DKIM: document proper Ed25519 key-generation methods; remove helper program
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.90"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2018
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
440 .endtable
441
442 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
445
446
447
448 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
449 .cindex "web site"
450 .cindex "FTP site"
451 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
452 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
453 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
454 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
455 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
456 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
457
458 .cindex "wiki"
459 .cindex "FAQ"
460 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
461 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
462 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
463 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
464 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
465
466 .cindex Bugzilla
467 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
468 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
469 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
470
471
472
473 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
474 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
475 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
476
477 .table2 140pt
478 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
479 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
480 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
481 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
482 .endtable
483
484 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
485 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
486 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
487 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
488 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
489 via this web page:
490 .display
491 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
492 .endd
493 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
494 lists.
495
496 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
497 .cindex "bug reports"
498 .cindex "reporting bugs"
499 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
500 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
501 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
502 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
503
504
505
506 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
507 .cindex "FTP site"
508 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
510 .display
511 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
512 .endd
513 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
514 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
515 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
516
517 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
518 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
519 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
520 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
521 .display
522 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
523 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
524 .endd
525 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
526 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
527 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
528
529 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
530 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
531 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
532 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
533 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
534 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
535 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
536 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
537 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
538 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
539 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
540
541 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
542 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
543 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
544 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
545
546 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
547 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
548 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
549
550 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
551 .display
552 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
553 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
554 .endd
555 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
556 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
557 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
558
559 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
560 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
561 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
562 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
563 .display
564 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
565 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
566 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
567 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
568 .endd
569 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
570 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
571
572
573 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
574 .ilist
575 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
576 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
577 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
578 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
579 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
580 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
581 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
582 .next
583 .cindex "domainless addresses"
584 .cindex "address" "without domain"
585 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
586 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
587 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
588 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
589 arrival.
590 .next
591 .cindex "transport" "external"
592 .cindex "external transports"
593 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
594 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
595 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
596 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
597 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
598 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
599 .next
600 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
601 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
602 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
603 other means.
604 .next
605 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
606 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
607 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
608 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
609 a number of common scanners are provided.
610 .endlist
611
612
613 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
614 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
615 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
616 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
617 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
618 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
619
620
621 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
622 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
623 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
624 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
625 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
626 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
627 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
628 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
629 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
630 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
631 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
632 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
633
634 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
635 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
636 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
637 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
638
639
640
641 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
642 .cindex "terminology definitions"
643 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
644 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
645 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
646 below) by a blank line.
647
648 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
649 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
650 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
651 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
652 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
653 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
654 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
655 rise to further bounce messages.
656
657 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
658 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
659 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
660 otherwise.
661
662 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
663 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
664 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
665 until a later time.
666
667 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
668 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
669 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
670
671 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
672 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
673 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
674 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
675 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
676 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
677 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
678 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
679
680 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
681 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
682 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
683 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
684 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
685 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
686 line.
687
688 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
689 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
690 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
691 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
692 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
693
694 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
695 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
696 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
697 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
698 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
699 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
700
701 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
702 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
703 message's envelope.
704
705 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
706 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
707 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
708 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
709 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
710
711 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
712 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
713 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
714 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
715 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
716
717 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
718 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
719 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
720 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
721 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
722 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
723
724
725
726
727
728
729 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
730 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
731
732 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
733 .cindex "incorporated code"
734 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
735 .cindex "PCRE"
736 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
737 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
738
739 .ilist
740 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
741 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
742 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
743 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
744 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
745 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
746 .next
747 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
748 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
749 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
750 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
751 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
752 following statements:
753
754 .blockquote
755 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
756
757 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
758 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
759 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
760 version.
761 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
762 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
763 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
764 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
765 restrictions applied to it).
766 .endblockquote
767 .next
768 .cindex "SPA authentication"
769 .cindex "Samba project"
770 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
771 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
772 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
773 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
774 under the Gnu GPL.
775 .next
776 .cindex "Cyrus"
777 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
778 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
779 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
780 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
781 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
782 conditions expressed therein.
783
784 .blockquote
785 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
786
787 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
788 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
789 are met:
790
791 .olist
792 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
793 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
794 .next
795 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
796 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
797 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
798 distribution.
799 .next
800 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
801 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
802 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
803 details, please contact
804 .display
805 Office of Technology Transfer
806 Carnegie Mellon University
807 5000 Forbes Avenue
808 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
809 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
810 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
811 .endd
812 .next
813 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
814 acknowledgment:
815
816 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
817 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
818
819 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
820 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
821 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
822 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
823 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
824 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
825 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
826 .endlist
827 .endblockquote
828
829 .next
830 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
831 .cindex "X-windows"
832 .cindex "Athena"
833 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
834 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
835 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
836 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
837
838 .blockquote
839 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
840 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
841
842 All Rights Reserved
843
844 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
845 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
846 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
847 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
848 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
849 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
850 software without specific, written prior permission.
851
852 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
853 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
854 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
855 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
856 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
857 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
858 SOFTWARE.
859 .endblockquote
860
861 .next
862 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
863 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
864 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
865 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
866 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
867 source code.
868
869 .next
870 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
871 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
872 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
873 .endlist
874
875
876
877
878
879 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
880 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
881
882 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
883 "Receiving and delivering mail"
884
885
886 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
887 .cindex "design philosophy"
888 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
889 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
890 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
891 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
892 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
893 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
894
895
896 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
897 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
898 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
899 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
900 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
901 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
902 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
903
904 .ilist
905 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
906 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
907 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
908 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
909 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
910 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
911 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
912 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
913 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
914 error code.
915 .next
916 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
917 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
918 .next
919 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
920 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
921 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
922 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
923 .next
924 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
925 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
926 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
927 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
928 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
929 .next
930 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
931 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
932 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
933 .next
934 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
935 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
936 runs at the start of every delivery process.
937 .endlist
938
939
940
941 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
942 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
943 .cindex "Sieve filter"
944 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
945 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
946 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
947 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
948 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
949 of filtering are available:
950
951 .ilist
952 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
953 by RFC 3028.
954 .next
955 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
956 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
957 .endlist
958
959 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
960
961
962
963 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
964 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
965 .cindex "format" "of message id"
966 .cindex "id of message"
967 .cindex "base62"
968 .cindex "base36"
969 .cindex "Darwin"
970 .cindex "Cygwin"
971 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
972 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
973 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
974 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
975 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
976 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
977 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
978 not always case-sensitive.
979
980 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
981 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
982 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
983 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
984 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
985 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
986 somewhat eccentric:
987
988 .ilist
989 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
990 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
991 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
992 way of representing the date and time of day).
993 .next
994 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
995 received the message.
996 .next
997 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
998 .olist
999 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1000 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1001 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1002 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1003 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1004 .next
1005 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1006 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1007 (1/100) of a second.
1008 .endlist
1009 .endlist
1010
1011 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1012 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1013 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1014 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1015 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1016
1017
1018 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1019 .cindex "receiving mail"
1020 .cindex "message" "reception"
1021 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1022 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1023 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1024 there are several possibilities:
1025
1026 .ilist
1027 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1028 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1029 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1030 .next
1031 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1032 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1033 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1034 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1035 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1036 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1037 .next
1038 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1039 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1040 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1041 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1042 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1043 .next
1044 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1045 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1046 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1047 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1048 .endlist
1049
1050
1051 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1052 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1053 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1054 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1055 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1056 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1057 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1058 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1059 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1060 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1061 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1062 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1063 users to change sender addresses.
1064
1065 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1066 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1067 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1068 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1069 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1070 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1071 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1072
1073 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1074 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1075 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1076 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1077 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1078 message is received.
1079
1080
1081
1082
1083
1084 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1085 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1086 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1087 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1088 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1089 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1090 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1091 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1092
1093 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1094 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1095 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1096 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1097 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1098 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1099 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1100 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1101 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1102 affect file system performance.
1103
1104 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1105 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1106 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1107 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1108 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1109
1110 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1111 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1112 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1113 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1114 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1115 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1116 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1117 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1118 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1119 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1120 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1121 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1122
1123
1124
1125 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1126 .cindex "message" "life of"
1127 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1128 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1129 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1130 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1131 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1132 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1133 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1134
1135 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1136 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1137 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1138 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1139 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1140 to be sent.
1141
1142 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1143 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1144 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1145 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1146 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1147
1148 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1149 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1150 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1151 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1152 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1153 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1154 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1155 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1156 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1157 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1158 systems.
1159
1160 .cindex "journal file"
1161 .cindex "file" "journal"
1162 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1163 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1164 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1165 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1166 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1167 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1168 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1169 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1170
1171 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1172 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1173 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1174 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1175 deliveries caused by crashes.
1176
1177
1178
1179 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1180 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1181 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1182 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1183 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1184 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1185 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1186 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1187 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1188
1189 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1190 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1191 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1192 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1193 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1194 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1195 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1196 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1197 the driver's features in general.
1198
1199 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1200 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1201 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1202 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1203 to be bounced.
1204
1205 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1206 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1207 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1208 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1209 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1210 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1211
1212 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1213 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1214 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1215 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1216 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1217 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1218
1219 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1220 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1221 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1222 configuration.
1223
1224 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1225 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1226 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1227 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1228 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1229 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1230 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1231 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1232 configured to fail the address.
1233
1234 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1235 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1236 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1237 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1238 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1239 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1240
1241 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1242 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1243 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1244 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1245 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1246 the address is bounced.
1247
1248
1249
1250 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1251 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1252 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1253 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1254 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1255 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1256 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1257 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1258
1259 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1260 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1261 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1262 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1263 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1264 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1265 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1266 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1267
1268
1269
1270
1271 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1272 .cindex "router" "running details"
1273 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1274 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1275 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1276 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1277 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1278 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1279 the following:
1280
1281 .ilist
1282 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1283 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1284 original address ceases,
1285 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1286 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1287 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1288 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1289 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1290 end of routing.
1291
1292 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1293 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1294 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1295 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1296 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1297 .next
1298 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1299 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1300 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1301 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1302 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1303 .next
1304 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1305 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1306 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1307 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1308 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1309 .next
1310 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1311 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1312 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1313 .next
1314 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1315 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1316 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1317 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1318 .next
1319 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1320 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1321 .endlist
1322
1323 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1324 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1325 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1326 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1327 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1328
1329 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1330 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1331 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1332 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1333 facility for this purpose.
1334
1335
1336 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1337 .cindex "case of local parts"
1338 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1339 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1340 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1341 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1342 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1343 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1344 routed addresses are shown.
1345
1346
1347
1348 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1349 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1350 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1351 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1352 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1353 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1354
1355 .ilist
1356 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1357 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1358 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1359 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1360 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1361 of any other conditions.
1362 .next
1363 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1364 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1365 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1366 address.
1367 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1368 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1369 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1370 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1371 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1372 .next
1373 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1374 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1375 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1376 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1377 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1378 .next
1379 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1380 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1381 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1382 .next
1383 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1384 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1385 .next
1386 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1387 of domains that it defines.
1388 .next
1389 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1390 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1391 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1392 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1393 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1394 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1395 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1396 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1397 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1398 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1399 .next
1400 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1402 .vindex "&$home$&"
1403 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1404 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1405 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1406 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1407 remaining preconditions.
1408 .next
1409 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1410 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1411 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1412 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1413 could lead to confusion.
1414 .next
1415 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1416 set of addresses that it defines.
1417 .next
1418 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1419 specified files is tested.
1420 .next
1421 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1422 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1423 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1424 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1425 .endlist
1426
1427
1428 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1429 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1430 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1431 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1432 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1433 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1434 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1435
1436
1437
1438 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1439 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1440 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1441
1442 .ilist
1443 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1444 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1445 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1446 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1447 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1448 filtering'&.
1449 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1450 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1451
1452 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1453 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1454 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1455 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1456 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1457 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1458 filter.
1459 .next
1460 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1461 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1462 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1463 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1464 processed entirely independently of each other.
1465 .next
1466 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1467 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1468 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1469 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1470 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1471 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1472 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1473 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1474 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1475 .next
1476 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1477 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1478 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1479 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1480 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1481 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1482 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1483 addresses to the same domain.
1484 .next
1485 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1486 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1487 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1488 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1489 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1490 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1491 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1492 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1493 .next
1494 .cindex "queue runner"
1495 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1496 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1497 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1498 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1499 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1500 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1501 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1502 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1503 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1504 .next
1505 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1506 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1507 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1508 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1509 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1510 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1511 .next
1512 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1513 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1514 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1515 messages to other addresses.
1516 .next
1517 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1518 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1519 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1520 &'deferred'&.
1521 .next
1522 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1523 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1524 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1525 .endlist
1526
1527
1528
1529
1530 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1531 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1532 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1533 .cindex "queue runner"
1534 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1535 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1536 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1537 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1538 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1539 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1540 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1541 passed its retry time.
1542 You can run several queue runners at once.
1543
1544 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1545 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1546 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1547 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1548 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1549 as permanent.
1550
1551
1552
1553 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1554 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1555 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1556 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1557 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1558 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1559 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1560 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1561 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1562 also apply.
1563
1564 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1565 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1566 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1567 deferred,
1568 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1569 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1570 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1571 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1572 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1573 one connection.
1574
1575
1576
1577 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1578 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1579 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1580 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1581 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1582 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1583 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1584 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1585 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1586 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1587 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1588
1589 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1590 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1591 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1592 automatically.
1593
1594 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1595 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1596 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1597 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1598 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1599 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1600 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1601 of the list.
1602
1603
1604
1605 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1606 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1607 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1608 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1609 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1610 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1611 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1612 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1613
1614
1615
1616
1617
1618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1620
1621 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1622 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1623
1624 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1625 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1626 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1627 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1628
1629 .table2 140pt
1630 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1631 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1632 documented"
1633 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1634 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1635 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1636 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1637 instructions"
1638 .endtable
1639
1640 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1641 following subdirectories are created:
1642
1643 .table2 140pt
1644 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1645 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1646 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1647 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1648 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1649 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1650 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1651 .endtable
1652
1653 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1654 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1655 that may be useful to some sites.
1656
1657
1658 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1659 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1660 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1661 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1662 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1663 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1664 system.
1665 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1666 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1667 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1668 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1669 overridden if necessary.
1670 .cindex compiler requirements
1671 .cindex compiler version
1672 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1673
1674
1675 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1676 .cindex "PCRE library"
1677 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1678 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1679 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1680 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1681 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1682 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1683 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1684 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1685 If your operating system has no
1686 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1687 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1688 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1689
1690 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1691 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1692 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1693 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1694 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1695 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1696 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1697
1698 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1699 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1700 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1701 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1702 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1703 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1704 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1705 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1706
1707 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1708 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1709 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1710 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1711 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1712 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1713 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1714 Berkeley DB library.
1715
1716 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1717 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1718 possibilities:
1719
1720 .olist
1721 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1722 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1723 .next
1724 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1725 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1726 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1727 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1728 file name is used unmodified.
1729 .next
1730 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1731 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1732 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1733 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1734 .next
1735 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1736 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1737 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1738 .next
1739 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1740 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1741 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1742 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1743 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1744 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1745 .next
1746 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1747 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1748 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1749 operates on a single file.
1750 .endlist
1751
1752 .cindex "USE_DB"
1753 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1754 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1755 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1756 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1757 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1758 .code
1759 USE_DB=yes
1760 .endd
1761 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1762 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1763
1764 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1765 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1766 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1767 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1768 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1769 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1770
1771 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1772 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1773 in one of these lines:
1774 .code
1775 DBMLIB = -ldb
1776 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1777 .endd
1778 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1779 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1780 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1781 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1782 this example:
1783 .code
1784 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1785 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1786 .endd
1787 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1788 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1789
1790
1791
1792 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1793 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1794 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1795 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1796 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1797 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1798 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1799 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1800 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1801 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1802 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1803 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1804
1805 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1806 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1807 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1808 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1809 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1810 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1811
1812 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1813 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1814 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1815 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1816 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1817 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1818 be logged.
1819
1820 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1821 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1822 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1823 facilities, you need to set
1824 .code
1825 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1826 .endd
1827 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1828 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1829
1830
1831 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1832 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1833 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1834 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1835 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1836 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1837 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1838
1839 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1840 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1841 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1842 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1843 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1844 do this.
1845
1846
1847
1848 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1849 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1850 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1851 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1852 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1853 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1854 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1855 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1856 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1857 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1858
1859 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1860 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1861 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1862 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1863 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1864 .code
1865 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1866 .endd
1867 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1868
1869
1870
1871 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1872 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1873 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1874 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1875 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1876 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1877 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1878 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1879 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1880 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1881 line option).
1882
1883 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1884 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1885 implementing SSL.
1886
1887 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1888 .code
1889 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1890 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1891 .endd
1892 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1893 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1894 .code
1895 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1896 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1897 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1898 .endd
1899 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1900 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1901 .code
1902 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1904 .endd
1905 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1906 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1907 .code
1908 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1909 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1910 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1911 .endd
1912 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1913 library and include files. For example:
1914 .code
1915 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1919 .endd
1920 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1921 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1922 .code
1923 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1924 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1925 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1926 .endd
1927
1928 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1929 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1930 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1931
1932
1933
1934
1935 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1936
1937 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1938 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1939 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1940 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1941 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1942 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1943 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1944 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1945 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1946 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1947 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1948 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1949 you might have
1950 .code
1951 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1952 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1953 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1954 .endd
1955 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1956 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1957 .code
1958 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1959 .endd
1960 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1961 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1962 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1963 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1964 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1965 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1966 further details.
1967
1968
1969 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1970 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1971 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1972 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1973 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1974 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1975 library files.
1976
1977 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1978 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1979 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1980 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1981 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1982 Exim used to
1983 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1984 withdrawn.
1985
1986
1987
1988 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1989 .cindex "lookup modules"
1990 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1991 .cindex ".so building"
1992 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1993 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
1994 on demand.
1995 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
1996 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
1997 dependencies.
1998 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
1999
2000 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2001 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2002 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2003 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2004 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2005 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2006
2007 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2008 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2009 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2010 on demand:
2011 .code
2012 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2013 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2014 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2015 .endd
2016
2017
2018 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2019 .cindex "build directory"
2020 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2021 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2022 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2023 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2024 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2025 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2026 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2027
2028 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2029 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2030 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2031 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2032 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2033 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2034 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2035 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2036
2037 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2038 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2039 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2040
2041
2042
2043 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2044 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2045 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2046 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2047 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2048 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2049 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2050 .code
2051 FULLECHO='' make -e
2052 .endd
2053 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2054 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2055 given in addition to the short output.
2056
2057
2058
2059 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2060 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2061 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2062 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2063 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2064 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2065 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2066 order:
2067 .display
2068 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2069 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2070 &_Local/Makefile_&
2071 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2072 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2073 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2074 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2075 .endd
2076 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2077 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2078 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2079 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2080 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2081 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2082 and are often not needed.
2083
2084 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2085 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2086 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2087 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2088 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2089 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2090 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2091 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2092 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2093
2094
2095 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2096 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2097 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2098 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2099 default values are.
2100
2101
2102 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2103 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2104 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2105 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2106 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2107 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2108 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2109 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2110 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2111 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2112 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2113 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2114 containing the lines
2115 .code
2116 CC=cc
2117 CFLAGS=-std1
2118 .endd
2119 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2120 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2121
2122 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2123 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2124 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2125
2126
2127 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2128 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2129 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2130 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2131 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2132 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2133 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2134 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2135 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2136 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2137 .code
2138 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2139 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2140 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2141 .endd
2142 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2143 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2144 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2145 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2146 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2147 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2148 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2149 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2150 errors.
2151
2152 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2153 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2154 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2155 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2156 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2157 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2158 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2159 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2160 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2161 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2162 syntax. For instance:
2163 .code
2164 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2165 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2166 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2167 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2168 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2169 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2170 .endd
2171
2172 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2173 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2174 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2175 .code
2176 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2177 .endd
2178 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2179 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2180
2181 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2182 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2183 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2184 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2185 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2186 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2187 .code
2188 X11=/usr/X11R6
2189 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2190 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2191 .endd
2192 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2193 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2194 .code
2195 X11=/usr/openwin
2196 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2197 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2198 .endd
2199 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2200 definition of all three of these variables into your
2201 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2202
2203 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2204 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2205 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2206 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2207 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2208
2209 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2210 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2211 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2212 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2213 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2214 libraries.
2215
2216 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2217 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2218 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2219 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2220 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2221
2222
2223 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2224 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2225 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2226 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2227 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2228 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2229 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2230 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2231
2232
2233
2234 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2235 .cindex "building Eximon"
2236 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2237 where the files that are involved are
2238 .display
2239 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2240 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2241 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2242 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2243 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2244 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2245 .endd
2246 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2247 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2248 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2249 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2250 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2251 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2252 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2253 .ecindex IIDbuex
2254
2255
2256 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2257 .cindex "installing Exim"
2258 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2259 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2260 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2261 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2262 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2263 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2264 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2265 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2266 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2267 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2268 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2269 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2270
2271 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2272 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2273 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2274 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2275 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2276 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2277 alternative files, no default is installed.
2278
2279 .cindex "system aliases file"
2280 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2281 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2282 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2283 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2284 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2285 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2286 and outputs a comment to the user.
2287
2288 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2289 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2290 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2291 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2292 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2293
2294 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2295 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2296 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2297 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2298 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2299 over SMTP.
2300
2301 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2302 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2303 command such as
2304 .code
2305 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2306 .endd
2307 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2308 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2309 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2310 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2311 but this usage is deprecated.
2312
2313 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2314 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2315 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2316 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2317 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2318 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2319
2320 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2321 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2322 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2323 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2324 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2325 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2326 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2327
2328 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2329 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2330 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2331 command:
2332 .code
2333 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2334 .endd
2335 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2336 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2337 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2338 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2339 command:
2340 .code
2341 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2342 .endd
2343 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2344 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2345
2346 .ilist
2347 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2348 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2349 .next
2350 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2351 installed binary.
2352 .endlist
2353
2354 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2355 .code
2356 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2357 .endd
2358 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2359 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2360 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2361 .code
2362 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2363 .endd
2364
2365
2366
2367 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2368 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2369 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2370 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2371 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2372 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2373
2374 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2375 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2376 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2377
2378
2379
2380 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2381 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2382 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2383 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2384 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2385 necessary.
2386
2387
2388
2389
2390 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2391 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2392 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2393 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2394 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2395 .code
2396 exim -bV
2397 .endd
2398 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2399 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2400 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2401 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2402 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2403 example,
2404 .display
2405 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2406 .endd
2407 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2408 .display
2409 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2410 .endd
2411 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2412 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2413 user agent. For example:
2414 .code
2415 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2416 From: user@your.domain.example
2417 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2418 Subject: Testing Exim
2419
2420 This is a test message.
2421 ^D
2422 .endd
2423 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2424 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2425 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2426
2427 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2428 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2429 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2430 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2431 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2432 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2433 .display
2434 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2435 .endd
2436 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2437 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2438 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2439 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2440 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2441
2442 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2443 .cindex "lock files"
2444 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2445 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2446 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2447 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2448 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2449 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2450 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2451 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2452 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2453 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2454 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2455 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2456
2457 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2458 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2459 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2460 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2461 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2462 incoming SMTP mail.
2463
2464 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2465 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2466 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2467 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2468 production version.
2469
2470
2471 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2472 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2473 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2474 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2475 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2476 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2477 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2478 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2479 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2480 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2481 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2482 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2483 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2484
2485 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2486 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2487 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2488 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2489 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2490 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2491 as follows:
2492 .code
2493 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2494 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2495 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2496 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2497 .endd
2498 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2499 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2500 favourite user agent.
2501
2502 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2503 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2504 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2505 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2506 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2507 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2508
2509
2510
2511 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2512 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2513 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2514 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2515 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2516 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2517 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2518 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2519 configuration file.
2520
2521
2522
2523
2524 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2525 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2526 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2527 .code
2528 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2529 .endd
2530 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2531 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2532 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2533 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2534 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2535 .code
2536 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2537 .endd
2538 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2539
2540 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2541 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2542 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2543
2544
2545
2546
2547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2548 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2549
2550 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2551 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2552 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2553 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2554 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2555 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2556 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2557 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2558 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2559
2560
2561 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2562 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2563 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2564 were present before any other options.
2565 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2566 standard output.
2567 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2568 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2569 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2570
2571 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2572 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2573 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2574 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2575 format.
2576
2577 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2578 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2579 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2580 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2581
2582 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2583 .cindex "queue runner"
2584 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2585 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2586 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2587
2588 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2589 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2590 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2591 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2592 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2593 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2594 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2595 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2596
2597
2598 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2599 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2600 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2601 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2602 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2603 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2604
2605 .ilist
2606 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2607 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2608 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2609 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2610 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2611 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2612
2613 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2614 .cindex "envelope sender"
2615 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2616 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2617 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2618 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2619 users to set envelope senders.
2620
2621 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2622 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2623 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2624 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2625 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2626 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2627 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2628
2629 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2630 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2631 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2632 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2633 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2634 that are available to trusted users.
2635 .next
2636 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2637 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2638 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2639 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2640 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2641
2642 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2643 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2644 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2645 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2646
2647 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2648 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2649 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2650 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2651
2652 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2653 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2654 false.
2655 .endlist
2656
2657
2658 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2659 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2660 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2661 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2662
2663
2664
2665
2666 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2667 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2668 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2669 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2670 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2671 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2672 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2673 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2674
2675 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2676 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2677 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2678 . creates a man page for the options.
2679 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2680
2681 .literal xml
2682 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2683 .literal off
2684
2685
2686 .vlist
2687 .vitem &%--%&
2688 .oindex "--"
2689 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2690 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2691 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2692 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2693
2694 .vitem &%--help%&
2695 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2696 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2697 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2698 no arguments.
2699
2700 .vitem &%--version%&
2701 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2702 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2703 displayed.
2704
2705 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2706 &%-Am%&
2707 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2708 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2709 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2710 ignored by Exim.
2711
2712 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2713 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2714 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2715 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2716 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2717 clean; it ignores this option.
2718
2719 .vitem &%-bd%&
2720 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2721 .cindex "daemon"
2722 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2723 .cindex "queue runner"
2724 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2725 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2726 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2727
2728 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2729 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2730 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2731 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2732
2733 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2734 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2735 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2736 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2737
2738 When a listening daemon
2739 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2740 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2741 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2742 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2743 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2744 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2745 running as root.
2746
2747 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2748 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2749 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2750
2751 The SIGHUP signal
2752 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2753 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2754 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2755 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2756 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2757 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2758 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2759 because these are reread each time they are used.
2760
2761 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2762 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2763 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2764 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2765
2766 .vitem &%-be%&
2767 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2768 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2769 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2770 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2771 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2772 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2773 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2774
2775 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2776 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2777 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2778 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2779 test data. A line history is supported.
2780
2781 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2782 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2783 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2784 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2785 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2786 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2787 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2788
2789 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2790 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2791 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2792 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2793
2794 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2795 defined and macros will be expanded.
2796 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2797 available to admin users.
2798
2799 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2800 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2801 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2802 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2803 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2804 of a file. For example:
2805 .code
2806 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2807 .endd
2808 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2809 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2810 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2811 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2812 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2813 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2814 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2815 &%-be%&).
2816
2817 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2818 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2819 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2820 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2821 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2822 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2823 system filters are recognized.
2824
2825 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2826 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2827 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2828 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2829 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2830 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2831 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2832 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2833 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2834 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2835 supplied.
2836
2837 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2838 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2839 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2840 .code
2841 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2842 .endd
2843 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2844 variables that are used by the user filter.
2845
2846 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2847 .code
2848 # Exim filter
2849 # Sieve filter
2850 .endd
2851 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2852 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2853 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2854 redirection lists.
2855
2856 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2857 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2858 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2859 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2860
2861 When testing a filter file,
2862 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2863 .cindex "envelope sender"
2864 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2865 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2866 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2867 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2868 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2869 options).
2870
2871 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2872 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2873 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2874 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2875 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2876 &$qualify_domain$&.
2877
2878 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2879 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2880 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2881 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2882 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2883 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2884 actually being delivered.
2885
2886 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2887 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2888 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2889 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2890 prefix.
2891
2892 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2893 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2894 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2895 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2896 suffix.
2897
2898 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2899 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2900 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2901 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2902 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2903 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2904 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2905 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2906 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2907 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2908 after a full stop. For example:
2909 .code
2910 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2911 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2912 .endd
2913 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2914 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2915 conversion to the canonical form is
2916 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2917
2918 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2919 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2920 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2921 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2922 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2923
2924 &*Warning 1*&:
2925 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2926 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2927 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2928 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2929 connection.
2930
2931 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2932 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2933 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2934
2935 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2936 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2937 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2938 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2939 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2940 session were authenticated.
2941
2942 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2943 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2944 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2945
2946 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2947 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2948 specialized SMTP test program such as
2949 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2950
2951 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2952 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2953 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2954 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2955 updating the callout cache database.
2956
2957 .vitem &%-bi%&
2958 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2959 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2960 .cindex "building alias file"
2961 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2962 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2963 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2964 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2965 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2966 recognized.
2967
2968 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2969 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2970 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2971 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2972 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2973 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2974 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2975
2976 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2977 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2978 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2979 .cindex "querying exim information"
2980 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2981 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2982 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2983 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2984 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2985
2986 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2987 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2988 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2989 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2990 recognised DSCP names.
2991
2992 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2993 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2994 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2995 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2996 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2997 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2998 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2999 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3000 way to guarantee a correct response.
3001
3002 .vitem &%-bm%&
3003 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3004 .cindex "local message reception"
3005 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3006 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3007 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3008 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3009 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3010 if no other conflicting option is present.
3011
3012 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3013 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3014 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3015 suppressing this for special cases.
3016
3017 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3018 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3019
3020 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3021 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3022 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3023
3024 The format
3025 .cindex "message" "format"
3026 .cindex "format" "message"
3027 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3028 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3029 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3030 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3031 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3032 .code
3033 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3034 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3035 .endd
3036 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3037 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3038 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3039 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3040 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3041
3042 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3043 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3044 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3045 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3046 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3047
3048 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3049 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3050 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3051 .cindex "malware scan test"
3052 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3053 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3054 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3055 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3056 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3057 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3058 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3059
3060 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3061 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3062 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3063 This option requires admin privileges.
3064
3065 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3066 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3067 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3068
3069 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3070 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3071 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3072 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3073 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3074 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3075 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3076 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3077 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3078
3079 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3080 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3081 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3082 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3083 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3084
3085 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3086 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3087 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3088 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3089
3090
3091 .vitem &%-bP%&
3092 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3093 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3094 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3095 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3096 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3097 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3098 arguments, for example:
3099 .code
3100 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3101 .endd
3102 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3103 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3104 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3105 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3106 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3107 users, the output is as in this example:
3108 .code
3109 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3110 .endd
3111 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3112 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3113
3114 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3115 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3116 backward compatibility.)
3117 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3118 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3119
3120 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3121 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3122 name will not be output.
3123
3124 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3125 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3126 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3127 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3128 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3129 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3130 written directly into the spool directory.
3131
3132 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3133 .code
3134 exim -bP +local_domains
3135 .endd
3136 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3137 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3138
3139 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3140 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3141 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3142 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3143 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3144 that driver are output. For example:
3145 .code
3146 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3147 .endd
3148 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3149 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3150 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3151 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3152 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3153 &%authenticators%&.
3154
3155 .cindex "environment"
3156 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3157 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3158 variables.
3159
3160 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3161 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3162 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3163 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3164 The output format is one item per line.
3165 .new
3166 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3167 the exit status will be nonzero.
3168 .wen
3169
3170 .vitem &%-bp%&
3171 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3172 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3173 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3174 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3175 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3176 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3177 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3178 to allow any user to see the queue.
3179
3180 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3181 .code
3182 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3183 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3184 <other addresses>
3185 .endd
3186 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3187 .cindex "size" "of message"
3188 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3189 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3190 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3191 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3192 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3193 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3194 before the sender address.
3195
3196 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3197 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3198 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3199
3200 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3201 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3202 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3203 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3204 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3205 complete.
3206
3207
3208 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3209 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3210 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3211 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3212 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3213 of just &"D"&.
3214
3215
3216 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3217 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3218 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3219 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3220 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3221 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3222
3223
3224 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3225 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3226 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3227 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3228 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3229 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3230
3231 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3232 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3233 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3234
3235 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3236 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3237 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3238
3239
3240 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3241 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3242 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3243 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3244 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3245 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3246
3247
3248 .vitem &%-brt%&
3249 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3250 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3251 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3252 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3253 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3254 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3255 .code
3256 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3257 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3258 .endd
3259 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3260 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3261 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3262 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3263 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3264 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3265 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3266 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3267 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3268 .code
3269 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3270 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3271 .endd
3272
3273 .vitem &%-brw%&
3274 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3275 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3276 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3277 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3278 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3279 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3280 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3281 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3282
3283 .vitem &%-bS%&
3284 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3285 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3286 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3287 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3288 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3289 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3290 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3291 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3292 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3293 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3294
3295 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3296 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3297 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3298
3299 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3300 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3301 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3302 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3303
3304 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3305 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3306 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3307
3308 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3309 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3310 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3311 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3312 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3313
3314 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3315 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3316
3317 .vitem &%-bs%&
3318 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3319 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3320 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3321 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3322 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3323 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3324 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3325 messages to the MTA.
3326
3327 In
3328 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3329 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3330 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3331 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3332 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3333 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3334 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3335
3336 .cindex "inetd"
3337 The
3338 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3339 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3340 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3341 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3342 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3343 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3344 the listening daemon.
3345
3346 .vitem &%-bt%&
3347 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3348 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3349 .cindex "address" "testing"
3350 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3351 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3352 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3353 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3354 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3355
3356 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3357 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3358
3359 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3360 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3361 security issues.
3362
3363 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3364 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3365 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3366 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3367 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3368 program.
3369
3370 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3371 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3372 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3373 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3374
3375 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3376 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3377 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3378 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3379 always shown.
3380
3381 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3382 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3383 message,
3384 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3385 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3386 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3387 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3388 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3389 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3390 doing such tests.
3391
3392 .vitem &%-bV%&
3393 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3394 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3395 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3396 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3397 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3398 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3399 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3400
3401 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3402 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3403 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3404 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3405 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3406 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3407 dynamic testing facilities.
3408
3409 .vitem &%-bv%&
3410 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3411 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3412 .cindex "address" "verification"
3413 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3414 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3415 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3416 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3417 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3418 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3419
3420 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3421 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3422 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3423
3424 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3425 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3426
3427 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3428 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3429 security issues.
3430
3431 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3432 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3433 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3434 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3435 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3436
3437 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3438 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3439 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3440 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3441 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3442 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3443 to succeed.
3444
3445 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3446 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3447 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3448
3449 The
3450 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3451 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3452 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3453 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3454
3455 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3456 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3457 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3458 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3459
3460 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3461 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3462 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3463 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3464 might happen.
3465
3466 .vitem &%-bw%&
3467 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3468 .cindex "daemon"
3469 .cindex "inetd"
3470 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3471 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3472 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3473 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3474
3475 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3476 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3477 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3478 each port only when the first connection is received.
3479
3480 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3481 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3482
3483 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3484 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3485 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3486 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3487 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3488 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3489 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3490 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3491 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3492 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3493 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3494
3495 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3496 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3497 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3498 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3499 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3500 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3501 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3502 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3503 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3504
3505 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3506 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3507 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3508 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3509 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3510 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3511 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3512
3513 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3514 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3515 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3516 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3517 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3518 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3519 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3520
3521 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3522 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3523 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3524 configuration file.
3525
3526 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3527 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3528 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3529 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3530 specified by this option.
3531
3532
3533 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3534 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3535 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3536 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3537 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3538 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3539 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3540 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3541
3542 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3543 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3544 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3545 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3546 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3547 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3548 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3549
3550 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3551 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3552 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3553 synonymous:
3554 .code
3555 exim -DABC ...
3556 exim -DABC= ...
3557 .endd
3558 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3559 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3560 example:
3561 .code
3562 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3563 .endd
3564 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3565 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3566
3567
3568 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3569 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3570 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3571 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3572 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3573 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3574 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3575 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3576 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3577 return code.
3578
3579 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3580 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3581 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3582 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3583 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3584 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3585 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3586 are:
3587 .display
3588 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3589 &`auth `& authenticators
3590 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3591 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3592 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3593 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3594 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3595 &`filter `& filter handling
3596 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3597 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3598 &`ident `& ident lookup
3599 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3600 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3601 &`load `& system load checks
3602 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3603 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3604 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3605 &`memory `& memory handling
3606 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3607 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3608 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3609 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3610 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3611 &`retry `& retry handling
3612 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3613 &`route `& address routing
3614 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3615 &`tls `& TLS logic
3616 &`transport `& transports
3617 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3618 &`verify `& address verification logic
3619 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3620 .endd
3621 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3622 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3623 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3624 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3625 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3626 turn everything off.
3627
3628 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3629 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3630 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3631 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3632 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3633 rather than stderr.
3634
3635 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3636 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3637 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3638 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3639 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3640 run in parallel.
3641
3642 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3643 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3644 in processing.
3645
3646 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3647 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3648
3649 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3650 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3651 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3652 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3653 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3654 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3655
3656 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3657 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3658 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3659 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3660 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3661
3662 .vitem &%-E%&
3663 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3664 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3665 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3666 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3667 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3668 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3669 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3670 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3671 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3672
3673 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3674 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3675 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3676 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3677 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3678 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3679
3680 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3681 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3682 .cindex "sender" "name"
3683 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3684 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3685 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3686 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3687 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3688 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3689
3690 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3691 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3692 .cindex "sender" "address"
3693 .cindex "address" "sender"
3694 .cindex "trusted users"
3695 .cindex "envelope sender"
3696 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3697 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3698 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3699 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3700 users to use it.
3701
3702 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3703 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3704 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3705 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3706 domain.
3707
3708 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3709 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3710 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3711 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3712 examples of shell commands:
3713 .code
3714 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3715 exim -f "" user@domain
3716 .endd
3717 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3718 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3719 &%-bv%& options.
3720
3721 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3722 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3723 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3724 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3725
3726 White
3727 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3728 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3729 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3730 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3731 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3732 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3733
3734 .vitem &%-G%&
3735 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3736 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3737 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3738 .code
3739 control = suppress_local_fixups
3740 .endd
3741 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3742 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3743 in future.
3744
3745 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3746 this option.
3747
3748 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3749 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3750 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3751 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3752 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3753 headers.)
3754
3755 .vitem &%-i%&
3756 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3757 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3758 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3759 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3760 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3761 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3762 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3763
3764 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3765 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3766 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3767 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3768 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3769 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3770 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3771 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3772
3773 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3774
3775 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3776 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3777 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3778 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3779 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3780 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3781 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3782 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3783 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3784
3785 Retry
3786 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3787 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3788 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3789 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3790 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3791 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3792
3793 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3794 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3795 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3796 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3797
3798 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3799 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3800 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3801 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3802 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3803 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3804 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3805 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3806 can be used only by an admin user.
3807
3808 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3809 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3810 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3811 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3812 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3813 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3814 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3815 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3816 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3817 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3818 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3819
3820 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3821 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3822 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3823 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3824 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3825
3826 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3827 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3828 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3829 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3830 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3831
3832 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3833 .oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3834 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3835 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3836 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3837
3838 .vitem &%-MCK%&
3839 .oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3840 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3841 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3842 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3843
3844 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3845 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3846 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3847 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3848 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3849
3850 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3851 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3852 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3853 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3854 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3855 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3856 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3857 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3858
3859 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3860 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3861 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3862 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3863 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3864 connection.
3865
3866 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3867 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3868 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3869 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3870 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3871
3872 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3873 .oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3874 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3875 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3876 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3877 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3878
3879 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3880 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3881 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3882 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3883 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3884 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3885 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3886 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3887 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3888 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3889 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3890 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3891 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3892 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3893 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3894
3895 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3896 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3897 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3898 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3899 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3900 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3901 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3902 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3903 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3904 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3905
3906 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3907 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3908 .cindex "freezing messages"
3909 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3910 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3911 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3912 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3913 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3914 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3915 user.
3916
3917 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3918 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3919 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3920 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3921 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3922 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3923 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3924 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3925 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3926 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3927 user.
3928
3929 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3930 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3931 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3932 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3933 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3934 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3935 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3936
3937 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3938 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3939 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3940 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3941 .cindex "removing recipients"
3942 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3943 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3944 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3945 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3946 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3947 can be used only by an admin user.
3948
3949 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3950 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3951 .cindex "removing messages"
3952 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3953 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3954 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3955 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3956 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3957 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3958 placed on the queue.
3959
3960 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3961 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3962 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3963 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3964 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3965 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3966 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3967 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3968 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3969 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3970 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3971
3972 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3973 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3974 .cindex "thawing messages"
3975 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3976 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3977 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3978 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3979 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3980 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3981 by an admin user.
3982
3983 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3984 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3985 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3986 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3987 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3988 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3989
3990 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3991 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3992 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3993 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3994 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3995 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3996 only by an admin user.
3997
3998 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3999 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
4000 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4001 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4002 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4003 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4004 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4005
4006 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4007 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
4008 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4009 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4010 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4011 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4012
4013 .vitem &%-m%&
4014 .oindex "&%-m%&"
4015 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4016 treats it that way too.
4017
4018 .vitem &%-N%&
4019 .oindex "&%-N%&"
4020 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4021 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4022 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4023 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4024 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4025 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4026 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4027 than &"=>"&.
4028
4029 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4030 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4031 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4032 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4033 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4034 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4035 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4036 for that message.
4037
4038 .vitem &%-n%&
4039 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4040 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4041 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4042 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4043 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4044
4045 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4046 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4047 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4048 Exim.
4049
4050 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4051 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4052 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4053 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4054 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4055 description above.
4056
4057 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4058 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4059 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4060 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4061 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4062 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4063 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4064 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4065
4066 .vitem &%-odb%&
4067 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4068 .cindex "background delivery"
4069 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4070 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4071 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4072 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4073 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4074 processes to finish.
4075
4076 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4077 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4078 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4079 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4080
4081 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4082 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4083 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4084 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4085
4086 .vitem &%-odf%&
4087 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4088 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4089 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4090 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4091 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4092 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4093 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4094
4095 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4096 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4097 during deliveries.
4098
4099 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4100 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4101
4102 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4103 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4104 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4105 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4106
4107
4108 .vitem &%-odi%&
4109 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4110 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4111 Sendmail.
4112
4113 .vitem &%-odq%&
4114 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4115 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4116 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4117 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4118 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4119 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4120 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4121 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4122 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4123 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4124 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4125 forces queueing.
4126
4127 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4128 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4129 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4130 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4131 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4132 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4133 configuration file is in effect.
4134
4135 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4136 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4137 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4138 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4139 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4140 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4141 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4142 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4143 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4144 &%-qq%& option.
4145
4146 .vitem &%-oee%&
4147 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4148 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4149 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4150 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4151 message.
4152
4153 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4154 Provided
4155 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4156 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4157 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4158 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4159
4160 .vitem &%-oem%&
4161 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4162 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4163 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4164 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4165 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4166 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4167
4168 .vitem &%-oep%&
4169 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4170 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4171 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4172 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4173 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4174 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4175
4176 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4177 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4178 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4179 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4180 effect as &%-oep%&.
4181
4182 .vitem &%-oew%&
4183 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4184 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4185 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4186 effect as &%-oem%&.
4187
4188 .vitem &%-oi%&
4189 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4190 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4191 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4192 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4193 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4194 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4195 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4196
4197 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4198 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4199 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4200
4201 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4202 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4203 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4204 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4205 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4206 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4207 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4208 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4209
4210 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4211 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4212 .code
4213 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4214 .endd
4215 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4216 followed by a colon and the port number:
4217 .code
4218 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4219 .endd
4220 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4221 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4222 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4223 whichever one is last.
4224
4225 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4226 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4227 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4228 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4229 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4230 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4231 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4232 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4233
4234 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4235 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4236 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4237 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4238 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4239 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4240 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4241 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4242
4243 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4244 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4245 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4246 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4247 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4248 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4249 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4250 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4251 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4252 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4253
4254 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4255 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4256 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4257 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4258 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4259 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4260 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4261
4262 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4263 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4264 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4265 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4266 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4267 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4268 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4269 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4270 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4271
4272 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4273 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4274 is sending the bounce.
4275
4276 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4277 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4278 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4279 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4280 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4281 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4282 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4283 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4284 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4285 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4286 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4287 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4288
4289 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4290 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4291 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4292 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4293 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4294 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4295 uses the name it is given.
4296
4297 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4298 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4299 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4300 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4301 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4302 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4303 used, when there is no default.
4304
4305 .vitem &%-om%&
4306 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4307 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4308 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4309 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4310 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4311
4312 .vitem &%-oo%&
4313 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4314 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4315 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4316 whatever that means.
4317
4318 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4319 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4320 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4321 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4322 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4323 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4324 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4325 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4326 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4327
4328 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4329 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4330 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4331 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4332 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4333 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4334 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4335
4336 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4337 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4338 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4339 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4340 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4341 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4342 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4343 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4344
4345 .vitem &%-ov%&
4346 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4347 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4348
4349 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4350 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4351 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4352 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4353 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4354 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4355 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4356 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4357 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4358 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4359
4360 .vitem &%-pd%&
4361 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4362 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4363 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4364 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4365 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4366 needed.
4367
4368 .vitem &%-ps%&
4369 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4370 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4371 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4372 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4373 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4374 started.
4375
4376 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4377 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4378 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4379 .display
4380 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4381 .endd
4382 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4383 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4384 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4385 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4386 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4387 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4388
4389 .vitem &%-q%&
4390 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4391 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4392 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4393 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4394 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4395 and &%-S%& options).
4396
4397 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4398 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4399 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4400 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4401 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4402 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4403 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4404
4405 If
4406 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4407 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4408 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4409 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4410 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4411 proceeding.
4412
4413 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4414 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4415 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4416 this to be repeated periodically.
4417
4418 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4419 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4420 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4421 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4422
4423 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4424 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4425 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4426
4427 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4428 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4429 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4430 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4431
4432 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4433 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4434 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4435 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4436 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4437 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4438 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4439 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4440 transports are run.
4441
4442 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4443 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4444 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4445 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4446 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4447 delivered down a single SMTP
4448 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4449 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4450 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4451 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4452 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4453 intermittently.
4454
4455 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4456 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4457 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4458 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4459 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4460 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4461 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4462
4463 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4464 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4465 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4466 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4467 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4468 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4469 their retry times are tried.
4470
4471 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4472 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4473 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4474 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4475 frozen or not.
4476
4477 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4478 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4479 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4480 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4481 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4482 for later delivery.
4483
4484 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4485 .oindex "&%-qG%&"
4486 .cindex queue named
4487 .cindex "named queues"
4488 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4489 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4490 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4491 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4492 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4493 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4494
4495 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4496 will specify a queue to operate on.
4497 For example:
4498 .code
4499 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4500 mailq -qGquarantine
4501 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4502 .endd
4503
4504 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4505 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4506 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4507 starting message id. For example:
4508 .code
4509 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4510 .endd
4511 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4512 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4513 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4514 .code
4515 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4516 .endd
4517 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4518 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4519 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4520 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4521 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4522 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4523
4524 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4525 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4526 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4527 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4528 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4529 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4530 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4531 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4532 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4533 .code
4534 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4535 .endd
4536 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4537 process every 30 minutes.
4538
4539 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4540 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4541
4542 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4543 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4544 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4545 compatibility.
4546
4547 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4548 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4549 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4550
4551 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4552 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4553 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4554 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4555 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4556 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4557 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4558 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4559 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4560
4561 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4562 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4563 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4564 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4565 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4566 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4567
4568 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4569 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4570 .code
4571 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4572 .endd
4573 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4574 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4575 applied to each queue run.
4576
4577 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4578 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4579 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4580 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4581 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4582 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4583 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4584 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4585 address will be skipped.
4586
4587 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4588 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4589 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4590 &'ff'& is present.
4591
4592 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4593 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4594 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4595 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4596 an arbitrary command instead.
4597
4598 .vitem &%-r%&
4599 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4600 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4601
4602 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4603 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4604 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4605 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4606 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4607 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4608 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4609 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4610
4611 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4612 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4613 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4614 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4615 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4616
4617 .vitem &%-t%&
4618 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4619 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4620 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4621 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4622 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4623 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4624 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4625 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4626 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4627 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4628
4629 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4630 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4631 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4632 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4633 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4634 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4635 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4636 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4637 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4638 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4639 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4640
4641 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4642 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4643 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4644 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4645 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4646 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4647
4648 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4649 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4650 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4651 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4652 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4653 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4654 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4655 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4656 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4657
4658 .vitem &%-ti%&
4659 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4660 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4661 compatibility with Sendmail.
4662
4663 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4664 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4665 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4666 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4667 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4668 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4669 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4670 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4671
4672
4673 .vitem &%-U%&
4674 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4675 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4676 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4677 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4678 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4679 set. Exim ignores this option.
4680
4681 .vitem &%-v%&
4682 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4683 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4684 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4685 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4686 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4687 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4688 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4689 unconditional.
4690
4691 .vitem &%-x%&
4692 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4693 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4694 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4695 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4696 this option.
4697
4698 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4699 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4700 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4701 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4702
4703 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4704 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4705 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4706 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4707 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4708 under most shells.
4709 .endlist
4710
4711 .ecindex IIDclo1
4712 .ecindex IIDclo2
4713
4714
4715 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4716 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4717 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4718 . creates a man page for the options.
4719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4720
4721 .literal xml
4722 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4723 .literal off
4724
4725
4726
4727
4728
4729 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4730 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4731
4732
4733 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4734 "The runtime configuration file"
4735
4736 .cindex "run time configuration"
4737 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4738 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4739 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4740 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4741 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4742 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4743 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4744 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4745 control.
4746
4747 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4748 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4749 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4750 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4751 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4752 actually alter the string.
4753
4754 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4755 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4756 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4757 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4758 existing file in the list.
4759
4760 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4761 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4762 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4763 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4764 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4765 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4766 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4767 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4768 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4769 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4770 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4771
4772 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4773 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4774 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4775 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4776 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4777
4778 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4779 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4780 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4781 compromise the Exim user account.
4782
4783 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4784 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4785 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4786 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4787 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4788 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4789 configuration.
4790
4791
4792
4793 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4794 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4795 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4796 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4797 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4798 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4799 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4800 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4801 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4802 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4803 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4804
4805 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4806 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4807 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4808 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4809 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4810 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4811 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4812 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4813 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4814 &%-M%&).
4815
4816 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4817 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4818 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4819 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4820 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4821
4822 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4823 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4824 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4825 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4826 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4827 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4828
4829 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4830 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4831 necessarily be discarded.
4832 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4833 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4834 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4835 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4836 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4837 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4838
4839 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4840 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4841 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4842 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4843 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4844 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4845 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4846
4847 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4848 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4849 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4850
4851
4852
4853 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4854 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4855 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4856 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4857 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4858 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4859 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4860 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4861
4862 .ilist
4863 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4864 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4865 .next
4866 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4867 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4868 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4869 .next
4870 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4871 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4872 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4873 .next
4874 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4875 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4876 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4877 .next
4878 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4879 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4880 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4881 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4882 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4883 .next
4884 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4885 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4886 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4887 .next
4888 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4889 want to use this feature, you must set
4890 .code
4891 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4892 .endd
4893 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4894 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4895 .endlist
4896
4897 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4898 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4899 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4900 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4901
4902 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4903 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4904 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4905 and does not introduce a comment.
4906
4907 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4908 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4909 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4910 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4911 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4912
4913 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4914 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4915 change settings as required.
4916
4917 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4918 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4919 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4920 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4921 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4922 described.
4923
4924
4925
4926 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4927 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4928 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4929 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4930 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4931 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4932 using this syntax:
4933 .display
4934 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4935 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4936 .endd
4937 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4938 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4939 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4940 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4941 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute file
4942 name is required.
4943
4944 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4945 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4946 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4947 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4948
4949 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4950 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4951 for example:
4952 .code
4953 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4954 .include /some/file
4955 .endd
4956 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4957 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4958 inclusion appears.
4959
4960
4961
4962 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4963 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4964 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4965 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4966 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4967 definition, and must be of the form
4968 .display
4969 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4970 .endd
4971 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4972 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4973 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4974 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4975 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4976
4977 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4978 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4979 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4980
4981 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4982 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4983 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4984 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4985 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4986 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4987 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4988 define
4989 .display
4990 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4991 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4992 .endd
4993 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4994 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4995 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4996 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4997 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4998 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4999
5000
5001 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5002 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5003 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5004 &'='&. For example:
5005 .code
5006 MAC = initial value
5007 ...
5008 MAC == updated value
5009 .endd
5010 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5011 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5012 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5013 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5014 .code
5015 MAC = initial value
5016 ...
5017 MAC == MAC and something added
5018 .endd
5019 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5020 from a number of other files.
5021
5022 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5023 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5024 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5025 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5026 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5027 file to be ignored.
5028
5029
5030
5031 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5032 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5033 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5034 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5035 .code
5036 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5037 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5038 .endd
5039 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5040 .code
5041 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5042 .endd
5043 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5044 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5045 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5046
5047
5048 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5049 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5050 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5051 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5052 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5053 (see below).
5054
5055 The following classes of macros are defined:
5056 .display
5057 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5058 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5059 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5060 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5061 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5062 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5063 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5064 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5065 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5066 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5067 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5068 .endd
5069
5070 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5071
5072
5073 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5074 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5075 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5076 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5077 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5078 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5079 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5080
5081 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5082 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5083 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5084 line. Thus:
5085 .code
5086 .ifdef AAA
5087 message_size_limit = 50M
5088 .else
5089 message_size_limit = 100M
5090 .endif
5091 .endd
5092 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5093 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5094 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5095 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5096 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5097
5098 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5099 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5100 in this line"& will always be true.
5101
5102 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5103 to clarify complicated nestings.
5104
5105
5106
5107 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5108 .cindex "common option syntax"
5109 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5110 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5111 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5112 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5113 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5114 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5115 space) and then the value. For example:
5116 .code
5117 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5118 .endd
5119 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5120 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5121 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5122 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5123 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5124 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5125 word &"hide"&. For example:
5126 .code
5127 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5128 .endd
5129 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5130 .code
5131 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5132 .endd
5133 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5134 all instances of the same driver.
5135
5136 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5137 that are found in option settings.
5138
5139
5140 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5141 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5142 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5143 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5144 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5145 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5146 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5147 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5148 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5149 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5150 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5151 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5152 .code
5153 queue_only
5154 queue_only = true
5155 .endd
5156 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5157 .code
5158 no_queue_only
5159 queue_only = false
5160 .endd
5161 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5162
5163
5164
5165
5166 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5167 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5168 .cindex "format" "integer"
5169 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5170 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5171 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5172 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5173 hexadecimal number.
5174
5175 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5176 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5177 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5178 When the values
5179 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5180 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5181 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5182 used.
5183
5184
5185 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5186 .cindex "integer format"
5187 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5188 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5189 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5190 Such options are always output in octal.
5191
5192
5193 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5194 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5195 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5196 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5197 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5198
5199
5200
5201 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5202 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5203 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5204 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5205 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5206
5207 .table2 30pt
5208 .irow &%s%& seconds
5209 .irow &%m%& minutes
5210 .irow &%h%& hours
5211 .irow &%d%& days
5212 .irow &%w%& weeks
5213 .endtable
5214
5215 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5216 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5217 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5218
5219
5220
5221 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5222 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5223 .cindex "format" "string"
5224 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5225 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5226 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5227 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5228 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5229 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5230 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5231 therefore equivalent:
5232 .code
5233 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5234 trusted_users = uucp:\
5235 # This comment line is ignored
5236 mail
5237 .endd
5238 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5239 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5240 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5241 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5242 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5243
5244 .table2 100pt
5245 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5246 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5247 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5248 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5249 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5250 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5251 character"
5252 .endtable
5253
5254 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5255 character, that character replaces the pair.
5256
5257 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5258 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5259 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5260 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5261 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5262 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5263
5264
5265 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5266 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5267 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5268 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5269 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5270 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5271 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5272 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5273 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5274 within a quoted configuration string.
5275
5276
5277 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5278 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5279 .cindex "format" "user name"
5280 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5281 .cindex "format" "group name"
5282 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5283 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5284 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5285 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5286
5287
5288 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5289 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5290 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5291 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5292 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5293 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5294 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5295 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5296 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5297 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5298 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5299
5300 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5301 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5302 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5303 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5304 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5305 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5306 example, the list
5307 .code
5308 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5309 .endd
5310 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5311
5312 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5313 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5314 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5315 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5316
5317 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5318 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5319 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5320 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5321 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5322 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5323 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5324 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5325 .code
5326 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5327 .endd
5328 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5329 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5330 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5331
5332 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5333 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5334 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5335 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5336 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5337 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5338 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5339 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5340 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5341 .code
5342 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5343 .endd
5344 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5345 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5346 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5347 the value in quotes. For example:
5348 .code
5349 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5350 .endd
5351 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5352 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5353 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5354 enclosing an empty list item.
5355
5356
5357
5358 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5359 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5360 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5361 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5362 .code
5363 senders = user@domain :
5364 .endd
5365 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5366 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5367 items, the second of which is empty:
5368 .code
5369 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5370 .endd
5371 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5372 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5373 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5374 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5375 .code
5376 senders = :
5377 .endd
5378 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5379 is at the end of the list.
5380
5381
5382
5383
5384 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5385 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5386 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5387 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5388 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5389 a sequence of lines like this:
5390 .display
5391 <&'instance name'&>:
5392 <&'option'&>
5393 ...
5394 <&'option'&>
5395 .endd
5396 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5397 followed by three options settings:
5398 .code
5399 localuser:
5400 driver = accept
5401 check_local_user
5402 transport = local_delivery
5403 .endd
5404 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5405 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5406 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5407 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5408 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5409 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5410
5411 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5412 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5413
5414 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5415 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5416 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5417 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5418 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5419 server.
5420
5421 .cindex "generic options"
5422 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5423 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5424 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5425 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5426 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5427 .cindex "private options"
5428 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5429 they all have default values.
5430
5431 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5432 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5433 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5434
5435 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5436 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5437 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5438 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5439 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5440 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5441 configuration lines:
5442 .code
5443 remote_smtp:
5444 driver = smtp
5445 .endd
5446 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5447 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5448 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5449 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5450 thus:
5451 .code
5452 special_smtp:
5453 driver = smtp
5454 port = 1234
5455 command_timeout = 10s
5456 .endd
5457 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5458 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5459 lines.
5460
5461 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5462 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5463 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5464 option.
5465
5466
5467
5468
5469
5470
5471 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5472 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5473
5474 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5475 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5476 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5477 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5478 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5479 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5480 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5481 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5482 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5483 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5484 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5485
5486
5487
5488 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5489 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5490 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5491 the line
5492 .code
5493 # primary_hostname =
5494 .endd
5495 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5496 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5497 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5498 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5499
5500 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5501 .code
5502 domainlist local_domains = @
5503 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5504 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5505 .endd
5506 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5507 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5508 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5509 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5510
5511 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5512 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5513 on the local host.
5514
5515 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5516 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5517 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5518 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5519 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5520 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5521
5522 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5523 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5524 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5525 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5526 domain is permitted.
5527
5528 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5529 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5530 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5531 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5532 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5533 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5534
5535 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5536 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5537 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5538
5539 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5540 .code
5541 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5542 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5543 .endd
5544 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5545 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5546 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5547 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5548 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5549 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5550 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5551 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5552 contents of a message to be checked.
5553
5554 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5555 .code
5556 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5557 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5558 .endd
5559 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5560 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5561 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5562 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5563
5564 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5565 .code
5566 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5567 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5568 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5569 .endd
5570 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5571 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5572 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5573 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5574 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5575 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5576 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5577
5578 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5579 .code
5580 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5581 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5582 .endd
5583 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5584 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5585 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5586 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5587 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5588 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5589 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5590 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5591 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5592 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5593 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5594 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5595 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5596 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5597 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5598 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5599 consequences).
5600 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5601 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5602 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5603 which should be used in preference to 587.
5604 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5605 these ports.
5606 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5607
5608 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5609 .code
5610 # qualify_domain =
5611 # qualify_recipient =
5612 .endd
5613 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5614 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5615 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5616 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5617 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5618 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5619
5620 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5621 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5622 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5623 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5624 .code
5625 # allow_domain_literals
5626 .endd
5627 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5628 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5629 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5630 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5631 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5632 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5633
5634 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5635 .code
5636 never_users = root
5637 .endd
5638 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5639 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5640 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5641 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5642 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5643 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5644 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5645 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5646
5647 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5648 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5649 line,
5650 .code
5651 host_lookup = *
5652 .endd
5653 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5654 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5655 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5656 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5657 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5658 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5659 unreachable.
5660
5661 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5662 1413 (hence their names):
5663 .code
5664 rfc1413_hosts = *
5665 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5666 .endd
5667 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5668 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5669 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5670 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5671 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5672 information, you can change this.
5673
5674 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5675 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5676 .code
5677 prdr_enable = true
5678 .endd
5679
5680 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5681 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5682 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5683 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5684 .code
5685 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5686 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5687 .endd
5688 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5689 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5690
5691 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5692 over the default:
5693 .code
5694 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5695 +tls_certificate_verified
5696 .endd
5697
5698 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5699 .code
5700 # percent_hack_domains =
5701 .endd
5702 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5703 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5704 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5705
5706 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5707 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5708 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5709 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5710 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5711 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5712 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5713 always bounce messages.
5714 .code
5715 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5716 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5717 .endd
5718 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5719 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5720 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5721 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5722 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5723
5724 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5725 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5726 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5727 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5728 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5729 not often needed).
5730 .code
5731 # split_spool_directory = true
5732 .endd
5733
5734 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5735 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5736 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5737 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5738 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5739 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5740 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5741 .code
5742 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5743 .endd
5744
5745 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5746 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5747 that are not 8-bit clean.
5748 .code
5749 # accept_8bitmime = false
5750 .endd
5751
5752 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5753 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5754 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5755 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5756 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5757 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5758 .code
5759 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5760 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5761 .endd
5762
5763
5764 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5765 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5766 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5767 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5768 It starts with the line
5769 .code
5770 begin acl
5771 .endd
5772 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5773 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5774 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5775
5776 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5777 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5778 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5779 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5780 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5781 result of the ACL processing.
5782 .code
5783 acl_check_rcpt:
5784 .endd
5785 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5786 ACL, and names it.
5787 .code
5788 accept hosts = :
5789 .endd
5790 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5791 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5792 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5793 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5794 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5795 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5796
5797 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5798 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5799 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5800 manner.
5801 .code
5802 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5803 domains = +local_domains
5804 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5805
5806 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5807 domains = !+local_domains
5808 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5809 .endd
5810 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5811 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5812 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5813 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5814 in Internet mail addresses.
5815
5816 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5817 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5818 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5819 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5820 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5821 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5822 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5823 policy of being as safe as possible.
5824
5825 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5826 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5827 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5828 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5829 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5830 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5831
5832 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5833 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5834 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5835 have to modify this rule.
5836
5837 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5838 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5839 common convention of local parts constructed as
5840 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5841 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5842 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5843 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5844 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5845 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5846
5847 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5848 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5849 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5850 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5851 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5852 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5853 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5854 .code
5855 accept local_parts = postmaster
5856 domains = +local_domains
5857 .endd
5858 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5859 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5860 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5861 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5862 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5863
5864 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5865 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5866 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5867 .code
5868 require verify = sender
5869 .endd
5870 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5871 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5872 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5873 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5874 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5875 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5876 discusses the details of address verification.
5877 .code
5878 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5879 control = submission
5880 .endd
5881 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5882 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5883 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5884 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5885 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5886 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5887 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5888 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5889 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5890 .code
5891 accept authenticated = *
5892 control = submission
5893 .endd
5894 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5895 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5896 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5897 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5898 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5899 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5900 .code
5901 require message = relay not permitted
5902 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5903 .endd
5904 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5905 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5906 .code
5907 require verify = recipient
5908 .endd
5909 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5910 fails, the address is rejected.
5911 .code
5912 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5913 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5914 # $dnslist_text
5915 # dnslists = black.list.example
5916 #
5917 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5918 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5919 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5920 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5921 .endd
5922 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5923 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5924 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5925 line.
5926 .code
5927 # require verify = csa
5928 .endd
5929 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5930 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5931 records.
5932 .code
5933 accept
5934 .endd
5935 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5936 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5937 .code
5938 acl_check_data:
5939 .endd
5940 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5941 of this ACL are commented out:
5942 .code
5943 # deny malware = *
5944 # message = This message contains a virus \
5945 # ($malware_name).
5946 .endd
5947 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5948 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5949 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5950 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5951 .code
5952 # warn spam = nobody
5953 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5954 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5955 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5956 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5957 .endd
5958 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5959 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5960 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5961 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5962 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5963 whatever the spam score.
5964 .code
5965 accept
5966 .endd
5967 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5968
5969
5970 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5971 .cindex "default" "routers"
5972 .cindex "routers" "default"
5973 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5974 by the line
5975 .code
5976 begin routers
5977 .endd
5978 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5979 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5980 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5981 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5982 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5983 .code
5984 # domain_literal:
5985 # driver = ipliteral
5986 # domains = !+local_domains
5987 # transport = remote_smtp
5988 .endd
5989 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5990 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5991 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5992 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5993 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5994 .code
5995 dnslookup:
5996 driver = dnslookup
5997 domains = ! +local_domains
5998 transport = remote_smtp
5999 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6000 no_more
6001 .endd
6002 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
6003 domains. This is specified by the line
6004 .code
6005 domains = ! +local_domains
6006 .endd
6007 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6008 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6009 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6010 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6011 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6012 passed on to the following routers.
6013
6014 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6015 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6016 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6017 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6018 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6019
6020 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6021 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6022 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6023 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6024 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6025 the address fails and is bounced.
6026
6027 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6028 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6029 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6030 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6031 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6032 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6033 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6034 out.
6035 .code
6036 system_aliases:
6037 driver = redirect
6038 allow_fail
6039 allow_defer
6040 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6041 # user = exim
6042 file_transport = address_file
6043 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6044 .endd
6045 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6046 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6047 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6048 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6049 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6050 the next router.
6051
6052 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6053 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6054 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6055 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6056 .code
6057 userforward:
6058 driver = redirect
6059 check_local_user
6060 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6061 # local_part_suffix_optional
6062 file = $home/.forward
6063 # allow_filter
6064 no_verify
6065 no_expn
6066 check_ancestor
6067 file_transport = address_file
6068 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6069 reply_transport = address_reply
6070 .endd
6071 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6072 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6073 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6074 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6075 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6076 namely:
6077 .code
6078 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6079 # local_part_suffix_optional
6080 .endd
6081 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6082 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6083 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6084 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6085 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6086 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6087 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6088
6089 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6090 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6091 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6092 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6093
6094 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6095 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6096 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6097 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6098 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6099 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6100 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6101
6102 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6103 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6104 There are two reasons for doing this:
6105
6106 .olist
6107 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6108 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6109 unnecessary work.
6110 .next
6111 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6112 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6113 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6114 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6115 this time.
6116 .endlist
6117
6118 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6119 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6120 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6121 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6122
6123 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6124 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6125 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6126 .code
6127 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6128 .endd
6129 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6130 transport.
6131 .code
6132 localuser:
6133 driver = accept
6134 check_local_user
6135 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6136 # local_part_suffix_optional
6137 transport = local_delivery
6138 .endd
6139 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6140 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6141 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6142 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6143 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6144
6145
6146 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6147 .cindex "default" "transports"
6148 .cindex "transports" "default"
6149 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6150 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6151 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6152 .code
6153 begin transports
6154 .endd
6155 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6156 .code
6157 remote_smtp:
6158 driver = smtp
6159 hosts_try_prdr = *
6160 .endd
6161 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6162 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6163 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6164 It is negotiated between client and server
6165 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6166 All other options are defaulted.
6167 .code
6168 local_delivery:
6169 driver = appendfile
6170 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6171 delivery_date_add
6172 envelope_to_add
6173 return_path_add
6174 # group = mail
6175 # mode = 0660
6176 .endd
6177 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6178 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6179 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6180 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6181 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6182 show how this can be done.
6183
6184 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6185 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6186 similarly-named options above.
6187 .code
6188 address_pipe:
6189 driver = pipe
6190 return_output
6191 .endd
6192 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6193 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6194 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6195 be returned to the sender.
6196 .code
6197 address_file:
6198 driver = appendfile
6199 delivery_date_add
6200 envelope_to_add
6201 return_path_add
6202 .endd
6203 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6204 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6205 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6206 .code
6207 address_reply:
6208 driver = autoreply
6209 .endd
6210 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6211 filter files.
6212
6213
6214
6215 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6216 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6217 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6218 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6219 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6220 introduced by the line
6221 .code
6222 begin retry
6223 .endd
6224 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6225 errors:
6226 .code
6227 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6228 .endd
6229 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6230 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6231 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6232 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6233 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6234
6235 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6236 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6237 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6238
6239
6240 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6241 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6242 .code
6243 begin rewrite
6244 .endd
6245 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6246 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6247
6248
6249
6250 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6251 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6252 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6253 .code
6254 begin authenticators
6255 .endd
6256 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6257 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6258 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6259 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6260 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6261 to support most MUA software.
6262
6263 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6264 .code
6265 #PLAIN:
6266 # driver = plaintext
6267 # server_set_id = $auth2
6268 # server_prompts = :
6269 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6270 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6271 .endd
6272 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6273 .code
6274 #LOGIN:
6275 # driver = plaintext
6276 # server_set_id = $auth1
6277 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6278 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6279 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6280 .endd
6281
6282 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6283 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6284 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6285 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6286 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6287 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6288 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6289 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6290
6291 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6292 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6293 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6294 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6295
6296 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6297 usercode and password are in different positions.
6298 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6299
6300 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6301
6302
6303
6304 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6305 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6306
6307 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6308
6309 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6310 .cindex "PCRE"
6311 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6312 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6313 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6314 regular expressions is discussed in
6315 online Perl manpages, in
6316 many Perl reference books, and also in
6317 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6318 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6319
6320 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6321 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6322 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6323 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6324 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6325 case-insensitive.
6326
6327 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6328 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6329 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6330 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6331 .code
6332 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6333 .endd
6334 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6335 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6336 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6337 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6338 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6339 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6340 matched.
6341
6342 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6343 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6344 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6345 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6346 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6347 match anywhere in the subject string.
6348
6349 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6350 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6351 .code
6352 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6353 .endd
6354 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6355 You need to use:
6356 .code
6357 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6358 .endd
6359 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6360 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6361
6362
6363
6364 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6365 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6366
6367 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6368 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6369 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6370 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6371 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6372 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6373
6374 .olist
6375 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6376 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6377 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6378 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6379 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6380 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6381 .next
6382 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6383 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6384 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6385 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6386 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6387 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6388 .endlist
6389
6390 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6391 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6392 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6393 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6394 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6395 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6396
6397 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6398 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6399 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6400 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6401 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6402 .code
6403 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6404 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6405 .endd
6406 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6407 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6408 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6409 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6410 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6411 .code
6412 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6413 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6414 .endd
6415 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6416 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6417
6418 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6419 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6420 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6421 .code
6422 domain1:
6423 domain2:
6424 .endd
6425 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6426 matches the list item.
6427
6428 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6429 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6430 .code
6431 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6432 .endd
6433 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6434 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6435 causes a second lookup to occur.
6436
6437 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6438 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6439 lookup is permitted.
6440
6441
6442 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6443 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6444 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6445 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6446
6447 .ilist
6448 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6449 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6450 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6451 .next
6452 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6453 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6454 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6455 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6456 .endlist
6457
6458 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6459 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6460 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6461 .code
6462 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6463 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6464 .endd
6465 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6466 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6467 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6468
6469
6470
6471
6472 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6473 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6474 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6475 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6476
6477 .ilist
6478 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6479 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6480 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6481 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6482 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6483 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6484 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6485 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6486 be found in several places:
6487 .display
6488 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6489 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6490 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6491 .endd
6492 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6493 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6494 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6495 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6496 .next
6497 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6498 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6499 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6500 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6501 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6502 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6503 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6504
6505 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6506 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6507 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6508 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6509 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6510 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6511 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6512 .next
6513 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6514 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6515 .cindex "sasldb2"
6516 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6517 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6518 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6519 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6520 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6521 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6522 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6523 .next
6524 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6525 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6526 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6527 .cindex "Courier"
6528 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6529 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6530 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6531 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6532 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6533 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6534 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6535 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6536 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6537 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6538 .next
6539 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6540 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6541 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6542 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6543 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6544 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6545 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6546 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6547 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6548 .next
6549 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6550 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6551 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6552 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6553 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6554 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6555 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6556 .code
6557 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6558 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6559 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6560 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6561 .endd
6562 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6563 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6564 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6565 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6566 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6567
6568 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6569 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6570 lookup types support only literal keys.
6571
6572 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6573 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6574 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6575 .next
6576 .cindex "linear search"
6577 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6578 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6579 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6580 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6581 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6582 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6583 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6584 in the file is used.
6585
6586 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6587 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6588 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6589 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6590 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6591 colon, for example:
6592 .code
6593 baduser: :fail:
6594 .endd
6595 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6596 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6597 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6598 wildcarding of any kind.
6599
6600 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6601 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6602 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6603 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6604 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6605 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6606 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6607 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6608 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6609
6610 .next
6611 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6612 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6613 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6614 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6615 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6616 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6617 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6618 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6619
6620 .next
6621 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6622 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6623 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6624 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6625 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6626 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6627 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6628 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6629 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6630
6631 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6632 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6633 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6634 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6635
6636 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6637 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6638
6639 .olist
6640 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6641 .code
6642 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6643 *fish data for anythingfish
6644 .endd
6645 .next
6646 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6647 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6648 .code
6649 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6650 .endd
6651 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6652 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6653 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6654 .code
6655 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6656 .endd
6657 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6658 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6659 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6660 .code
6661 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6662 .endd
6663
6664 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6665 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6666 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6667 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6668 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6669
6670 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6671 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6672 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6673 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6674 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6675
6676 .next
6677 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6678 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6679 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6680 example:
6681 .code
6682 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6683 .endd
6684 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6685 .endlist olist
6686
6687 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6688 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6689 be followed by optional colons.
6690
6691 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6692 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6693 lookup types support only literal keys.
6694 .endlist ilist
6695
6696
6697 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6698 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6699 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6700 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6701 many of them are given in later sections.
6702
6703 .ilist
6704 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6705 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6706 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6707 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6708 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6709 .next
6710 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6711 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6712 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6713 .next
6714 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6715 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6716 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6717 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6718 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6719 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6720 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6721 .next
6722 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6723 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6724 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6725 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6726 .next
6727 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6728 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6729 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6730 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6731 .next
6732 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6733 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6734 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6735 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6736 .next
6737 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6738 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6739 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6740 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6741 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6742 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6743 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6744 password value. For example:
6745 .code
6746 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6747 .endd
6748 .next
6749 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6750 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6751 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6752 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6753
6754 .next
6755 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6756 .cindex lookup Redis
6757 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6758 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6759
6760 .next
6761 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6762 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6763 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6764 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6765
6766 .next
6767 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6768 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6769 .next
6770 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6771 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6772 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6773 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6774 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6775 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6776 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6777 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6778 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6779 .code
6780 require condition = \
6781 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6782 .endd
6783 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6784 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6785 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6786 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6787 .endlist
6788
6789
6790
6791 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6792 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6793 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6794 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6795 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6796 options such as a list of local domains.
6797
6798 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6799 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6800 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6801 or may give up altogether.
6802
6803
6804
6805 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6806 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6807 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6808 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6809 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6810 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6811 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6812 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6813
6814 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6815 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6816 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6817
6818 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6819 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6820 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6821
6822 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6823 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6824 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6825 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6826 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6827 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6828 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6829 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6830 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6831 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6832 .code
6833 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6834 .endd
6835 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6836 looks up these keys, in this order:
6837 .code
6838 jane@eyre.example
6839 *@eyre.example
6840 *
6841 .endd
6842 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6843 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6844 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6845 Exim move on to try the next key.
6846
6847
6848
6849 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6850 .cindex "partial matching"
6851 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6852 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6853 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6854 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6855 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6856 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6857 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6858 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6859 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6860 a key in a DBM file is
6861 .code
6862 *.dates.fict.example
6863 .endd
6864 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6865 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6866 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6867 file.
6868
6869 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6870 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6871 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6872
6873 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6874 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6875 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6876 partial matching keys
6877 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6878 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6879 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6880
6881 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6882 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6883 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6884 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6885 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6886 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6887 remains.
6888
6889 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6890 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6891 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6892 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6893 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6894 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6895 .code
6896 2250.dates.fict.example
6897 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6898 *.dates.fict.example
6899 *.fict.example
6900 .endd
6901 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6902 finishes.
6903
6904 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6905 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6906 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6907 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6908 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6909 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6910 .code
6911 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6912 .endd
6913 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6914 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6915 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6916 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6917 .code
6918 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6919 .endd
6920 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6921 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6922
6923 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6924 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6925 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6926
6927 .ilist
6928 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6929 .next
6930 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6931 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6932 .next
6933 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6934 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6935 for &"*"& on its own.
6936 .next
6937 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6938 .endlist
6939
6940
6941 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6942 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6943 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6944 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6945 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6946 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6947 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6948
6949 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6950 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6951 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6952 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6953 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6954
6955
6956
6957
6958 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6959 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6960 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6961 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6962 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6963 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6964 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6965
6966 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6967 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6968 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6969 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6970 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6971 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6972
6973 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6974 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6975 complete.
6976
6977
6978
6979
6980 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6981 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6982 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6983 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6984 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6985 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6986 .code
6987 [name=$local_part]
6988 .endd
6989 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6990 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6991 .code
6992 [name="$local_part"]
6993 .endd
6994 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6995 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6996 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6997 of the following form is provided:
6998 .code
6999 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7000 .endd
7001 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7002 .code
7003 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7004 .endd
7005 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7006 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7007 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7008
7009
7010
7011
7012 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7013 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7014 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7015 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7016 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7017 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7018 an expansion string could contain:
7019 .code
7020 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7021 .endd
7022 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7023 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7024 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7025 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7026
7027 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7028 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7029 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7030
7031 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7032 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7033 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7034 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7035 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7036 .code
7037 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7038 .endd
7039 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7040 white space is ignored.
7041 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7042 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7043 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7044
7045 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7046 When the type is PTR,
7047 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7048 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7049 .code
7050 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7051 .endd
7052 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7053 altered and nothing is added.
7054
7055 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7056 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7057 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7058 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7059 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7060 The field separator can be modified as above.
7061
7062 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7063 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7064 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7065 unless a field separator is specified.
7066 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7067 For SPF records the
7068 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7069 .code
7070 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7071 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7072 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7073 .endd
7074 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7075 white space is ignored.
7076
7077 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7078 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7079 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7080 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7081 specified.
7082 .code
7083 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7084 .endd
7085
7086 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7087 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7088 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7089 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7090 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7091 each followed by a comma,
7092 that may appear before the record type.
7093
7094 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7095 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7096 a defer-option modifier.
7097 The possible keywords are
7098 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7099 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7100 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7101 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7102 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7103 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7104 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7105 .code
7106 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7107 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7108 .endd
7109 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7110 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7111
7112 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7113 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7114 The possible keywords are
7115 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7116 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7117 with the lookup.
7118 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7119 is not labelled as authenticated data
7120 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7121 The default is &"never"&.
7122
7123 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7124
7125 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7126 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7127 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7128 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7129 (e.g. &"5s"&).
7130 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7131
7132 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7133 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7134 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7135
7136 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7137 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7138 .cindex DNS TTL
7139 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7140 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7141 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7142
7143
7144 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7145 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7146 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7147 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7148 the pseudo-type MXH:
7149 .code
7150 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7151 .endd
7152 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7153 returned.
7154
7155 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7156 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7157 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7158 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7159 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7160 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7161 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7162 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7163 .code
7164 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7165 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7166 .endd
7167 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7168 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7169 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7170
7171 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7172 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7173 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7174 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7175 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7176 such a list.
7177
7178 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7179 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7180 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7181 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7182 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7183 result of a successful lookup such as:
7184 .code
7185 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7186 .endd
7187 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7188 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7189 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7190
7191 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7192 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7193 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7194 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7195 .code
7196 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7197 .endd
7198
7199
7200 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7201 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7202 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7203 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7204 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7205 .code
7206 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7207 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7208 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7209 .endd
7210 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7211 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7212 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7213 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7214
7215 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7216 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7217 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7218
7219
7220
7221
7222 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7223 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7224 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7225 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7226 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7227 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7228 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7229 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7230 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7231 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7232 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7233 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7234 .code
7235 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7236 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7237 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7238 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7239 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7240 .endd
7241 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7242 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7243
7244 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7245 the way they handle the results of a query:
7246
7247 .ilist
7248 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7249 gives an error.
7250 .next
7251 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7252 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7253 .next
7254 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7255 from all of them are returned.
7256 .endlist
7257
7258
7259 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7260 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7261 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7262 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7263
7264
7265 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7266 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7267 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7268 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7269 .code
7270 data = ${lookup ldap \
7271 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7272 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7273 .endd
7274 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7275 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7276 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7277 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7278
7279 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7280 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7281 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7282
7283 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7284 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7285 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7286 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7287 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7288 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7289 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7290 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7291 &_exim.conf_&.
7292
7293
7294 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7295 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7296 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7297 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7298 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7299 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7300
7301 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7302 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7303 the string:
7304 .code
7305 * => \2A
7306 ( => \28
7307 ) => \29
7308 \ => \5C
7309 .endd
7310 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7311 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7312 .code
7313 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7314 .endd
7315 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7316 .code
7317 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7318 .endd
7319 yields
7320 .code
7321 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7322 .endd
7323 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7324 .code
7325 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7326 .endd
7327 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7328 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7329 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7330 .code
7331 , + " \ < > ;
7332 .endd
7333 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7334 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7335 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7336 .code
7337 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7338 .endd
7339 yields
7340 .code
7341 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7342 .endd
7343 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7344 .code
7345 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7346 .endd
7347 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7348 authentication below.
7349
7350
7351 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7352 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7353 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7354 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7355 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7356 by starting it with
7357 .code
7358 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7359 .endd
7360 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7361 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7362 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7363 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7364 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7365 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7366 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7367 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7368 failures, and timeouts.
7369
7370 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7371 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7372 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7373 doubled. For example
7374 .code
7375 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7376 .endd
7377 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7378 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7379 the local host) is used.
7380
7381 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7382 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7383 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7384 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7385 not available.
7386
7387 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7388 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7389 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7390 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7391 .code
7392 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7393 .endd
7394 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7395 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7396 .code
7397 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7398 .endd
7399 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7400 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7401 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7402 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7403 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7404 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7405 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7406 backup host.
7407
7408 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7409 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7410 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7411
7412 .ilist
7413 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7414 interface.
7415 .next
7416 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7417 .endlist
7418
7419
7420 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7421 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7422
7423
7424
7425 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7426 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7427 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7428 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7429 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7430 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7431 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7432 them. The following names are recognized:
7433 .display
7434 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7435 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7436 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7437 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7438 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7439 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7440 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7441 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7442 .endd
7443 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7444 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7445 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7446 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7447
7448 .cindex LDAP timeout
7449 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7450 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7451 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7452 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7453 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7454 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7455 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7456 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7457 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7458 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7459
7460 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7461 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7462
7463 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7464 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7465 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7466 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7467 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7468 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7469 alternate list (colon-separated).
7470
7471 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7472 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7473 .code
7474 ${lookup ldap
7475 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7476 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7477 {$value}fail}
7478 .endd
7479 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7480 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7481 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7482 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7483
7484 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7485 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7486 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7487
7488 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7489 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7490 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7491 quoting has two advantages:
7492
7493 .ilist
7494 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7495 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7496 .next
7497 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7498 .endlist
7499
7500 For example, a setting such as
7501 .code
7502 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7503 .endd
7504 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7505
7506 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7507 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7508 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7509 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7510 .code
7511 PASS=${quote:$3}
7512 .endd
7513 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7514 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7515 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7516
7517
7518
7519 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7520 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7521 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7522 as a sequence of values, for example
7523 .code
7524 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7525 .endd
7526 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7527 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7528 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7529 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7530 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7531 directory.
7532
7533 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7534 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7535 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7536 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7537
7538 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7539 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7540 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7541 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7542 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7543 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7544 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7545 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7546 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7547
7548 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7549 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7550 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7551 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7552 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7553
7554 .code
7555 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7556 value1.1,value1,,2
7557
7558 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7559 value two
7560
7561 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7562 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7563
7564 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7565 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7566
7567 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7568 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7569 .endd
7570 You can
7571 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7572 results of LDAP lookups.
7573 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7574 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7575 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7576 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7577 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7578 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7579
7580
7581
7582
7583 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7584 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7585 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7586 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7587 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7588 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7589 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7590 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7591 .code
7592 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7593 .endd
7594 might return the string
7595 .code
7596 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7597 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7598 .endd
7599 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7600 .code
7601 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7602 .endd
7603 would just return
7604 .code
7605 Martin Guerre
7606 .endd
7607 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7608 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7609 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7610
7611
7612
7613 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7614 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7615 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7616 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7617 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7618 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7619 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7620 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7621 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7622 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7623 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7624 .cindex lookup Redis
7625 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7626 and SQLite
7627 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7628 might be
7629 .code
7630 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7631 {$value}fail}
7632 .endd
7633 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7634 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7635 .code
7636 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7637 {$value}}
7638 .endd
7639 might be
7640 .code
7641 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7642 .endd
7643 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7644 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7645 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7646 .code
7647 Mister X
7648 .endd
7649 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7650 with a newline between the data for each row.
7651
7652
7653 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7654 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7655 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7656 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7657 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7658 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7659 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7660 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7661 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7662 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7663 .cindex lookup Redis
7664 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7665 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7666 or &%redis_servers%&
7667 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7668 information.
7669 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7670 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7671 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7672 For all but Redis
7673 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7674 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7675 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7676 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7677 .code
7678 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7679 .endd
7680 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7681 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7682 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7683 .code
7684 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7685 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7686 .endd
7687 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7688 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7689 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7690 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7691 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7692 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7693
7694 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7695 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7696 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7697 information.
7698 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7699 host, database number, and password.
7700 .olist
7701 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7702 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7703 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7704 .next
7705 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7706 .next
7707 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7708 .endlist
7709
7710 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7711 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7712 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7713 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7714
7715 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7716 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7717
7718 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7719 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7720 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7721 done by starting the query with
7722 .display
7723 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7724 .endd
7725 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7726 .olist
7727 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7728 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7729 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7730 taken from there.
7731 .next
7732 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7733 .endlist
7734 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7735 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7736 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7737
7738 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7739 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7740 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7741 like this:
7742 .code
7743 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7744 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7745 master/db/name/pw
7746 .endd
7747 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7748 .code
7749 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7750 .endd
7751 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7752 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7753 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7754 .code
7755 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7756 .endd
7757
7758
7759 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7760 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7761 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7762 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7763 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7764 the default value is &"exim"&.
7765 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7766 .display
7767 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7768 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7769 .endd
7770 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7771 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7772
7773 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7774 the queries.
7775
7776 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7777 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7778
7779 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7780 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7781 is zero because no rows are affected.
7782
7783
7784 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7785 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7786 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7787 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7788 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7789 looks like this:
7790 .code
7791 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7792 .endd
7793 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7794 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7795 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7796
7797 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7798 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7799 affected.
7800
7801 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7802 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7803 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7804 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7805 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7806 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7807 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7808 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7809 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7810 .code
7811 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7812 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7813 .endd
7814 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7815 .code
7816 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7817 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7818 .endd
7819 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7820 quote, which it doubles.
7821
7822 .cindex timeout SQLite
7823 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
7824 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7825 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7826 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7827 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7828 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7829 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7830 option.
7831
7832 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
7833 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
7834 .cindex "redis lookup type"
7835 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
7836 Examples:
7837 .code
7838 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
7839 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
7840 .endd
7841
7842 .new
7843 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
7844 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
7845 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
7846 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
7847 servers.
7848
7849 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, exim does not
7850 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
7851 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
7852 reached.
7853 .wen
7854
7855 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7856 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7857
7858
7859 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7860 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7861
7862 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7863 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7864 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7865 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7866 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7867 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7868 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7869 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7870 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7871
7872 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7873 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7874 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7875 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7876
7877 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7878 support all the complexity available in
7879 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7880
7881
7882
7883 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
7884 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7885 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
7886
7887 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
7888 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
7889
7890 The result of
7891 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7892 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7893 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7894 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7895 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7896
7897
7898 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7899 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7900 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7901
7902 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7903 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7904 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7905 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7906 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7907 .code
7908 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7909 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7910 .endd
7911 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7912 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7913 senders based on the receiving domain.
7914
7915
7916
7917
7918 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7919 .cindex "list" "negation"
7920 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7921 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7922 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7923 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7924 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7925 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7926
7927 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7928 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7929 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7930 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7931 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7932 .code
7933 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7934 .endd
7935 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7936 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7937 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7938 .code
7939 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7940 .endd
7941 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7942 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7943 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7944
7945 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7946 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7947 item.
7948
7949
7950
7951 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7952 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7953 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7954 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7955 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7956 file names are not allowed,
7957 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7958 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7959 lines:
7960
7961 .ilist
7962 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7963 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7964 .next
7965 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7966 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7967 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7968 .code
7969 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7970 .endd
7971 .endlist
7972
7973 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7974 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7975 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7976 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7977
7978 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7979 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7980 .code
7981 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7982 .endd
7983 and the file contains the lines
7984 .code
7985 !a.b.c
7986 *.b.c
7987 .endd
7988 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7989 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7990
7991
7992
7993 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7994 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7995 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7996 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7997 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7998 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7999 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8000 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8001
8002 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8003 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
8004 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8005 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8006
8007
8008
8009
8010 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8011 .cindex "named lists"
8012 .cindex "list" "named"
8013 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8014 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8015 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8016 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8017 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8018 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8019 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8020 .code
8021 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8022 .endd
8023 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8024 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8025 configured with the line
8026 .code
8027 domains = +local_domains
8028 .endd
8029 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8030 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8031 .code
8032 dnslookup:
8033 driver = dnslookup
8034 domains = ! +local_domains
8035 transport = remote_smtp
8036 no_more
8037 .endd
8038 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8039 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8040 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8041 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8042 .code
8043 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8044 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8045 .endd
8046 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8047 .code
8048 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8049 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8050 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8051 .endd
8052 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8053 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8054 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8055 .code
8056 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8057 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8058 .endd
8059 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8060 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8061 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8062 .code
8063 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8064 .endd
8065 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8066 referenced lists if you can.
8067
8068 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8069 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8070 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8071 .code
8072 domains = +local_domains
8073 .endd
8074 on several of your routers
8075 or in several ACL statements,
8076 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8077 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8078 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8079 the same each time they are referenced.
8080
8081 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8082 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8083 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8084 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8085
8086
8087
8088 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8089 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8090 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8091 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8092 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8093 write
8094 .code
8095 ALIST = host1 : host2
8096 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8097 .endd
8098 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8099 .code
8100 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8101 .endd
8102 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8103 list, and write
8104 .code
8105 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8106 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8107 .endd
8108 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8109 .code
8110 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8111 .endd
8112
8113
8114 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8115 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8116 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8117 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8118 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8119 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8120 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8121 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8122 message. For example:
8123 .code
8124 domainlist special_domains = \
8125 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8126 .endd
8127 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8128 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8129 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8130 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8131 same list each time.
8132
8133 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8134 cache the result anyway. For example:
8135 .code
8136 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8137 .endd
8138 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8139 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8140
8141
8142
8143 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8144 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8145 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8146 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8147 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8148
8149 .ilist
8150 .cindex "primary host name"
8151 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8152 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8153 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8154 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8155 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8156 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8157 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8158 differ only in their names.
8159 .next
8160 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8161 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8162 .cindex "domain literal"
8163 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8164 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8165 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8166 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8167 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8168 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8169 .next
8170 .cindex "@mx_any"
8171 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8172 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8173 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8174 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8175 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8176 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8177 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8178 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8179 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8180 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8181 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8182
8183 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8184 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8185 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8186 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8187 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8188
8189 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8190 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8191 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8192 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8193 on a router). For example:
8194 .code
8195 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8196 .endd
8197 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8198 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8199
8200 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8201 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8202 contain negative items.
8203
8204 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8205 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8206 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8207 .code
8208 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8209 an.other.domain : ...
8210 .endd
8211 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8212 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8213 .code
8214 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8215 an.other.domain ? ...
8216 .endd
8217 .next
8218 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8219 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8220 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8221 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8222 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8223 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8224 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8225 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8226 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8227 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8228
8229 .next
8230 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8231 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8232 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8233 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8234 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8235 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8236 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8237 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8238 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8239
8240 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8241 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8242 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8243 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8244 expression by expansion, of course).
8245 .next
8246 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8247 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8248 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8249 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8250 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8251 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8252 .code
8253 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8254 .endd
8255 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8256 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8257 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8258 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8259 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8260 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8261 other statements in the same ACL.
8262
8263 .next
8264 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8265 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8266 .code
8267 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8268 .endd
8269 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8270 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8271
8272 .next
8273 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8274 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8275 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8276 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8277 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8278 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8279 expansion variable.
8280 .next
8281 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8282 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8283 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8284 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8285 .code
8286 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8287 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8288 .endd
8289 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8290 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8291 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8292 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8293 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8294 .next
8295 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8296 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8297 between the pattern and the domain.
8298 .endlist
8299
8300 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8301 .code
8302 domainlist funny_domains = \
8303 @ : \
8304 lib.unseen.edu : \
8305 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8306 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8307 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8308 nis;domains.byname : \
8309 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8310 .endd
8311 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8312 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8313 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8314 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8315 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8316 patterns earlier.
8317
8318
8319
8320 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8321 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8322 .cindex "list" "host list"
8323 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8324 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8325 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8326 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8327 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8328 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8329 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8330
8331
8332 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8333 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8334 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8335 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8336 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8337 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8338 not used.
8339
8340 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8341 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8342 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8343
8344
8345
8346 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8347 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8348 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8349 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8350 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8351 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8352 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8353 concerns.)
8354
8355 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8356 inspecting its IP address:
8357
8358 .ilist
8359 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8360 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8361 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8362 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8363 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8364 with the IP address of the subject host.
8365
8366 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8367 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8368 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8369 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8370 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8371
8372 .next
8373 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8374 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8375 domain name, as just described.
8376
8377 .next
8378 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8379 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8380 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8381 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8382 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8383 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8384 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8385 that can never match a client host.
8386
8387 .next
8388 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8389 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8390 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8391 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8392 .code
8393 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8394 accept hosts = @[]
8395 .endd
8396 .next
8397 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8398 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8399 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8400 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8401 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8402 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8403 significant end of the address.
8404
8405 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8406 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8407 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8408 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8409 .code
8410 192.168.23.236/31
8411 .endd
8412 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8413 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8414 matches.
8415
8416 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8417 .code
8418 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8419 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8420 .endd
8421 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8422 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8423 For example:
8424 .code
8425 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8426 .endd
8427 could make use of a file containing
8428 .code
8429 172.16.0.0/12
8430 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8431 .endd
8432 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8433 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8434 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8435 .code
8436 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8437 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8438 .endd
8439 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8440 list.
8441 .endlist
8442
8443
8444
8445 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8446 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8447 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8448 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8449 address, the pattern takes this form:
8450 .display
8451 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8452 .endd
8453 For example:
8454 .code
8455 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8456 .endd
8457 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8458 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8459 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8460 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8461 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8462 returned by the lookup is not used.
8463
8464 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8465 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8466 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8467 patterns of this form:
8468 .display
8469 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8470 .endd
8471 For example:
8472 .code
8473 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8474 .endd
8475 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8476 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8477 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8478 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8479 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8480
8481 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8482 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8483 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8484 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8485 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8486 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8487 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8488 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8489 addresses are always used.
8490
8491 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8492 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8493 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8494 configurations.
8495
8496 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8497 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8498 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8499 case the IP address is used on its own.
8500
8501
8502
8503 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8504 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8505 .cindex "unknown host name"
8506 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8507 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8508 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8509 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8510 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8511 above.)
8512
8513 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8514 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8515 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8516 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8517 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8518 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8519 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8520
8521 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8522 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8523
8524 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8525 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8526 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8527 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8528 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8529 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8530 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8531 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8532 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8533
8534 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8535 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8536
8537 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8538 .cindex "alias for host"
8539 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8540 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8541
8542 .ilist
8543 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8544 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8545 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8546 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8547 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8548 expression.
8549 .next
8550 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8551 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8552 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8553 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8554 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8555 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8556 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8557 example,
8558 .code
8559 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8560 .endd
8561 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8562 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8563 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8564 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8565 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8566 .code
8567 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8568 .endd
8569 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8570 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8571 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8572 required.
8573 .endlist
8574
8575
8576
8577
8578 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8579 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8580 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8581 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8582 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8583 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8584
8585 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8586 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8587
8588 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8589 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8590 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8591 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8592 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8593 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8594 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8595 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8596 not recognized in an indirected file).
8597
8598 .ilist
8599 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8600 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8601 .code
8602 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8603 .endd
8604 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8605 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8606
8607 .next
8608 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8609 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8610 example:
8611 .code
8612 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8613 192.168.4.5
8614 .endd
8615 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8616 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8617 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8618 .endlist
8619
8620 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8621 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8622 list.
8623
8624 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8625 "SECTmixwilhos"
8626 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8627
8628 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8629 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8630 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8631
8632 .ilist
8633 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8634 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8635 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8636 .code
8637 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8638 .endd
8639 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8640 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8641 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8642 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8643 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8644 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8645 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8646
8647 .next
8648 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8649 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8650 .code
8651 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8652 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8653 .endd
8654 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8655 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8656 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8657 this section.
8658 .endlist
8659
8660
8661 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8662 "SECTtemdnserr"
8663 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8664 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8665 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8666 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8667 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8668 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8669 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8670 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8671 host lists such as whitelists.
8672
8673
8674
8675 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8676 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8677 .cindex "unknown host name"
8678 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8679 If a pattern is of the form
8680 .display
8681 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8682 .endd
8683 for example
8684 .code
8685 dbm;/host/accept/list
8686 .endd
8687 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8688 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8689 is not used.
8690
8691 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8692 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8693 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8694 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8695 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8696 lookup, both using the same file.
8697
8698
8699
8700 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8701 If a pattern is of the form
8702 .display
8703 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8704 .endd
8705 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8706 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8707 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8708 .code
8709 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8710 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8711 .endd
8712 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8713 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8714 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8715 operator.
8716
8717 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8718 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8719 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8720
8721 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8722 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8723 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8724 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8725 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8726 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8727
8728
8729
8730
8731
8732 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8733 .cindex "list" "address list"
8734 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8735 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8736 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8737 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8738 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8739 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8740 using this option setting:
8741 .code
8742 senders = :
8743 .endd
8744 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8745 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8746 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8747 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8748
8749 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8750 example:
8751 .code
8752 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8753 .endd
8754 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8755 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8756 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8757 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8758 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8759 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8760 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8761 .code
8762 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8763 *@+hostile_domains:\
8764 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8765 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8766 .endd
8767 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8768 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8769 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8770 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8771 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8772
8773 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8774 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8775 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8776 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8777 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8778 .code
8779 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8780 .endd
8781
8782 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8783 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8784 senders:
8785
8786 .ilist
8787 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8788 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8789 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8790 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8791 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8792 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8793 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8794 .code
8795 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8796 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8797 .endd
8798 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8799 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8800
8801 .next
8802 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8803 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8804 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8805 example:
8806 .code
8807 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8808 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8809 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8810 .endd
8811 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8812 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8813 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8814 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8815
8816 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8817 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8818 panic log.
8819 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8820 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8821 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8822 default. For example, with this lookup:
8823 .code
8824 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8825 .endd
8826 the file could contains lines like this:
8827 .code
8828 user1@domain1.example
8829 *@domain2.example
8830 .endd
8831 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8832 that are tried is:
8833 .code
8834 nimrod@jaeger.example
8835 *@jaeger.example
8836 *
8837 .endd
8838 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8839 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8840
8841 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8842 .code
8843 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8844 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8845 .endd
8846 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8847 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8848 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8849 .endlist
8850
8851
8852 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8853 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8854 always fails.
8855
8856
8857 .ilist
8858 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8859 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8860 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8861 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8862 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8863 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8864 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8865 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8866 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8867
8868 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8869 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8870 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8871 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8872 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8873 with
8874 .code
8875 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8876 .endd
8877 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8878 .code
8879 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8880 .endd
8881 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8882
8883 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8884 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8885 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8886 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8887 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8888 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8889 .code
8890 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8891 spammer3 : spammer4
8892 .endd
8893 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8894 doubling.
8895
8896 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8897 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8898 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8899 might have entries like
8900 .code
8901 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8902 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8903 *: ^\d{8}$
8904 .endd
8905 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8906 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8907 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8908 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8909
8910 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8911 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8912 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8913
8914 .next
8915 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8916 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8917 can only return a single list of local parts.
8918 .endlist
8919
8920 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8921 in these two examples:
8922 .code
8923 senders = +my_list
8924 senders = *@+my_list
8925 .endd
8926 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8927 example it is a named domain list.
8928
8929
8930
8931
8932 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8933 .cindex "case of local parts"
8934 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8935 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8936 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8937 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8938 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8939 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8940 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8941 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8942 default.
8943
8944 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8945 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8946 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8947 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8948 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8949 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8950 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8951 case-independent.
8952
8953 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8954 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8955 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8956 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8957 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8958 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8959 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8960 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8961
8962
8963
8964 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8965 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8966 .cindex "local part" "list"
8967 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8968 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8969 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8970 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8971 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8972 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8973 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8974 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8975
8976 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8977 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8978 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8979 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8980 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8981 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8982 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8983 types.
8984 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8985
8986
8987
8988
8989 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8990 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8991
8992 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8993 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8994 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8995 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8996
8997 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8998 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8999 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9000 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9001 escape character, as described in the following section.
9002
9003 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9004 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9005 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
9006 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9007 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9008 reasons.
9009
9010
9011
9012 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9013 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9014 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9015 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9016 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9017 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9018 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9019 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9020
9021 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9022 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9023 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9024 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9025 .code
9026 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9027 .endd
9028 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9029 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9030 string.
9031
9032
9033
9034 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9035 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9036 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9037 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9038 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9039 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9040 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9041 encoding.
9042
9043 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9044 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9045 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9046
9047
9048 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9049 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9050 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9051 .oindex "&%-be%&"
9052 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9053 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9054 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9055 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9056 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9057 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9058 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9059 and &%nhash%&.
9060
9061 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9062 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9063 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9064
9065 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
9066 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9067 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9068 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
9069 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9070 .code
9071 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9072 .endd
9073 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9074 Exim message identifier. For example:
9075 .code
9076 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9077 .endd
9078 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9079 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9080
9081
9082 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9083 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9084 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9085 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9086 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9087 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9088 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9089 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9090 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9091 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9092 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9093 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9094 being expanded.
9095
9096
9097
9098
9099 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9100 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9101 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9102 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9103 white space is significant.
9104
9105 .vlist
9106 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9107 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9108 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9109 .code
9110 $local_part
9111 ${domain}
9112 .endd
9113 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9114 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9115 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9116 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9117 given, the expansion fails.
9118
9119 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9120 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9121 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9122 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9123 .code
9124 ${lc:$local_part}
9125 .endd
9126 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9127 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9128 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9129 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9130 string easier to understand.
9131
9132 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9133 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9134 expansion item below.
9135
9136
9137 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9138 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9139 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9140 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9141 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9142 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9143 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9144 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9145 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9146 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9147 the result of the expansion.
9148 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9149 the expansion result is an empty string.
9150 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9151
9152
9153 .new
9154 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9155 .cindex authentication "results header"
9156 .cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9157 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9158 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9159 &'Authentication-Results"'&
9160 header line.
9161 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9162 will ba a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9163 Methods that may be present in the result include:
9164 .code
9165 none
9166 iprev
9167 auth
9168 spf
9169 dkim
9170 .endd
9171
9172 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9173 .code
9174 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9175 .endd
9176 This is safe even if no authentication reselts are available.
9177 .wen
9178
9179
9180 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9181 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9182 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9183 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9184 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9185 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9186 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9187 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9188 .display
9189 &`version `&
9190 &`serial_number `&
9191 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9192 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9193 &`notbefore `& time
9194 &`notafter `& time
9195 &`sig_algorithm `&
9196 &`signature `&
9197 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9198 &`ocsp_uri `& list
9199 &`crl_uri `& list
9200 .endd
9201 If the field is found,
9202 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9203 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9204 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9205 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9206
9207 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9208 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9209 extracted is used.
9210
9211 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9212
9213 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9214 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9215 not quite
9216 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9217 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9218 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9219 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9220 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9221 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9222 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9223 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9224
9225 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9226 take an optional modifier of "int"
9227 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9228 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9229 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9230
9231 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9232 newline-separated by default,
9233 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9234 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9235 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9236
9237 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9238 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9239 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9240 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9241 if so the element tags are omitted.
9242
9243 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9244
9245 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9246 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9247 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9248 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9249 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9250 .code
9251 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9252 .endd
9253 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9254 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9255 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9256
9257 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9258 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9259 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9260 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9261 must have the following type:
9262 .code
9263 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9264 .endd
9265 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9266 function should return one of the following values:
9267
9268 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9269 into the expanded string that is being built.
9270
9271 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9272 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9273
9274 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9275 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9276
9277 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9278
9279 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9280 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9281 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9282
9283
9284 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9285 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9286 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9287 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9288 removed.
9289 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9290 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9291 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9292
9293 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9294 appear, for example:
9295 .code
9296 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9297 .endd
9298 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9299 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9300
9301 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9302 search failure.
9303 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9304 search success.
9305
9306 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9307 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9308
9309
9310 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9311 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9312 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9313 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9314 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9315 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9316 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9317 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9318 .display
9319 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9320 .endd
9321 .vindex "&$value$&"
9322 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9323 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9324 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9325 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9326 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9327 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9328 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9329 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9330 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9331
9332 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9333 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9334 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9335 yield &"2001"&:
9336 .code
9337 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9338 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9339 .endd
9340 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9341 appear, for example:
9342 .code
9343 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9344 .endd
9345 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9346 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9347
9348
9349 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9350 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9351 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9352 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9353 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9354 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9355 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9356 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9357 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9358 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9359 <&'string3'&> as before.
9360
9361 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9362 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9363 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9364 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9365 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9366 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9367 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9368 provided. For example:
9369 .code
9370 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9371 .endd
9372 yields &"42"&, and
9373 .code
9374 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9375 .endd
9376 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9377 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9378
9379
9380 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9381 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9382 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9383 .vindex "&$item$&"
9384 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9385 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9386 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9387 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9388 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9389 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9390 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9391 .code
9392 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9393 .endd
9394 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9395 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9396
9397
9398 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9399 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9400 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9401 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9402 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9403 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9404
9405 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9406 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9407 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9408 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9409 .code
9410 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9411 .endd
9412 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9413 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9414 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9415 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9416 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9417 .code
9418 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9419 .endd
9420 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9421 letters appear. For example:
9422 .display
9423 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9424 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9425 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9426 .endd
9427
9428 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9429 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9430 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9431 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9432 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9433 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9434 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9435 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9436 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9437 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9438 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9439 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9440 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9441 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9442 .code
9443 $header_reply-to:
9444 .endd
9445 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9446 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9447 lines) may be present.
9448
9449 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9450 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9451
9452 .ilist
9453 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9454 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9455 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9456
9457 .next
9458 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9459 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9460 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9461 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9462 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9463 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9464 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9465 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9466
9467 .next
9468 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9469 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9470 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9471 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9472 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9473 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9474 .endlist ilist
9475
9476 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9477 command of the following form:
9478 .code
9479 headers charset "UTF-8"
9480 .endd
9481 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9482 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9483 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9484 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9485 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9486 ISO-8859-1.
9487
9488 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9489 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9490 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9491 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9492
9493 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9494 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9495 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9496 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9497 router or transport are not accessible.
9498
9499 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9500 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9501 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9502 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9503 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9504 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9505 point they are added.
9506 When any of the above ACLs ar
9507 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9508
9509 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9510 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9511 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9512 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9513 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9514 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9515 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9516 header.)
9517
9518 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9519 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9520 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9521 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9522 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9523 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9524 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9525 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9526
9527
9528 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9529 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9530 .cindex &%hmac%&
9531 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9532 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9533 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9534 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9535 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9536 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9537 present. For example:
9538 .code
9539 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9540 .endd
9541 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9542 produces:
9543 .code
9544 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9545 .endd
9546 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9547 an Exim configuration:
9548 .code
9549 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9550 .endd
9551 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9552 .code
9553 headers_add = \
9554 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9555 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9556 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9557 .endd
9558 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9559 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9560 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9561 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9562 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9563 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9564
9565
9566 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9567 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9568 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9569 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9570 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9571 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9572 .code
9573 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9574 .endd
9575 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9576 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9577 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9578 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9579 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9580
9581 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9582 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9583 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9584 .code
9585 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9586 .endd
9587 you can use
9588 .code
9589 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9590 .endd
9591
9592
9593
9594 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9595 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9596 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9597 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9598 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9599 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9600
9601
9602
9603 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9604 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9605 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9606 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9607 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9608 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9609 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9610 some of the braces:
9611 .code
9612 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9613 .endd
9614 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9615 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9616 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9617
9618
9619 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9620 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9621 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9622 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9623 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9624 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9625 apart from an optional leading minus,
9626 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9627
9628 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9629 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9630
9631 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9632 If the number is negative, the fields are
9633 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9634 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9635 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9636
9637 If the modulus of the
9638 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9639 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9640
9641 For example:
9642 .code
9643 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9644 .endd
9645 yields &"42"&, and
9646 .code
9647 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9648 .endd
9649 yields &"result: 42"&.
9650
9651 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9652 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9653 extracted is used.
9654 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9655
9656
9657 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9658 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9659 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9660 described in the next item.
9661
9662 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9663 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9664 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9665 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9666 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9667 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9668 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9669 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9670 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9671
9672 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9673 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9674 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9675 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9676 out by the system administrator.
9677
9678 .vindex "&$value$&"
9679 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9680 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9681 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9682 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9683 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9684 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9685 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9686 original lookup fails.
9687
9688 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9689 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9690 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9691 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9692 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9693 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9694 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9695 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9696
9697 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9698 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9699 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9700 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9701
9702 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9703 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9704 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9705 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9706
9707 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9708 .code
9709 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9710 .endd
9711 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9712 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9713 .code
9714 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9715 {$value}fail}
9716 .endd
9717
9718
9719 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9720 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9721 .vindex "&$item$&"
9722 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9723 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9724 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9725 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9726 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9727 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9728 .code
9729 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9730 .endd
9731 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9732 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9733 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9734
9735 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9736 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9737 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9738 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9739 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9740 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9741 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9742 .code
9743 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9744 .endd
9745 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9746 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9747 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9748 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9749 example,
9750 .code
9751 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9752 .endd
9753 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9754
9755
9756
9757 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9758 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9759 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9760 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9761 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9762 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9763 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9764 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9765
9766 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9767 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9768 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9769 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9770 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9771 not its contents.
9772
9773 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9774 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9775 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9776
9777 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9778 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9779
9780
9781 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9782 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9783 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9784 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9785 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9786 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9787 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9788 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9789
9790 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9791 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9792 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9793 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9794 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9795 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9796 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9797 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9798 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9799 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9800
9801 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9802 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9803 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9804 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9805
9806 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9807 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9808 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9809 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9810 is the expansion of the third argument.
9811
9812 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9813 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9814 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9815
9816 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9817 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9818 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9819 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9820 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9821 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9822 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9823 newlines are left in the string.
9824 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9825 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9826 the string expansion fails.
9827
9828 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9829 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9830
9831
9832
9833 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9834 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9835 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9836 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9837 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9838 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9839 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9840 examples:
9841 .code
9842 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9843 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9844 .endd
9845 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9846 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9847 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9848 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9849 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9850 example:
9851 .code
9852 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9853 .endd
9854 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9855 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9856 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9857 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
9858 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9859 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9860 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9861 .code
9862 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9863 .endd
9864 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
9865 and must be present if the argument is given.
9866 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
9867 One option type is currently recognised, defining whether (the default)
9868 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
9869 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
9870 .code
9871 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
9872 .endd
9873 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9874 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9875 turns them into spaces:
9876 .code
9877 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9878 .endd
9879 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9880 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9881 addition, the following errors can occur:
9882
9883 .ilist
9884 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9885 .next
9886 Failure to connect the socket;
9887 .next
9888 Failure to write the request string;
9889 .next
9890 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9891 .endlist
9892
9893 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9894 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9895 errors occurs. For example:
9896 .code
9897 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9898 {socket failure}}
9899 .endd
9900 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9901 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9902 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9903 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9904 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9905
9906 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9907 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9908
9909
9910 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9911 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9912 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9913 .vindex "&$value$&"
9914 .vindex "&$item$&"
9915 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9916 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9917 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9918 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9919 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9920 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9921 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9922 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9923 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9924 .code
9925 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9926 .endd
9927 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9928 can be found:
9929 .code
9930 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9931 .endd
9932 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9933 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9934 expansion items.
9935
9936 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9937 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9938 expansion item above.
9939
9940 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9941 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9942 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9943 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9944 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9945 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9946 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9947 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9948 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9949
9950 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9951 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9952 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9953 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9954 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9955 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9956 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9957 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9958 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9959 character.
9960
9961 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9962 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9963 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9964 .vindex "&$value$&"
9965 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9966 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9967 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9968 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9969 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9970 &$value$&.
9971
9972 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9973 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9974 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9975 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9976
9977 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9978 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9979 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9980 troubleshoot:
9981 .code
9982 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9983 log_message = Output of id: $value
9984 .endd
9985 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9986 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9987 .code
9988 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9989 .endd
9990
9991 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9992 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9993 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9994 .code
9995 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9996 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9997 ...
9998 endif
9999 .endd
10000 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10001 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10002 commands.
10003
10004 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10005 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10006 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10007 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10008
10009 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10010 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10011
10012
10013 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10014 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10015 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10016 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10017 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10018 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10019 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10020 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10021 .code
10022 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10023 .endd
10024 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10025 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10026 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10027 .code
10028 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10029 .endd
10030 yields &"defabc"&, and
10031 .code
10032 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10033 .endd
10034 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10035 the regular expression from string expansion.
10036
10037
10038
10039 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10040 .cindex sorting "a list"
10041 .cindex list sorting
10042 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10043 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10044 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
10045 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10046 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10047 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10048 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10049 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10050 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10051 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10052 to give values for comparison.
10053
10054 The item result is a sorted list,
10055 with the original list separator,
10056 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10057
10058 Examples:
10059 .code
10060 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10061 .endd
10062 sorts a list of numbers, and
10063 .code
10064 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10065 .endd
10066 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10067
10068
10069 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10070 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10071 .cindex "substring extraction"
10072 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10073 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10074 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10075 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10076 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10077 .code
10078 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10079 .endd
10080 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10081 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10082 omitted.
10083
10084 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10085 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10086 length required. For example
10087 .code
10088 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10089 .endd
10090 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10091 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10092 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10093 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
10094
10095 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10096 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
10097 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10098 .code
10099 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10100 .endd
10101 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10102 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10103 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10104 .code
10105 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10106 .endd
10107 yields an empty string, but
10108 .code
10109 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10110 .endd
10111 yields &"1"&.
10112
10113 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10114 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
10115 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10116 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10117 .code
10118 ${substr_-1:abcde}
10119 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10120 .endd
10121 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10122
10123
10124
10125 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10126 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10127 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10128 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10129 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
10130 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10131 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10132 replacement list. For example
10133 .code
10134 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10135 .endd
10136 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10137 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10138 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10139 place.
10140 .endlist
10141
10142
10143
10144 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10145 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10146 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10147 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10148 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10149 following operations can be performed:
10150
10151 .vlist
10152 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10153 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10154 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10155 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10156 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10157 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10158
10159
10160 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10161 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10162 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10163 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10164 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10165 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10166 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10167 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10168 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10169
10170 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10171 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10172 character. For example:
10173 .code
10174 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10175 .endd
10176 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10177 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10178 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10179 separator explicitly:
10180 .code
10181 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10182 .endd
10183
10184 Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10185 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10186 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10187 processing lists.
10188
10189 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10190 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10191 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10192 email address separator. For the example header line:
10193 .code
10194 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10195 .endd
10196 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10197 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10198 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10199 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10200 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10201 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10202 quoted.
10203 .code
10204 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10205 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10206 user@example.com
10207 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10208 Last:user@example.com
10209 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10210 user@example.com
10211 .endd
10212
10213 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10214 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10215 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10216 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10217 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10218 Only lowercase letters are used.
10219
10220 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10221 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10222 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10223 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10224 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10225
10226 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10227 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10228 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10229 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10230 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10231 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10232 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
10233 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
10234 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10235
10236 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10237 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10238 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10239 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10240 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10241 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10242 string.
10243
10244 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10245 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10246 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10247 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10248 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10249 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10250
10251 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10252 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10253
10254
10255 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10256 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10257 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10258 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10259 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10260
10261
10262 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10263 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10264 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10265 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10266 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10267
10268
10269 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10270 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10271 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10272 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10273 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10274 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10275 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10276
10277 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10278 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10279 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10280 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10281 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10282 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10283
10284
10285 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10286 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10287 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10288 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10289 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10290 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10291 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10292 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10293 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10294 C programming language):
10295 .table2 70pt 300pt
10296 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10297 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10298 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10299 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10300 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10301 .irow "" "xor (^)"
10302 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10303 .endtable
10304 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10305 space is permitted before or after operators.
10306
10307 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10308 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10309 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10310 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10311 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10312
10313 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10314 or 1024*1024*1024,
10315 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10316 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10317
10318 .display
10319 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10320 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10321 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10322 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10323 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10324 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10325 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10326 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10327 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10328 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10329 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10330 .endd
10331
10332 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10333 .code
10334 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10335 condition = \
10336 ${if and { \
10337 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10338 { \
10339 < \
10340 {$recipients_count} \
10341 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10342 } \
10343 }{yes}{no}}
10344 .endd
10345 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10346 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10347
10348
10349 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10350 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10351 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10352 example,
10353 .code
10354 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10355 .endd
10356 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10357 and then re-expands what it has found.
10358
10359
10360 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10361 .cindex "Unicode"
10362 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10363 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10364 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10365 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10366 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10367 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10368 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10369 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10370 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10371
10372 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10373 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10374 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10375 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10376 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10377 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10378 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10379
10380
10381 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10382 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10383 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10384 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10385 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10386 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10387 .code
10388 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10389 .endd
10390 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10391 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10392
10393
10394
10395 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10396 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10397 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10398 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10399 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10400 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10401
10402
10403
10404 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10405 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10406 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10407 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10408 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10409 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10410 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10411
10412
10413 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10414 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10415 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10416 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10417 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10418 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10419 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10420
10421 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10422 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10423 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10424 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10425 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10426 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10427 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10428 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10429 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10430
10431
10432 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10433 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10434 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10435 .cindex "lower casing"
10436 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10437 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10438 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10439 .code
10440 ${lc:$local_part}
10441 .endd
10442
10443 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10444 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10445 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10446 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10447 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10448 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10449 .code
10450 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10451 .endd
10452 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10453 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10454 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10455
10456
10457 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10458 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10459 .cindex "list" "item count"
10460 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10461 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10462 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10463
10464
10465 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10466 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10467 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10468 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10469 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10470 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10471 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10472 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10473 matching list is returned.
10474
10475
10476 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10477 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10478 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10479 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10480 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10481 empty.
10482
10483
10484 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10485 .cindex "masked IP address"
10486 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10487 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10488 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10489 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10490 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10491 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10492 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10493 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10494 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10495 .code
10496 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10497 .endd
10498 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10499 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10500 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10501 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10502 .code
10503 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10504 .endd
10505 returns the string
10506 .code
10507 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10508 .endd
10509 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10510
10511
10512 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10513 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10514 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10515 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10516 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10517 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10518 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10519
10520 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10521 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10522
10523
10524 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10525 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10526 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10527 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10528 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10529 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10530 .code
10531 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10532 .endd
10533 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10534
10535
10536 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10537 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10538 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10539 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10540 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10541 is an empty string or
10542 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10543 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10544 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10545 respectively For example,
10546 .code
10547 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10548 .endd
10549 becomes
10550 .code
10551 "ab\"*\"cd"
10552 .endd
10553 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10554 variable or a message header.
10555
10556 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10557 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10558 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10559 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10560 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10561 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10562 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10563
10564
10565 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10566 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10567 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10568 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10569 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10570 .code
10571 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10572 .endd
10573 returns
10574 .code
10575 two%20%5C2A%20two
10576 .endd
10577 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10578 yields an unchanged string.
10579
10580
10581 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10582 .cindex "random number"
10583 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10584 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10585 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10586 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10587 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10588 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10589 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10590 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10591 random().
10592
10593
10594 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10595 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10596 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10597 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10598 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10599 for DNS. For example,
10600 .code
10601 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10602 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10603 .endd
10604 returns
10605 .code
10606 4.2.0.192
10607 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10608 .endd
10609
10610
10611 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10612 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10613 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10614 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10615 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10616 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10617 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10618 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10619 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10620 characters
10621 .code
10622 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10623 .endd
10624 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10625 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10626 characters.
10627
10628
10629 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10630 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10631 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10632 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10633 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10634 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10635 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10636 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10637
10638 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10639 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10640 to use this operator as well.
10641
10642
10643
10644 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10645 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10646 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10647 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10648 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10649 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10650 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10651
10652
10653 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10654 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10655 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10656 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10657 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10658 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10659 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10660
10661 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10662 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10663
10664
10665 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10666 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10667 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10668 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10669 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10670 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10671 and returns
10672 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10673
10674 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10675 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10676
10677
10678 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10679 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10680 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
10681 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
10682 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
10683 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
10684 and returns
10685 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10686
10687 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
10688 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
10689 with 256 being the default.
10690
10691 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
10692 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
10693 .new
10694 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
10695 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
10696 .wen
10697
10698
10699 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10700 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10701 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10702 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10703 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10704 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10705 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10706 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10707 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10708 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10709 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10710 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10711 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10712
10713 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10714 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10715 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10716
10717 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10718 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10719 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
10720
10721
10722
10723 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10724 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10725 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10726 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10727 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10728 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10729
10730
10731 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10732 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10733 .cindex "substring extraction"
10734 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10735 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10736 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10737 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10738 .code
10739 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10740 .endd
10741 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10742 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10743
10744 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10745 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10746 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10747 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10748 seconds.
10749
10750 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10751 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10752 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10753 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10754 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10755 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10756 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10757
10758 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10759 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10760 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10761 .cindex "upper casing"
10762 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10763 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10764 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10765
10766 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10767 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10768 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10769 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10770 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10771 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10772 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10773
10774 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10775 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10776 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10777 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
10778 .cindex expansion UTF-8
10779 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
10780 .cindex EAI
10781 .cindex internationalisation
10782 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10783 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10784 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10785 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10786 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
10787 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
10788 .endlist
10789
10790
10791
10792
10793
10794
10795 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10796 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10797 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10798 while expanding strings:
10799
10800 .vlist
10801 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10802 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10803 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10804 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10805 condition.
10806
10807 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10808 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10809 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10810 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10811 are:
10812 .display
10813 &`= `& equal
10814 &`== `& equal
10815 &`> `& greater
10816 &`>= `& greater or equal
10817 &`< `& less
10818 &`<= `& less or equal
10819 .endd
10820 For example:
10821 .code
10822 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10823 .endd
10824 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10825 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10826 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10827 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10828 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10829 zero.
10830
10831 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10832 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10833 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10834
10835
10836 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10837 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10838 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10839 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10840 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10841 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10842 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10843 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10844 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10845 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10846 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10847 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10848 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10849 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10850
10851 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10852 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10853 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10854 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10855 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10856 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10857 false if zero.
10858 An empty string is treated as false.
10859 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10860 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10861 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10862
10863 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10864 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10865 For example:
10866 .code
10867 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10868 .endd
10869
10870
10871 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10872 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10873 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10874 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10875 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10876 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10877 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10878 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10879
10880 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10881
10882 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10883 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10884 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10885 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10886 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10887 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10888 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10889 included in the binary.
10890
10891 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10892 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10893 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10894 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10895 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10896 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10897 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10898 string in LDAP form is:
10899 .code
10900 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10901 .endd
10902 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10903 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10904 .code
10905 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10906 .endd
10907 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10908 supported:
10909
10910 .ilist
10911 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10912 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10913 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10914 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10915 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10916 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10917 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10918 comparison fails.
10919
10920 .next
10921 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10922 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10923 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10924 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10925 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10926 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10927
10928 .next
10929 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10930 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10931 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10932 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10933 whatever its length.
10934
10935 .next
10936 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10937 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10938 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10939 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10940 .endlist
10941 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10942 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10943 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10944 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10945 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10946 support &[crypt16()]&.
10947
10948 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10949 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10950 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10951 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10952 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10953
10954 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10955 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10956 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10957
10958 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10959 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10960 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10961 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10962 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10963
10964 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10965 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10966 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10967 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10968 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10969 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10970 .code
10971 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10972 .endd
10973 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10974 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10975
10976 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10977 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10978 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10979 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10980 exists in the message. For example,
10981 .code
10982 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10983 .endd
10984 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10985 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10986
10987 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10988 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10989 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10990 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10991 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10992 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10993 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10994 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10995 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10996
10997 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10998 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10999 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11000 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11001 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11002 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11003 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11004 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11005
11006 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11007 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11008 .cindex "first delivery"
11009 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11010 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11011 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11012 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11013
11014
11015 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11016 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11017 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11018 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11019 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11020 .vindex "&$item$&"
11021 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11022 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11023 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11024 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11025 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11026 .ilist
11027 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11028 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11029 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11030 .next
11031 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11032 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11033 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11034 .endlist
11035 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11036 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11037 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11038 list separator is changed to a comma:
11039 .code
11040 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11041 .endd
11042 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
11043 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11044
11045 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11046
11047
11048 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11049 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11050 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11051 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11052 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11053 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11054 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11055 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11056 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11057 case-independent.
11058
11059 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11060 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11061 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11062 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11063 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11064 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11065 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11066 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11067 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11068 case-independent.
11069
11070 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11071 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11072 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11073 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11074 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11075 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11076 is true.
11077
11078 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11079 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11080 .code
11081 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11082 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11083 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11084 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11085 .endd
11086
11087 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11088 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11089 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11090 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11091 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11092 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11093 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11094 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11095 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11096 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11097 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11098
11099 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11100 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11101 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11102 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11103 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11104
11105 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11106 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11107 check.
11108 This is no longer the case.
11109
11110 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11111 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11112 .code
11113 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11114 .endd
11115 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11116
11117 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11118 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11119 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11120 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11121 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11122 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11123 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11124 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11125 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11126 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11127 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11128 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11129 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11130 this can be used.
11131
11132
11133 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11134 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11135 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11136 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11137 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11138 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11139 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11140 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11141 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11142 case-independent.
11143
11144 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11145 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11146 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11147 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11148 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11149 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11150 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11151 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11152 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11153 case-independent.
11154
11155
11156 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11157 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11158 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11159 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11160 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11161 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11162 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11163 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11164 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11165 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11166 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11167 For example,
11168 .code
11169 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11170 .endd
11171 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11172 backslashes is also required.
11173
11174 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11175 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11176 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11177 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11178 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11179 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11180
11181 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11182 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11183 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11184 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11185 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11186 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11187 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11188 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11189
11190 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11191 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11192 See &*match_local_part*&.
11193
11194 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11195 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11196 See &*match_local_part*&.
11197
11198 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11199 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11200 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11201 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11202 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11203 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11204 .code
11205 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11206 .endd
11207 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11208
11209 .ilist
11210 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11211 .next
11212 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11213 .next
11214 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11215 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11216 in a single test such as
11217 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11218 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11219 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11220 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11221 .code
11222 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11223 .endd
11224 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11225 .next
11226 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11227 .next
11228 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11229 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11230 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11231 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11232 masks. For example:
11233 .code
11234 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11235 .endd
11236 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11237 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11238 address mask, for example:
11239 .code
11240 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11241 .endd
11242 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11243 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11244 .code
11245 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11246 .endd
11247 .endlist ilist
11248
11249 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11250 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11251
11252 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11253
11254 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11255 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11256 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11257 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11258 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11259 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11260 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11261 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11262 example is:
11263 .code
11264 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11265 .endd
11266 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11267 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11268 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11269 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11270 .code
11271 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11272 .endd
11273 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11274 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11275 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11276 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11277 caselessly.
11278
11279 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11280 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11281
11282 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11283 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11284 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11285 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11286
11287 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11288 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11289 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11290 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11291 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11292 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11293 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11294 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11295 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11296 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11297 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11298 .code
11299 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11300 .endd
11301 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11302 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11303
11304 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11305 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11306 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11307 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11308 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11309 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11310 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11311
11312 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11313 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11314 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11315 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11316 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11317 .code
11318 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11319 .endd
11320 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11321 .code
11322 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11323 .endd
11324 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11325 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11326 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11327 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
11328 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
11329 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
11330 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
11331 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
11332
11333
11334 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11335 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11336 .cindex "Cyrus"
11337 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11338 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11339 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11340 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11341 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11342 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11343
11344 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11345 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11346 building Exim. For example:
11347 .code
11348 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11349 .endd
11350 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11351 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11352 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11353 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11354
11355 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11356 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11357 configuration, you might have this:
11358 .code
11359 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11360 .endd
11361 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11362 .code
11363 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11364 .endd
11365 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11366 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11367 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11368 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11369 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11370 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11371
11372
11373 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11374 .cindex "Radius"
11375 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11376 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11377 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11378 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11379 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11380 support.
11381
11382 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11383 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11384 this library, you need to set
11385 .code
11386 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11387 .endd
11388 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11389 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11390 .code
11391 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11392 .endd
11393 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11394 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11395 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11396
11397 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11398 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11399 the authentication is successful. For example:
11400 .code
11401 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11402 .endd
11403
11404
11405 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11406 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11407 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11408 .cindex "Cyrus"
11409 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11410 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11411 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11412 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11413 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11414 by a process that is not running as root.
11415
11416 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11417 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11418 building Exim. For example:
11419 .code
11420 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11421 .endd
11422 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11423 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11424 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11425
11426 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11427 two are mandatory. For example:
11428 .code
11429 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11430 .endd
11431 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11432 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11433 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11434 .endlist vlist
11435
11436
11437
11438 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11439 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11440 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11441 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11442 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11443 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11444 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11445
11446
11447 .vlist
11448 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11449 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11450 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11451 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11452 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11453 For example,
11454 .code
11455 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11456 .endd
11457 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11458 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11459 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11460
11461 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11462 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11463 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11464 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11465 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11466 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11467 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11468 parsed but not evaluated.
11469 .endlist
11470 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11471
11472
11473
11474
11475 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11476 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11477 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11478 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11479 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11480
11481 .vlist
11482 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11483 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11484 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11485 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11486 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11487 In the expansion condition case
11488 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11489 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11490 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11491 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11492 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11493 matching condition.
11494
11495 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11496 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11497 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11498 any unused variables being made empty.
11499
11500 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11501 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11502 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11503 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11504 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11505 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11506 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11507 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11508 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11509 during subsequent delivery.
11510
11511 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11512 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11513 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11514 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11515 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11516 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11517 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11518 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11519 delivery.
11520
11521 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11522 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11523 this variable has the number of arguments.
11524
11525 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11526 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11527 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11528 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11529 be preserved by coding like this:
11530 .code
11531 warn !verify = sender
11532 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11533 .endd
11534 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11535 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11536 failure.
11537
11538 .vitem &$address_data$&
11539 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11540 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11541 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11542 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11543 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11544 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11545 user filter files.
11546
11547 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11548 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11549 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11550 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11551 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11552 from the child's routing.
11553
11554 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11555 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11556 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11557 address.
11558
11559 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11560 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11561 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11562
11563 .vitem &$address_file$&
11564 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11565 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11566 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11567 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11568 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11569 .code
11570 /home/r2d2/savemail
11571 .endd
11572 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11573 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11574 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11575 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11576 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11577 to the relevant file.
11578
11579 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11580 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11581 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11582 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11583
11584 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11585 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11586 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11587 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11588
11589 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11590 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11591 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11592 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11593 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11594 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11595 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11596 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11597 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11598
11599 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11600 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11601 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11602 command line option.
11603 .new
11604 This second case also sets up inforamtion used by the
11605 &$authresults$& expansion item.
11606 .wen
11607
11608 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11609 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11610 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11611 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11612 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11613 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11614 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11615 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11616 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11617 the ACL's as well.
11618
11619
11620 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11621 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11622 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11623 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11624 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11625 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11626 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11627 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11628 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11629 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11630 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11631
11632 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11633 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11634 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11635 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11636 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11637
11638
11639 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11640 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11641 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11642 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11643 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11644 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11645 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11646 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11647 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11648 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11649 an undefined mechanism.
11650
11651 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11652 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11653 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11654 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11655 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11656 the ACL malware condition.
11657
11658 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11659 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11660 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11661 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11662 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11663 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11664
11665 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11666 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11667 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11668 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11669 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11670 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11671 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11672
11673 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11674 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11675 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11676 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11677 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11678
11679 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11680 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11681 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11682 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11683 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11684
11685 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11686 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11687 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11688 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11689 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11690 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11691 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11692
11693 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11694 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11695 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11696 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11697 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11698 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11699 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11700
11701 .vitem &$callout_address$&
11702 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11703 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11704 address that was connected to.
11705
11706 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11707 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11708 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11709 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11710 compilations of the same version of the program.
11711
11712 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11713 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11714 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11715 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11716 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11717 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11718
11719 .vitem &$config_file$&
11720 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11721 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11722
11723 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
11724 Results of DKIM verification.
11725 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11726
11727 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11728 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11729 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11730 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11731 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11732 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11733 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11734 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11735 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11736 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11737 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11738 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11739 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11740 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11741 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11742 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11743 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11744 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
11745 &$dkim_key_length$&
11746 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11747 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11748
11749 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11750 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11751 When a message has been received this variable contains
11752 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11753 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11754
11755 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11756 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11757 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11758 &$dnslist_value$&
11759 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11760 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11761 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11762 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11763 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11764 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11765 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11766 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11767 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11768
11769 .vitem &$domain$&
11770 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11771 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11772 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11773 case for &$domain$&.
11774
11775 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11776 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11777 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11778 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11779
11780 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11781 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11782 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11783 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11784 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11785 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11786
11787 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11788 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11789 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11790
11791 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11792
11793 .ilist
11794 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11795 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11796 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11797 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11798 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11799 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11800 the &(smtp)& transport.
11801
11802 .next
11803 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11804 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11805 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11806 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11807
11808 .next
11809 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11810 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11811 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11812 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11813 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11814 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11815
11816 .next
11817 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11818 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11819 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11820 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11821 .endlist
11822
11823
11824 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11825 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11826 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11827 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11828 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11829 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11830 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11831 used.
11832
11833 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11834 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11835 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11836 to nothing.
11837
11838 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11839 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11840 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11841
11842 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11843 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11844 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11845
11846 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11847 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11848 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11849
11850 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11851 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11852 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11853 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11854 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11855 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11856
11857 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11858 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11859 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11860 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11861 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11862
11863 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11864 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11865 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11866 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11867 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11868
11869 .vitem &$home$&
11870 .vindex "&$home$&"
11871 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11872 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11873 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11874 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11875 by a setting on the transport itself.
11876
11877 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11878 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
11879 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
11880
11881 .vitem &$host$&
11882 .vindex "&$host$&"
11883 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11884 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11885 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11886 to local and remote transports.
11887
11888 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11889 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11890 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11891 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11892 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11893 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11894 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11895 is connected.
11896
11897 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11898 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11899 client is connected.
11900
11901
11902 .vitem &$host_address$&
11903 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11904 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11905 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11906 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11907
11908 .vitem &$host_data$&
11909 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11910 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11911 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11912 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11913 .code
11914 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11915 message = $host_data
11916 .endd
11917 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11918 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11919 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11920 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11921 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11922 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11923 variables is set to &"1"&.
11924
11925 .ilist
11926 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11927 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11928
11929 .next
11930 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11931 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11932 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11933 .endlist ilist
11934
11935 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11936 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11937 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11938 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11939 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11940 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11941 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11942 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11943 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11944 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11945
11946 .new
11947 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
11948 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
11949 &$authresults$& expansion item.
11950 .wen
11951
11952
11953 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11954 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11955 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11956
11957 .vitem &$host_port$&
11958 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11959 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11960 for an outbound connection.
11961
11962 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
11963 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
11964 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
11965 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
11966 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
11967 to &$spool_directory$& later.
11968
11969 .vitem &$inode$&
11970 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11971 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11972 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11973 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11974 a unique name for the file.
11975
11976 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11977 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11978 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11979
11980 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11981 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11982 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11983
11984 .vitem &$item$&
11985 .vindex "&$item$&"
11986 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11987 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11988 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11989 empty.
11990
11991 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11992 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11993 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11994 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11995 lookup.
11996
11997 .vitem &$load_average$&
11998 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11999 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12000 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12001 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12002
12003 .vitem &$local_part$&
12004 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12005 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12006 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12007 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12008 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12009
12010 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12011 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12012 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12013 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12014 once.
12015
12016 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12017 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12018 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12019 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12020 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12021 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12022
12023 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12024 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12025 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
12026 &$address_pipe$&).
12027
12028 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12029 local part of the recipient address.
12030
12031 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12032 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12033 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12034
12035 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12036 the addresses
12037 .code
12038 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12039 abc\:xyz@test.example
12040 .endd
12041 the value of &$local_part$& is
12042 .code
12043 abc:xyz
12044 .endd
12045 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12046 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12047 have:
12048 .code
12049 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12050 .endd
12051 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12052 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12053 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12054
12055 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12056 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12057 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12058 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12059 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12060 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12061 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12062
12063 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12064 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12065 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12066 variable expands to nothing.
12067
12068 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12069 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12070 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12071 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12072 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12073
12074 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12075 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12076 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12077 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12078 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12079
12080 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12081 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12082 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12083 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12084
12085 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12086 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12087 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12088
12089 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12090 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12091 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12092 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12093 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12094 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12095 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12096 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12097
12098 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12099 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12100 This contains the expanded value of the
12101 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12102 been read.
12103
12104 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12105 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12106 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12107 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12108 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12109 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12110
12111 .vitem &$log_space$&
12112 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12113 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12114 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12115 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12116 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12117 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12118
12119
12120 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12121 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12122 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12123 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12124 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12125 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12126 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12127 and &"yes"& if it was.
12128 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12129 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12130 as authenticated data.
12131
12132 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12133 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12134 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12135 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12136 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12137 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12138 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12139 variable is empty.
12140
12141 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12142 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12143 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12144 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12145 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12146
12147 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12148 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12149 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12150 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12151 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12152 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12153 character(s).
12154 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12155
12156 .vitem &$message_age$&
12157 .cindex "message" "age of"
12158 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12159 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12160 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12161 delivery attempt.
12162
12163 .vitem &$message_body$&
12164 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12165 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12166 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12167 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12168 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12169 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12170 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12171 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12172 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12173
12174 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12175 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12176 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12177 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12178 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12179
12180 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12181 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12182 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12183 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12184 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12185 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12186 &$message_body$&.
12187
12188 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12189 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12190 .cindex "message body" "size"
12191 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12192 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12193 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12194 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12195 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12196
12197 If the spool file is wireformat
12198 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12199 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12200
12201 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12202 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12203 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12204 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12205 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12206 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12207 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12208 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12209
12210 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12211 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12212 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12213 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12214 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12215 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12216
12217 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12218 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12219 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12220 contents of header lines is done.
12221
12222 .vitem &$message_id$&
12223 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12224
12225 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12226 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12227 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12228 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12229 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12230 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12231 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12232 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12233 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12234 from the body is not counted.
12235
12236 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12237 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12238 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12239 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12240 header and the body).
12241
12242 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12243 .code
12244 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12245 condition = \
12246 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12247 .endd
12248 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12249 message has not yet been received.
12250
12251 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12252
12253 .vitem &$message_size$&
12254 .cindex "size" "of message"
12255 .cindex "message" "size"
12256 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12257 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12258 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12259 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12260 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12261 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12262 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12263 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12264 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12265
12266 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12267 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12268 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12269 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12270
12271 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12272 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12273 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12274 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12275
12276 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12277 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12278 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12279
12280 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12281 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12282 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12283 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12284 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12285 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12286 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12287 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12288 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12289 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12290
12291 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12292 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12293 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12294
12295 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12296 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12297 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12298 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12299 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12300 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12301 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12302 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12303 the original address.
12304
12305 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12306 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12307 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12308 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12309 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12310
12311 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12312 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12313 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12314
12315 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12316 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12317 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12318 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12319 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12320 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12321 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12322 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12323 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12324
12325 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12326 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12327 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12328 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12329 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12330 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12331 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12332 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12333 user.
12334
12335 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12336 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12337 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12338 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12339
12340 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12341 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12342 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12343 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12344
12345 .vitem &$pid$&
12346 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12347 .vindex "&$pid$&"
12348 This variable contains the current process id.
12349
12350 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12351 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12352 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12353 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12354 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12355 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12356 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12357 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12358 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12359 variable"& error if encountered.
12360
12361 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12362 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12363 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12364 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12365 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12366 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12367 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12368
12369
12370 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12371 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12372 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12373 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12374 &$proxy_session$&
12375 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12376 or SOCKS5 support.
12377 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12378
12379 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12380 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12381 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12382 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12383
12384 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12385 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12386 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12387 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12388
12389 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12390 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12391 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12392 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12393
12394 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12395 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12396 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12397 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12398
12399 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12400 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12401 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12402
12403 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12404 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12405 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12406 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12407
12408 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12409 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12410 .cindex "named queues"
12411 .cindex queues named
12412 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12413
12414 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12415 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12416 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12417 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12418 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12419
12420 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12421 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12422 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12423 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12424 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12425 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12426
12427 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12428 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12429 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12430 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12431 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12432
12433 .vitem &$received_count$&
12434 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12435 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12436 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12437 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12438 delivering.
12439
12440 .vitem &$received_for$&
12441 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12442 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12443 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12444 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12445 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12446
12447 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12448 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12449 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12450 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12451 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12452 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12453 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12454 option.
12455
12456 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12457 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12458 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12459 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12460 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12461 time.
12462 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12463
12464 .vitem &$received_port$&
12465 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12466 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12467
12468 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12469 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12470 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12471 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12472 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12473 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12474 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12475 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12476 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12477
12478 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12479 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12480 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12481 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12482 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12483 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12484
12485 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12486 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12487 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12488
12489 .vitem &$received_time$&
12490 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12491 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12492 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12493
12494 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12495 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12496 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12497 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12498 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12499 .display
12500 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12501 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12502 .endd
12503 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12504 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12505 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12506 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12507
12508 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12509 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12510 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12511 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12512
12513 .ilist
12514 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12515 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12516
12517 .next
12518 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12519
12520 .next
12521 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12522 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12523 MAIL).
12524
12525 .next
12526 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12527 .next
12528
12529 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12530 .endlist
12531
12532 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12533 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12534
12535 .vitem &$recipients$&
12536 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12537 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12538 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12539 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12540 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12541 cases:
12542
12543 .olist
12544 In a system filter file.
12545 .next
12546 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12547 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12548 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12549 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12550 .next
12551 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12552 .endlist
12553
12554
12555 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12556 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12557 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12558 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12559 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12560 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12561
12562
12563 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12564 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12565 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12566 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12567
12568 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12569 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12570 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12571 these variables contain the
12572 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12573
12574
12575 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12576 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12577 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12578 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12579 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12580 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12581 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12582
12583 .vitem &$return_path$&
12584 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12585 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12586 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12587 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12588 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12589 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12590 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12591 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12592 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12593 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12594 envelope sender.
12595
12596 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12597 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12598 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12599
12600 .vitem &$router_name$&
12601 .cindex "router" "name"
12602 .cindex "name" "of router"
12603 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12604 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12605
12606 .vitem &$runrc$&
12607 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12608 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12609 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12610 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12611 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12612 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12613 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12614 another.
12615
12616 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12617 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12618 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12619 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12620 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12621 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12622 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12623 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12624
12625 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12626 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12627 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12628 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12629 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12630 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12631
12632 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12633 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12634 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12635 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12636 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12637 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12638 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12639 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12640
12641 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12642 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12643 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12644
12645 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12646 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12647 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12648
12649 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12650 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12651 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12652 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12653 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12654 this:
12655 .display
12656 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12657 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12658 .endd
12659 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12660 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12661 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12662 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12663
12664 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12665 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12666 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12667 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12668 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12669 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12670 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12671 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12672 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12673 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12674 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12675 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12676 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12677
12678 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12679 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12680 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12681 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12682 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12683
12684 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12685 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12686 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12687 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12688 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12689 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12690
12691 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12692 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12693 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12694 this variable contains that
12695 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12696
12697 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12698 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12699 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12700 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12701 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12702 &$authenticated_id$&.
12703
12704 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12705 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12706 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12707 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12708 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12709 resolver library states that both
12710 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12711 other times, this variable is false.
12712
12713 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12714 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12715 library, by setting:
12716 .code
12717 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12718 .endd
12719
12720 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12721 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12722
12723 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12724 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12725
12726 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
12727 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
12728 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
12729 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
12730
12731
12732 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12733 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12734 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12735 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12736 other means, this variable is empty.
12737
12738 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12739 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12740 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12741 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12742 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12743 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12744 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12745
12746 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12747 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12748 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12749 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12750
12751 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12752 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12753 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12754 is set to &"1"&.
12755
12756 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12757 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12758 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12759 following are true:
12760
12761 .ilist
12762 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12763 .next
12764 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12765 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12766 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12767 .next
12768 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12769 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12770 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12771 .next
12772 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12773 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12774 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12775 .next
12776 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12777 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12778 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12779 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12780 .code
12781 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12782 .endd
12783 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12784 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12785 .endlist
12786
12787
12788 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12789 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12790 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12791 number that was used on the remote host.
12792
12793 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12794 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12795 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12796 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12797 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12798 called Exim.
12799
12800 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12801 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12802 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12803 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12804
12805 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12806 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12807 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12808 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12809 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12810 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12811 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12812 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12813 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12814 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12815 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12816 the parentheses.
12817
12818 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12819 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12820 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12821 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12822 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12823
12824 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12825 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12826 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12827 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12828 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12829
12830 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12831 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12832 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12833 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12834 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12835 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12836 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12837
12838 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12839 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12840 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12841 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12842 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12843
12844 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12845 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12846 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12847 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12848 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12849 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12850
12851 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12852 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12853 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12854 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12855 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12856 .code
12857 MAIL FROM:<>
12858 MAIL FROM: <>
12859 .endd
12860 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12861 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12862 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12863 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12864
12865 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12866 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12867 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12868 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12869 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12870 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12871 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12872
12873 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
12874 .cindex SMTP "command history"
12875 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
12876 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
12877 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
12878 are remembered.
12879
12880 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12881 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12882 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12883 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12884 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12885 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12886 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12887 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12888 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12889 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12890 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12891
12892 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12893 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12894 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12895 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12896 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12897 message is junk mail.
12898
12899 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12900 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12901 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12902 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12903
12904 .new
12905 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
12906 &$spf_received$& &&&
12907 &$spf_result$& &&&
12908 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
12909 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
12910 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
12911 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
12912 .wen
12913
12914 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12915 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12916 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12917
12918 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12919 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12920 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12921 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12922 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12923 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12924
12925 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12926 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12927 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12928 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12929 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12930 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12931 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12932 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12933 .code
12934 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12935 .endd
12936 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12937
12938
12939 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12940 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12941 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12942 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12943 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12944 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12945
12946 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12947 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12948 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12949 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12950 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12951 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12952 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12953 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12954
12955 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12956 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12957 the outbound.
12958
12959 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12960 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12961 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12962 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12963 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12964 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12965
12966 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12967 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12968 .cindex certificate variables
12969 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12970 inbound connection when the message was received.
12971 It is only useful as the argument of a
12972 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12973 or a &%def%& condition.
12974
12975 &*Note*&: Under current versions of OpenSSL, when a list of more than one
12976 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
12977
12978 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12979 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12980 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12981 inbound connection when the message was received.
12982 It is only useful as the argument of a
12983 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12984 or a &%def%& condition.
12985 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12986 which is not the leaf.
12987
12988 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12989 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12990 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12991 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12992 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12993 or a &%def%& condition.
12994
12995 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12996 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12997 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12998 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12999 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13000 or a &%def%& condition.
13001 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13002 which is not the leaf.
13003
13004 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13005 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13006 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13007 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13008
13009 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13010 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13011 the outbound.
13012
13013 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13014 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13015 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13016 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13017 and &"0"& otherwise.
13018
13019 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13020 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13021 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13022 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13023 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13024 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13025 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13026 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13027 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13028
13029 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13030 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13031 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13032
13033 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13034 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13035 This variable is
13036 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13037 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13038 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13039 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13040
13041 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13042 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13043 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13044
13045 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13046 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13047 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13048 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13049 .code
13050 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13051 1 No response to request
13052 2 Response not verified
13053 3 Verification failed
13054 4 Verification succeeded
13055 .endd
13056
13057 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13058 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13059 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13060 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13061 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13062
13063 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13064 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13065 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13066 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13067 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13068 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13069 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13070 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13071 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13072 which is not the leaf.
13073
13074 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13075 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13076 the outbound.
13077
13078 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13079 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13080 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13081 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13082 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13083 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13084 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13085 which is not the leaf.
13086
13087 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13088 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13089 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13090 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13091 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13092 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13093 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13094 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13095 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13096 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13097 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13098
13099 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13100 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13101 the outbound.
13102
13103 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13104 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13105 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13106 During outbound
13107 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13108 the transport.
13109
13110 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13111 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13112 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13113
13114 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13115 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13116 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13117 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13118
13119 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13120 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13121 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13122
13123 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13124 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13125 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13126
13127 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13128 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13129 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13130 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13131 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13132 values for those that are behind (west).
13133
13134 .vitem &$tod_log$&
13135 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13136 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13137 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13138
13139 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13140 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13141 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13142 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13143 flag.
13144
13145 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13146 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13147 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13148 -0500.
13149
13150 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13151 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13152 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13153 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13154
13155 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13156 .cindex "transport" "name"
13157 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13158 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13159 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13160
13161 .vitem &$value$&
13162 .vindex "&$value$&"
13163 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13164 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13165 &*reduce*& expansion.
13166
13167 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13168 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13169 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13170 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13171 Otherwise, empty.
13172
13173 .vitem &$version_number$&
13174 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13175 The version number of Exim.
13176
13177 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13178 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13179 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13180 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13181
13182 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13183 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13184 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13185 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13186 .endlist
13187 .ecindex IIDstrexp
13188
13189
13190
13191 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13192 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13193
13194 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13195 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13196 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13197 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13198 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13199 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13200 the line
13201 .code
13202 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13203 .endd
13204 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13205
13206
13207 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13208 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13209 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13210 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13211 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13212 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13213 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13214 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13215 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13216
13217 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13218 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13219 should usually be something like
13220 .code
13221 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13222 .endd
13223 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13224 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13225 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13226 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13227 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13228 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13229 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13230 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13231 two ways:
13232
13233 .ilist
13234 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13235 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13236 a startup when Exim is entered.
13237 .next
13238 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13239 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13240 .endlist
13241
13242 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13243 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13244
13245 .ilist
13246 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13247 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13248 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13249 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13250 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13251 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13252 defaults to false.
13253
13254
13255 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13256 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13257 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13258 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13259 forms:
13260 .code
13261 ${perl{foo}}
13262 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13263 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13264 .endd
13265 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13266 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13267 with an error message of the form
13268 .code
13269 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13270 .endd
13271 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13272 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13273 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13274 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13275 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13276 that was passed to &%die%&.
13277
13278
13279 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13280 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13281 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13282 the Perl code
13283 .code
13284 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13285 .endd
13286 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13287 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13288 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13289
13290 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13291 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13292 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13293 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13294
13295 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13296 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13297 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13298 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13299 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13300 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13301 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13302
13303
13304 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13305 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13306 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13307 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13308 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13309 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13310 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13311 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13312 avoided, but the output is lost.
13313
13314 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13315 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13316 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13317 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13318 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13319 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13320 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13321 .code
13322 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13323 .endd
13324 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13325 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13326 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13327 as the first subroutine argument.
13328 .ecindex IIDperl
13329
13330
13331 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13332 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13333
13334 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13335 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13336 "Starting the daemon"
13337 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13338 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13339 .cindex "network interface"
13340 .cindex "interface" "network"
13341 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13342 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13343 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13344 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13345 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13346 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13347 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13348 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13349 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13350 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13351 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13352
13353 .olist
13354 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13355 and ports to listen on.
13356 .next
13357 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13358 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13359 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13360 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13361 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13362 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13363 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13364 as an error situation.
13365 .next
13366 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13367 for the outgoing connection.
13368 .endlist
13369
13370
13371 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13372 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13373 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13374 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13375 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13376
13377 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13378 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13379 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13380 chapter describes how they operate.
13381
13382 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13383 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13384
13385
13386
13387 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13388 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13389 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13390 following options:
13391
13392 .ilist
13393 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13394 or service names.
13395 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13396 .next
13397 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13398 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13399 .endlist
13400
13401 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13402 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13403 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13404 colons. For example:
13405 .code
13406 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13407 192.168.23.65 ; \
13408 ::1 ; \
13409 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13410 .endd
13411 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13412 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13413
13414 .olist
13415 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13416 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13417 .code
13418 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13419 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13420 .endd
13421 .next
13422 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13423 with a colon separator, for example:
13424 .code
13425 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13426 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13427 .endd
13428 .endlist
13429
13430 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13431 default setting contains just one port:
13432 .code
13433 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13434 .endd
13435 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13436 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13437 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13438 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13439 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13440
13441
13442
13443 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13444 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13445 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13446 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13447 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13448 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13449 .code
13450 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13451 .endd
13452 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13453 .code
13454 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13455 .endd
13456 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13457
13458
13459
13460 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13461 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13462 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13463 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13464 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13465 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13466 exim.
13467
13468 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13469 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13470 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13471 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13472 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13473 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13474 .code
13475 -oX 1225
13476 .endd
13477 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13478 whereas
13479 .code
13480 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13481 .endd
13482 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13483 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13484 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13485
13486
13487
13488 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13489 .cindex "submissions protocol"
13490 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13491 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13492 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13493 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13494 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13495 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13496 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13497 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13498 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13499 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13500 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13501 the 465 TCP ports.
13502
13503 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13504 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13505 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13506
13507 The common use of this option is expected to be
13508 .code
13509 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13510 .endd
13511 per RFC 8314.
13512 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13513 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13514
13515 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13516 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13517 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13518 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13519 connections via the daemon.)
13520
13521
13522
13523
13524 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13525 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13526 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13527 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13528 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13529 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13530 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13531 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13532 .code
13533 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13534 .endd
13535 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13536 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13537 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13538 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13539 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13540 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13541 .code
13542 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13543 .endd
13544 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13545 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13546 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13547 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13548 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13549
13550 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13551 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13552 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13553 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13554 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13555 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13556 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13557 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13558 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13559 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13560 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13561 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13562
13563 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13564 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13565 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13566 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13567 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13568
13569
13570
13571 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13572 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13573 .code
13574 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13575 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13576 .endd
13577 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13578 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13579 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13580 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13581
13582 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13583 .code
13584 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13585 .endd
13586 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13587 .code
13588 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13589 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13590 .endd
13591 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13592 IPv4 loopback address only:
13593 .code
13594 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13595 .endd
13596 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13597 .code
13598 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13599 .endd
13600 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13601
13602
13603
13604 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13605 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13606 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13607 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13608 treated as local.
13609
13610 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13611 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13612 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13613 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13614
13615 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13616 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13617 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13618 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13619 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13620 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13621 used for listening. Consider this example:
13622 .code
13623 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13624 192.168.53.235 ; \
13625 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13626
13627 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13628 .endd
13629 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13630 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13631 Exim is routing.
13632
13633 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13634 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13635 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13636 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13637 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13638 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13639 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13640 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13641
13642
13643
13644 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13645 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13646 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13647 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13648 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13649 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13650 details.
13651
13652
13653
13654
13655 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13656 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13657
13658 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13659 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13660 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13661 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13662
13663 .ilist
13664 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13665 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13666 .next
13667 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13668 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13669 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13670 .next
13671 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13672 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13673 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13674 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13675 settings.
13676 .endlist
13677
13678 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13679 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13680 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13681 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13682 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13683 listed in more than one group.
13684
13685 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13686 .table2
13687 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13688 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
13689 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13690 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13691 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13692 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13693 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13694 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13695 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13696 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
13697 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13698 .endtable
13699
13700
13701 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13702 .table2
13703 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13704 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13705 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13706 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13707 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13708 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13709 .endtable
13710
13711
13712
13713 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13714 .table2
13715 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13716 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
13717 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13718 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13719 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13720 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13721 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13722 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13723 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13724 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13725 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13726 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13727 .endtable
13728
13729
13730
13731 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13732 .table2
13733 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
13734 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13735 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13736 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13737 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13738 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13739 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13740 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13741 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13742 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13743 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13744 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
13745 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13746 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13747 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13748 .endtable
13749
13750
13751
13752 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13753 .table2
13754 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13755 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13756 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13757 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13758 .endtable
13759
13760
13761
13762 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13763 .table2
13764 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13765 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13766 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13767 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13768 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13769 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13770 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13771 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13772 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13773 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13774 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13775 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13776 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13777 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13778 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13779 .endtable
13780
13781
13782
13783 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13784 .table2
13785 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13786 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13787 .endtable
13788
13789
13790
13791 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13792 .table2
13793 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13794 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13795 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
13796 .endtable
13797
13798
13799
13800 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13801 .table2
13802 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13803 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13804 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13805 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13806 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13807 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13808 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13809 .endtable
13810
13811
13812
13813 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13814 .table2
13815 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13816 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13817 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13818 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13819 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13820 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13821 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13822 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13823 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13824 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13825 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13826 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13827 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13828 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13829 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13830 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13831 connection"
13832 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13833 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13834 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13835 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13836 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13837 .endtable
13838
13839
13840
13841 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13842 .table2
13843 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13844 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13845 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13846 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13847 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13848 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13849 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13850 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13851 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13852 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13853 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13854 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13855 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13856 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13857 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13858 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13859 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13860 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13861 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13862 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13863 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13864 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13865 words""&"
13866 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13867 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13868 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13869 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13870 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13871 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13872 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13873 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13874 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13875 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13876 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13877 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
13878 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13879 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13880 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13881 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13882 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13883 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13884 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13885 .endtable
13886
13887
13888
13889 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13890 .table2
13891 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13892 item"
13893 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13894 item"
13895 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13896 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13897 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13898 .endtable
13899
13900
13901
13902 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13903 .table2
13904 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13905 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13906 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13907 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13908 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13909 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13910 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13911 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13912 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13913 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13914 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13915 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13916 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13917 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13918 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13919 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13920 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13921 .endtable
13922
13923
13924
13925 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13926 .table2
13927 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13928 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13929 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13930 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13931 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13932 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13933 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13934 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13935 .endtable
13936
13937
13938
13939 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13940 .table2
13941 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13942 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13943 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13944 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13945 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13946 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13947 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13948 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13949 .endtable
13950
13951
13952
13953
13954 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13955 .table2
13956 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13957 .endtable
13958
13959
13960
13961
13962
13963 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13964 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13965
13966 .table2
13967 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13968 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13969 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13970 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13971 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13972 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13973 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13974 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13975 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13976 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13977 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13978 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13979 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13980 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13981 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13982 connection"
13983 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13984 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13985 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13986 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13987 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13988 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13989 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13990 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13991 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13992 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13993 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13994 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13995 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13996 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13997 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13998 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13999 .endtable
14000
14001
14002
14003 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14004 .table2
14005 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14006 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14007 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14008 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14009 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14010 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14011 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14012 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14013 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14014 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14015 .endtable
14016
14017
14018
14019 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14020 .table2
14021 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14022 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14023 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14024 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14025 words""&"
14026 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14027 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14028 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14029 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14030 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14031 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14032 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14033 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14034 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14035 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14036 .endtable
14037
14038
14039
14040 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14041 .table2
14042 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14043 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14044 directory"
14045 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14046 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14047 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14048 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14049 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14050 .endtable
14051
14052
14053
14054 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14055 .table2
14056 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14057 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14058 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14059 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14060 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14061 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14062 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14063 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14064 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14065 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14066 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14067 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14068 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14069 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14070 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14071 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14072 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14073 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14074 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14075 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14076 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14077 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14078 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14079 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14080 .endtable
14081
14082
14083
14084 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14085 .table2
14086 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14087 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14088 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14089 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14090 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14091 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14092 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14093 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14094 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14095 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14096 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14097 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14098 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14099 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14100 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14101 .endtable
14102
14103
14104
14105 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14106 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14107 &dagger;.
14108
14109 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14110 .cindex "8BITMIME"
14111 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14112 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14113 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14114 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14115 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14116 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14117 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14118
14119 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14120 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14121 It now defaults to true.
14122 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14123 .display
14124 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14125 .endd
14126
14127 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14128 .code
14129 log_selector = +8bitmime
14130 .endd
14131
14132 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14133 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14134 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14135 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14136 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14137 further details.
14138
14139 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14140 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14141 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14142 SMTP messages.
14143
14144 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14145 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14146 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14147 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14148 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14149
14150 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14151 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14152 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14153 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14154 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14155
14156 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14157 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14158 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14159 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14160
14161 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14162 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14163 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14164 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14165 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14166
14167 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14168 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14169 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14170 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14171 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14172 This option defines the ACL that,
14173 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14174 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14175 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14176 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14177
14178 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14179 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14180 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14181 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14182 of a received message.
14183 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14184
14185 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14186 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14187 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14188 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14189
14190 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14191 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14192 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14193 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14194
14195 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14196 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14197 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14198 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14199 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14200
14201
14202 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14203 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14204 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14205 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14206
14207 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14208 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14209 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14210 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14211 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14212
14213 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14214 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14215 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14216 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14217 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14218
14219 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14220 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14221 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14222 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14223 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14224
14225 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14226 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14227 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14228 further details.
14229
14230 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14231 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14232 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14233 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14234
14235 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14236 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14237 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14238 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14239
14240 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14241 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14242 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14243 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14244
14245 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14246 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14247 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14248 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14249
14250 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14251 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14252 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14253 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14254 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14255
14256 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14257 .cindex "admin user"
14258 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14259 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14260 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14261 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14262 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14263 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14264 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14265
14266 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14267 .cindex "domain literal"
14268 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14269 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14270 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14271 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14272
14273 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14274 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14275 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14276 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14277 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14278 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14279 the local host's IP addresses.
14280
14281
14282 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14283 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14284 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14285 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14286 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14287 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14288 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14289 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14290 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14291
14292 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14293 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14294 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14295 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14296 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14297 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14298 experiment if they wish.
14299
14300 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14301 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14302 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14303 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14304 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14305 suitable setting is:
14306 .code
14307 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14308 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14309 .endd
14310 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14311 .code
14312 dns_check_names_pattern =
14313 .endd
14314 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14315
14316
14317 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14318 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14319 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14320 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14321 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14322 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14323 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14324 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14325 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14326 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14327 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14328
14329 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14330 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14331 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14332 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14333 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14334 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14335
14336 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14337 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14338 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14339 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14340 .code
14341 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14342 .endd
14343 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14344 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14345 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14346 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14347
14348
14349 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14350 .cindex "thawing messages"
14351 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14352 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14353 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14354 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14355 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14356 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14357
14358 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14359 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14360 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14361
14362
14363 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14364 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14365 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14366 .code
14367 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14368 .endd
14369 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14370 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14371
14372
14373 .option bi_command main string unset
14374 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
14375 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14376 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14377 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14378 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14379
14380
14381 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14382 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14383 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14384 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14385 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14386 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14387
14388
14389 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14390 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14391 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14392 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14393
14394 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14395 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14396 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14397 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14398 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14399 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14400 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14401 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14402 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14403 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14404
14405 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14406 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14407 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14408 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14409 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14410 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14411 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14412 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14413 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14414 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14415
14416 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14417 during reception of a message.
14418 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14419
14420 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14421
14422
14423 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14424 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14425 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14426 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14427
14428
14429 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14430 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14431 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14432 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14433 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14434 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14435 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14436 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14437 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14438
14439 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14440 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14441 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14442 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14443 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14444 messages.
14445
14446 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14447 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14448 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14449 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14450 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14451 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14452 connection. A typical setting might be:
14453 .code
14454 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14455 .endd
14456 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14457 .code
14458 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14459 .endd
14460 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14461 address.
14462
14463 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14464 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14465 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14466 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14467 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14468 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14469
14470
14471 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14472 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14473 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14474 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14475
14476
14477 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14478 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14479 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14480 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14481
14482
14483 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14484 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14485 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14486 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14487
14488
14489 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14490 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14491 callout verification. The default value is
14492 .code
14493 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14494 .endd
14495 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14496
14497
14498 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14499 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14500
14501
14502 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14503 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14504
14505 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14506 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14507 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14508 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14509 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14510 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14511 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14512 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14513 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14514 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14515
14516
14517 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14518 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14519
14520
14521 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14522 .cindex "checking disk space"
14523 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14524 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14525 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14526 message is accepted.
14527
14528 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14529 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14530 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14531 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14532 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14533 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14534 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14535 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14536
14537
14538 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14539 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14540 .code
14541 check_spool_space = 100M
14542 check_spool_inodes = 100
14543 .endd
14544 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14545 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14546 transit.
14547
14548 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14549 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14550 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14551
14552 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14553 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14554 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14555 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14556 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14557 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14558
14559 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14560 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14561 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14562
14563 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14564 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14565 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14566
14567 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14568 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14569 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14570 may wish to deliberately disable them.
14571
14572 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14573 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14574 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14575 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14576 these hosts.
14577 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14578
14579 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14580 .cindex "restricting access to features"
14581 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14582 administrative user.
14583 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14584
14585 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14586 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14587 .cindex memory debugging
14588 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14589 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14590 it should normally be left as default.
14591
14592 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14593 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14594 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14595 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14596 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14597 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14598
14599 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14600 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14601 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14602 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14603 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14604 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14605 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14606
14607 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14608 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14609
14610 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14611 .cindex "warning of delay"
14612 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14613 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
14614 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14615 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14616 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14617 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14618 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14619 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14620 with
14621 .code
14622 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14623 .endd
14624 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14625 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14626 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14627 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14628 .code
14629 delay_warning = 6h
14630 .endd
14631 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14632 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14633 .code
14634 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14635 .endd
14636 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14637 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14638 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14639
14640 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14641 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14642 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14643 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14644 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14645 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14646 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14647 not sent. The default is:
14648 .code
14649 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14650 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14651 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14652 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14653 } {no}{yes}}
14654 .endd
14655 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14656 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14657 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14658 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14659
14660 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14661 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14662 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14663 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14664 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14665 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14666 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14667 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14668
14669 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14670 .cindex "load average"
14671 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14672 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14673 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14674 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14675 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14676
14677
14678 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14679 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14680 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14681 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14682 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14683 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14684 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14685 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14686
14687 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14688 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14689 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14690 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14691 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14692 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14693 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14694 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14695
14696 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14697 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14698 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14699 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14700
14701
14702 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14703 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14704 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14705 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14706 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14707 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14708 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14709
14710
14711 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14712 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14713 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14714 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14715 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14716 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
14717
14718
14719 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14720 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14721 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14722 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14723 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14724 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14725 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14726 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14727 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14728 by a setting such as this:
14729 .code
14730 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14731 .endd
14732 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14733 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14734 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14735 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14736 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14737 options are applied after this global option.
14738
14739 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14740 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14741 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14742 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14743 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14744 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14745 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14746 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14747 value of this option. The default pattern is
14748 .code
14749 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14750 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14751 .endd
14752 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14753 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14754 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14755 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14756 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14757 empty string.
14758
14759 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14760 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14761 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14762
14763 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14764 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14765 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14766 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14767
14768
14769 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14770 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14771 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14772 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14773 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14774 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14775
14776 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14777
14778
14779 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14780 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14781 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14782 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
14783 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14784 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14785 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14786 domain matches this list.
14787
14788 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14789 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14790 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14791
14792
14793 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14794 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14795 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14796 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14797 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14798 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14799 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14800 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14801 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14802 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14803 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14804 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14805 to set in them.
14806 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14807
14808
14809 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14810 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14811
14812
14813 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14814 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14815 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14816 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14817 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14818 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14819 match with this expanded domain list.
14820
14821 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14822 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14823 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14824 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14825 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14826 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14827
14828 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14829 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14830 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14831
14832 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14833 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14834 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14835 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14836 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14837
14838 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14839 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14840 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14841 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14842 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
14843 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14844 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14845 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14846 on.
14847
14848 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14849
14850 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
14851 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
14852 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
14853
14854
14855 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14856 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14857 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14858 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14859
14860 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14861 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14862 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14863 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14864 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14865 and accepted from, these hosts.
14866 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14867 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14868 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14869 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14870 are sent.
14871
14872 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14873 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14874 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14875 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14876 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14877 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14878 .code
14879 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14880 .endd
14881 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14882 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14883
14884 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14885 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14886 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14887 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14888 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14889 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14890 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14891 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14892 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14893
14894
14895 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14896 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14897 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14898 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14899 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14900 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14901 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14902 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14903 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14904
14905 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14906 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14907 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14908 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14909 are examined. For example:
14910 .code
14911 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14912 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14913 postmaster@mydomain.example
14914 .endd
14915 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14916 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14917 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14918 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14919 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14920 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14921 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14922
14923
14924 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14925 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14926 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14927 .display
14928 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14929 .endd
14930 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14931 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14932 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14933 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14934 overrides the default.
14935
14936 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14937 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14938 and warning messages. For example:
14939 .code
14940 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14941 .endd
14942 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14943 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14944 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14945 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14946 not used.
14947
14948
14949 .option event_action main string&!! unset
14950 .cindex events
14951 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
14952 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
14953
14954
14955 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14956 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14957 .cindex "Exim group"
14958 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14959 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14960 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14961 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14962 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14963 security issues.
14964
14965
14966 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14967 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14968 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14969 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14970 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14971 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14972 other place.
14973 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14974 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14975 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14976 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14977
14978
14979 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14980 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14981 .cindex "Exim user"
14982 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14983 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14984 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14985 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14986
14987 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14988 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14989 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14990 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14991
14992
14993 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14994 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14995 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14996 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14997
14998
14999 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15000 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15001
15002 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15003 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15004 .oindex "&%-t%&"
15005 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15006 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15007 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15008 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15009 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15010 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15011 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15012 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15013 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15014 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15015 addresses.
15016
15017
15018 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
15019 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15020 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15021 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15022 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15023 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15024 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15025 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15026 retries.
15027
15028 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15029 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15030 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15031 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15032
15033
15034
15035 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15036 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15037 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15038 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15039 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15040 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15041 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15042 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15043 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15044 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15045 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15046 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15047 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15048 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15049 logging that you require.
15050
15051
15052 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15053 .cindex "HP-UX"
15054 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15055 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15056 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15057 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15058 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15059 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15060 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15061 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15062
15063 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15064 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15065 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15066 user's name.
15067
15068 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15069 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15070 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15071 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15072 .code
15073 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15074 gecos_name = $1
15075 .endd
15076
15077 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15078 See &%gecos_name%& above.
15079
15080
15081 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15082 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15083 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15084 implementations of TLS.
15085
15086
15087 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15088 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15089 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15090
15091 See
15092 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15093 for documentation.
15094
15095
15096
15097 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15098 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15099 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15100 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15101 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15102 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15103
15104
15105
15106 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15107 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15108 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15109 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15110 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15111 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15112 sections are rejected.
15113
15114
15115 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15116 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15117 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15118 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15119 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15120 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15121 zero means &"no limit"&.
15122
15123
15124
15125
15126 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15127 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15128 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15129 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15130 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15131 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15132 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15133 if you want to do semantic checking.
15134 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15135 set.
15136
15137
15138 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15139 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15140 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15141 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15142 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15143 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15144 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15145 .code
15146 helo_allow_chars = _
15147 .endd
15148 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15149
15150
15151 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15152 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15153 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15154 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15155 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15156 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15157 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15158 do.
15159
15160
15161 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15162 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15163 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15164 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15165 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15166 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15167 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15168 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15169 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15170 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15171 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15172 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15173
15174 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15175 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15176 EHLO command either:
15177
15178 .ilist
15179 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15180 .next
15181 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15182 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15183 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15184 calling host address, or
15185 .next
15186 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15187 .endlist
15188
15189 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15190 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15191 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15192
15193 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15194 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15195 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15196
15197 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15198 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15199 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15200 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15201 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15202 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15203 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15204 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15205 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15206 error.
15207
15208 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15209 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15210 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15211 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
15212 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15213 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15214 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15215 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15216 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15217
15218 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15219 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15220 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15221 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15222 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15223
15224 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15225 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15226 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15227 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15228
15229
15230 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15231 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15232 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15233 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15234 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15235 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15236 default configuration file contains
15237 .code
15238 host_lookup = *
15239 .endd
15240 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15241 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15242
15243 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15244 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15245 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15246
15247 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15248 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15249 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15250 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15251 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15252 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15253
15254
15255 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15256 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15257 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15258 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15259 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15260 if you want.
15261
15262 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15263 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15264 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15265 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15266
15267
15268
15269 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15270 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15271 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15272 as soon as the connection is made.
15273 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15274 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15275 connections immediately.
15276
15277 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15278 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15279 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15280 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15281 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15282
15283
15284 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15285 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15286 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15287 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15288 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15289 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15290 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15291 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15292 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15293 .code
15294 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15295 .endd
15296 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15297
15298
15299
15300 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15301 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15302 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15303 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15304
15305
15306 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15307 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15308 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15309 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15310 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15311 records
15312 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15313 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15314
15315 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15316 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15317 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15318 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15319 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15320 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15321 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15322
15323
15324 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15325 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15326 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15327 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15328 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15329
15330
15331
15332 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15333 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15334 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15335 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15336 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15337 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15338
15339 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15340 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15341 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15342 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15343 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15344 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15345 for frozen messages. For example,
15346 .code
15347 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15348 .endd
15349 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15350 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15351 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15352 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15353 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15354 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15355
15356
15357 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15358 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15359 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15360 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15361 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15362 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15363 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15364 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15365 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15366 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15367
15368
15369 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15370 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15371
15372 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15373 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15374 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15375 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15376 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15377 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15378 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15379 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15380 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15381
15382 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15383 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15384
15385 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15386 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15387 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15388 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15389
15390 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15391 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15392 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15393 anymore.
15394
15395 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15396 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15397 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15398 details.
15399
15400
15401 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15402 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15403 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15404 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15405 logged.
15406
15407
15408 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15409 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15410 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15411 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15412 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15413 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15414 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15415 and constrained to be a directory.
15416
15417
15418 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15419 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15420 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15421 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15422 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15423 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15424 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15425 and constrained to be a file.
15426
15427
15428 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15429 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15430 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15431 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15432 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15433 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15434
15435
15436 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15437 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15438 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15439 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15440 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15441 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15442 identity to be proven.
15443
15444
15445 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15446 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15447 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15448 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15449 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15450
15451
15452 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15453 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15454 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15455 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15456 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15457 with LDAP support.
15458
15459
15460 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15461 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15462 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15463 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15464 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15465 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15466 to hard/demand.
15467
15468
15469 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15470 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15471 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15472 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15473 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15474 of SSL-on-connect.
15475 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15476 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15477 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15478
15479
15480 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15481 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15482 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15483 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15484 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15485 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15486 has been built with LDAP support.
15487
15488
15489
15490 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15491 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15492 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15493 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15494 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15495 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15496 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15497
15498 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15499 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15500 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15501
15502 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15503 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15504 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15505 and the default qualify domain.
15506
15507 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15508 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15509 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15510 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15511
15512 .cindex "envelope sender"
15513 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15514 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15515 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15516
15517 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15518 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15519 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15520
15521
15522
15523
15524 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15525 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15526 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15527 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15528 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15529 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15530 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15531 example, if
15532 .code
15533 local_from_prefix = *-
15534 .endd
15535 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15536 .code
15537 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15538 .endd
15539 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15540 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15541 qualify domain.
15542
15543
15544 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15545 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15546
15547
15548 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15549 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15550 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15551 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15552 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15553 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15554 &%local_interfaces%& is
15555 .code
15556 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15557 .endd
15558 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15559 .code
15560 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15561 .endd
15562
15563 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15564 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15565 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15566 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15567 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15568 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15569 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15570 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15571
15572
15573
15574 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15575 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15576 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15577 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15578 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15579 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15580 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15581 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15582
15583
15584
15585
15586 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15587 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15588 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15589 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15590 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15591 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15592 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15593 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15594 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15595 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15596 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15597 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15598 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15599 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15600 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15601
15602
15603
15604 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15605 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15606 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15607 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15608 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15609 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15610 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15611 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15612 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15613 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15614 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15615 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15616 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15617 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15618 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15619
15620
15621 .option log_selector main string unset
15622 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15623 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15624 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15625 minus characters. For example:
15626 .code
15627 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15628 .endd
15629 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15630 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15631
15632
15633 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15634 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15635 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15636 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15637 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15638 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15639 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15640 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15641 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15642 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15643 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15644 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15645 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15646
15647
15648 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15649 .cindex "too many open files"
15650 .cindex "open files, too many"
15651 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15652 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15653 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15654 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15655 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15656 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15657 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15658 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15659 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15660 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15661 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15662 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15663
15664
15665 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15666 .cindex "length of login name"
15667 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15668 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15669 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15670 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15671 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15672 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15673
15674
15675 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15676 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15677 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15678 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15679 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15680 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15681 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15682 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15683
15684
15685 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15686 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15687 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15688 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15689 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15690 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15691 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15692
15693
15694 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15695 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15696 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15697 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15698 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15699 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15700 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15701 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15702 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15703 empty string, the option is ignored.
15704
15705
15706 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15707 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15708 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15709 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15710 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15711 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15712 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15713 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15714 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15715 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15716 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15717 colons will become hyphens.
15718
15719
15720 .option message_logs main boolean true
15721 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15722 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15723 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15724 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15725 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15726 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15727 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15728 which is not affected by this option.
15729
15730
15731 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15732 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15733 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15734 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15735 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15736 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15737 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15738 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15739 optionally followed by K or M.
15740
15741 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15742 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15743 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15744 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15745 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15746
15747 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15748 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15749 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15750 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15751 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15752 message that an individual transport can process.
15753
15754 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15755 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15756 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15757 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15758 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15759 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15760 some problems may result.
15761
15762 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15763 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15764 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15765
15766
15767 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15768 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15769 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15770 .code
15771 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15772 .endd
15773 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15774 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15775 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15776 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15777 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15778
15779
15780 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15781 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15782 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15783 contains a full description of this facility.
15784
15785
15786
15787 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15788 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15789 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15790 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15791 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15792
15793
15794 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15795 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15796 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15797 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15798 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15799 safety precaution.
15800
15801 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15802 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15803 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15804 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15805 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15806
15807 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15808 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15809 example is
15810 .code
15811 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15812 .endd
15813 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15814 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15815 transport driver.
15816
15817
15818 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
15819 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15820 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15821 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15822 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15823
15824 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15825 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15826 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15827 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15828 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15829 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15830 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15831
15832 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15833 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15834 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15835 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15836 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15837
15838 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15839
15840 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15841 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15842 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15843 some now infamous attacks.
15844
15845 Examples:
15846 .code
15847 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15848 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15849 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15850
15851 # Disable older protocol versions:
15852 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15853 .endd
15854
15855 Possible options may include:
15856 .ilist
15857 &`all`&
15858 .next
15859 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15860 .next
15861 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15862 .next
15863 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15864 .next
15865 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
15866 .next
15867 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15868 .next
15869 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15870 .next
15871 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15872 .next
15873 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15874 .next
15875 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15876 .next
15877 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15878 .next
15879 &`no_compression`&
15880 .next
15881 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15882 .next
15883 &`no_sslv2`&
15884 .next
15885 &`no_sslv3`&
15886 .next
15887 &`no_ticket`&
15888 .next
15889 &`no_tlsv1`&
15890 .next
15891 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
15892 .next
15893 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
15894 .next
15895 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15896 .next
15897 &`single_dh_use`&
15898 .next
15899 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15900 .next
15901 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15902 .next
15903 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15904 .next
15905 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15906 .next
15907 &`tls_d5_bug`&
15908 .next
15909 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15910 .endlist
15911
15912 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15913 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15914 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15915 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15916 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15917 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15918
15919
15920 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15921 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15922 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15923 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15924 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15925
15926
15927 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15928 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15929 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15930 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15931 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15932 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15933 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15934 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15935 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15936 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15937 an ACL.
15938
15939 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15940 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15941 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15942 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15943 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15944 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15945 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15946
15947
15948 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15949 .cindex "Perl"
15950 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15951 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15952
15953
15954 .option perl_startup main string unset
15955 .cindex "Perl"
15956 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15957 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15958
15959 .option perl_startup main boolean false
15960 .cindex "Perl"
15961 This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
15962
15963
15964 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15965 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15966 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15967 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15968 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15969 PostgreSQL support.
15970
15971
15972 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15973 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15974 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15975 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15976 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15977 to the host name:
15978 .code
15979 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15980 .endd
15981 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15982 spool directory.
15983 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15984 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15985 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15986
15987
15988 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15989 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15990 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15991 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15992 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15993 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15994 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15995 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15996 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15997
15998
15999 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
16000 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16001 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16002 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16003 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16004 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16005 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16006 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16007
16008 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16009 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16010 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16011 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16012 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16013 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16014 volume of mail. Use with care!
16015
16016
16017 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16018 .cindex "name" "of local host"
16019 .cindex "host" "name of local"
16020 .cindex "local host" "name of"
16021 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16022 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16023 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16024 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16025 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16026 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16027
16028 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16029 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16030 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16031 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16032 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16033 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16034
16035
16036 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16037 .cindex "printing characters"
16038 .cindex "8-bit characters"
16039 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
16040 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16041 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16042 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16043 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16044 characters.
16045
16046 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16047 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16048 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16049 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16050 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16051 standards.
16052
16053
16054 .option process_log_path main string unset
16055 .cindex "process log path"
16056 .cindex "log" "process log"
16057 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16058 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16059 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16060 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16061 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16062 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16063 different spool directories.
16064
16065
16066 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16067 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16068 .oindex "&%-M%&"
16069 .oindex "&%-R%&"
16070 .oindex "&%-q%&"
16071 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16072 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16073 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16074
16075
16076 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16077 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16078 .cindex "address" "qualification"
16079 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16080 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16081 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16082 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16083 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16084 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16085
16086 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16087 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16088 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16089 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16090 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16091 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16092 &%primary_hostname%& value.
16093
16094
16095 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16096 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16097 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16098
16099
16100
16101 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16102 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16103 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16104 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16105 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16106 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16107 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16108 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16109
16110
16111 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16112 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16113 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
16114 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16115 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16116 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16117 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16118
16119
16120 .option queue_only main boolean false
16121 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16122 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16123 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16124 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
16125 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16126 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16127
16128 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16129 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16130 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16131 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16132
16133
16134 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16135 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16136 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16137 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16138 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16139 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16140 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16141 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16142 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16143 .code
16144 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16145 .endd
16146 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16147 &_/some/file_& exists.
16148
16149
16150 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16151 .cindex "load average"
16152 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16153 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16154 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16155 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16156 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16157 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16158 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16159 false.
16160
16161 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16162 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16163 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16164 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16165
16166
16167 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16168 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16169 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16170 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16171 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16172 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16173 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16174 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16175 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16176 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16177 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16178 re-evaluated for each message.
16179
16180
16181 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16182 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16183 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16184 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16185 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16186 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16187
16188
16189 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16190 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16191 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16192 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16193 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16194 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16195 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16196 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16197 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16198 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16199 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16200 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16201 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16202
16203
16204
16205 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16206 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16207 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16208 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16209 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16210 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16211 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16212 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16213 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16214
16215 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16216 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16217 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16218 the daemon's command line.
16219
16220 .cindex queues named
16221 .cindex "named queues"
16222 To set limits for different named queues use
16223 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16224
16225 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16226 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16227 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16228 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16229 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16230 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16231 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16232 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16233 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16234 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16235 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16236 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16237 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16238 &%queue_domains%&.
16239
16240
16241 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16242 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16243 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16244 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16245 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
16246 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16247 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16248
16249 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16250 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16251 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16252 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16253 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16254 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16255 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16256 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16257 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16258 header lines. The default setting is:
16259
16260 .code
16261 received_header_text = Received: \
16262 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16263 {${if def:sender_ident \
16264 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16265 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16266 by $primary_hostname \
16267 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
16268 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
16269 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16270 ${if def:sender_address \
16271 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16272 id $message_exim_id\
16273 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16274 .endd
16275
16276 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16277 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16278 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16279 header lines such as the following:
16280 .code
16281 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16282 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16283 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16284 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16285 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16286 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16287 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16288 .endd
16289 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16290 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16291 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16292 message was accepted.
16293
16294
16295 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16296 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16297 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16298 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16299 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16300 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16301 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16302 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16303
16304
16305 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16306 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16307 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16308 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16309 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16310 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16311 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16312 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16313 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16314 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16315 option was not set.
16316
16317
16318 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16319 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16320 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16321 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16322 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16323 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16324 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16325 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16326 done.
16327
16328 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16329 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16330 RCPT commands in a single message.
16331
16332
16333 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16334 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16335 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16336 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16337 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16338 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16339 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16340
16341
16342 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16343 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16344 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16345 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16346 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16347 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16348 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16349 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16350 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16351 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16352 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16353 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16354 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16355 tagged with its process id.
16356
16357 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16358 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16359 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16360 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16361 is received.
16362
16363 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16364 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16365 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16366 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16367 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16368 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16369 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16370 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16371 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16372 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16373 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16374
16375 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16376 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16377 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16378 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16379
16380
16381 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16382 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16383 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16384 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16385 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16386 .code
16387 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16388 .endd
16389 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16390 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16391
16392
16393 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16394 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16395 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16396 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16397 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16398 past failures.
16399
16400
16401 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16402 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16403 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16404 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16405 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16406 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16407 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16408 the default value.
16409
16410
16411 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16412 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16413 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16414 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16415 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16416 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16417 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16418 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16419 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16420 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16421
16422
16423 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16424 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16425
16426
16427 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16428 .cindex "RFC 1413"
16429 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16430 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16431 an item in the list.
16432 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16433 for the system.
16434
16435 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16436 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16437 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16438 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16439 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16440
16441
16442 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16443 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16444 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16445 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16446 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16447 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16448 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16449 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16450 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16451 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16452
16453 .option set_environment main "string list" empty
16454 .cindex "environment"
16455 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16456 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16457 default list is empty,
16458
16459
16460 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16461 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16462 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16463 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16464 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16465 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16466 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16467
16468
16469
16470 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16471 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16472 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16473 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16474 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16475 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16476 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16477 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16478 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16479 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16480 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16481
16482
16483
16484 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16485 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16486 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16487 .cindex "inetd"
16488 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16489 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16490 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16491 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16492 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16493 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16494
16495 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16496 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16497 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16498 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16499
16500
16501 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16502 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16503 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16504 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16505 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16506 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16507 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16508 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16509
16510 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16511 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16512 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16513 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16514 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16515 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16516 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16517 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16518
16519
16520 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16521 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16522 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16523 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16524 live with.
16525
16526
16527 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16528 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16529 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16530 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16531 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16532 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16533 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16534 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16535 . the option name to split.
16536
16537 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16538 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16539 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16540 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16541 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16542 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16543 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16544 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16545 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16546 seen).
16547
16548
16549 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16550 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16551 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16552 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16553 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16554 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16555 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16556 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16557 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16558 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16559 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16560
16561 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16562 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16563 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16564 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16565 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16566 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16567
16568
16569
16570 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16571 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16572 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16573 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16574 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16575 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16576 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16577 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16578 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16579 to all messages received in the same connection.
16580
16581 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16582 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16583 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16584 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16585
16586
16587 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16588
16589 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16590 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16591 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16592 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16593 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16594 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16595 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16596 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16597 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16598 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16599 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16600 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16601 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16602
16603
16604 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16605 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16606 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16607 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16608 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16609 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16610 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16611 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16612 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16613 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16614 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16615 individual host.
16616
16617 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16618 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16619 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16620 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16621
16622
16623 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16624 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16625 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16626 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16627 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16628 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16629 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16630 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16631 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16632
16633 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16634 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16635 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16636 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16637
16638 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16639 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16640 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16641 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16642 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16643 For example:
16644 .code
16645 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16646 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16647 .endd
16648
16649 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16650 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16651 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16652 &%helo_data%& value.
16653
16654 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16655 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16656 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16657 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16658 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16659 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16660 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16661 .code
16662 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16663 $version_number $tod_full
16664 .endd
16665 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16666 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16667 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16668 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16669 multiline response).
16670
16671
16672 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16673 .cindex "checking disk space"
16674 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16675 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16676 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16677 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16678 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16679 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16680 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16681
16682
16683 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16684 .cindex "connection backlog"
16685 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16686 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16687 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16688 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16689 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16690 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16691 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16692 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16693 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16694 attacks by SYN flooding.
16695
16696
16697 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16698 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16699 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16700 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16701 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16702 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16703 fewer, but they still exist.
16704
16705 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16706 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16707 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16708 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16709 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16710 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16711 does detect many instances.
16712
16713 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16714 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16715 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16716 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16717
16718
16719
16720 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16721 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16722 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16723 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16724 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16725 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16726 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16727 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16728 example:
16729 .code
16730 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16731 $sender_host_address
16732 .endd
16733 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16734 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16735 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16736 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16737 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16738 the command.
16739
16740
16741 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16742 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16743 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16744 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16745 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16746
16747
16748 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16749 .cindex "load average"
16750 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16751 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16752 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16753 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16754 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16755 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16756
16757
16758
16759 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16760 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16761 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16762 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16763 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16764 .code
16765 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16766 .endd
16767 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16768 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16769 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16770 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16771 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16772
16773 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16774 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16775 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16776 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16777 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16778 not count towards the limit.
16779
16780
16781
16782 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16783 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16784 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16785 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16786 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16787 that subvert web
16788 clients
16789 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16790 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16791
16792
16793
16794 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16795 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16796 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16797 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16798 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16799 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16800 recipients.
16801
16802 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16803 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16804 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16805 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16806
16807 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16808 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16809 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16810 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16811 values:
16812
16813 .ilist
16814 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16815 .next
16816 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16817 fractional parts are allowed here.
16818 .next
16819 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16820 .next
16821 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16822 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16823 .endlist
16824
16825 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16826 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16827 .code
16828 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16829 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16830 .endd
16831 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16832 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16833 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16834 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16835
16836
16837 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16838 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16839
16840
16841 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16842 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16843
16844
16845 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16846 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16847 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16848 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16849 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16850 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16851 the message is abandoned.
16852 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16853 .code
16854 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16855 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16856 .endd
16857 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16858 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16859
16860 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16861 expanded before use and may depend on
16862 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16863
16864
16865 .oindex "&%-os%&"
16866 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16867 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16868 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16869 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16870 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16871
16872
16873 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16874 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16875 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16876
16877
16878 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16879 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16880 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16881 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16882 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16883 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16884 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16885 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16886 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16887 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16888 .code
16889 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16890 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16891 .endd
16892
16893
16894 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16895 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
16896 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
16897 the availability thereof is advertised in
16898 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16899 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
16900
16901
16902 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
16903 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16904 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16905 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16906
16907
16908
16909 .new
16910 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
16911 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
16912 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
16913 .wen
16914
16915
16916
16917 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16918 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16919 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16920 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16921 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16922 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16923 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16924 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16925 arrival of the message.
16926
16927 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16928 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16929 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16930 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16931 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16932
16933 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16934 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16935 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16936 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16937 automatically deleted.
16938
16939 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16940 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16941 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16942 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16943 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16944 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16945 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16946 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16947 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16948
16949
16950 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16951 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16952 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16953 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16954 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16955 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16956 &$primary_hostname$&.
16957
16958 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16959 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16960 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16961 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16962 as failures in the configuration file.
16963
16964 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16965 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16966
16967 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
16968 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
16969 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternate format
16970 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
16971 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
16972 Currently it is only done for messages received using the EMSTP CHUNKING
16973 option.
16974
16975 The following variables will not have useful values:
16976 .code
16977 $max_received_linelength
16978 $body_linecount
16979 $body_zerocount
16980 .endd
16981
16982 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
16983 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
16984 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
16985 will need to be aware of the potential different format.
16986
16987 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
16988 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
16989 The transmission benefit is maintained.
16990
16991 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16992 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16993 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16994 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16995
16996 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16997 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16998 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16999 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17000 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17001 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17002
17003 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17004 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17005 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17006 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17007 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17008 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17009 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17010
17011
17012 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17013 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17014 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17015 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17016 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17017 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17018 domain causes a syntax error.
17019 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17020 syntax checking.
17021
17022
17023 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17024 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17025 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17026 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17027 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17028 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17029 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17030 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17031 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17032 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17033 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17034 the LOG_ALERT priority.
17035
17036
17037 .option syslog_facility main string unset
17038 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17039 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17040 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17041 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17042 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17043 details of Exim's logging.
17044
17045
17046 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
17047 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
17048 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17049 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17050 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17051 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17052 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17053
17054
17055
17056 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17057 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17058 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17059 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17060 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17061
17062
17063
17064 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17065 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17066 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17067 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17068 details of Exim's logging.
17069
17070
17071 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
17072 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
17073 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17074 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17075 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17076 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17077 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17078 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17079 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17080 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17081 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17082 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17083
17084
17085 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17086 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
17087 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17088 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17089 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17090 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17091
17092
17093 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17094 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17095 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17096 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17097 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17098
17099 .option system_filter_group main string unset
17100 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17101 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17102 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17103 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17104
17105 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17106 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17107 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17108 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17109 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17110 contains the pipe command.
17111
17112
17113 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17114 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17115 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17116 is used in a system filter.
17117
17118
17119 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17120 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17121 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17122 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17123 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17124 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17125 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17126 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17127 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17128 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17129
17130 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17131 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17132 transport option overrides.
17133
17134
17135 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17136 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17137 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17138 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17139 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17140 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17141 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17142 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17143 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17144 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17145 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17146 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17147 TCP_NODELAY.
17148
17149
17150 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17151 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17152 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17153 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17154 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
17155 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17156 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17157 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17158 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17159 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17160
17161 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17162 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17163 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17164
17165
17166 .option timezone main string unset
17167 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17168 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17169 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17170 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17171 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17172 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17173 .code
17174 timezone = UTC
17175 .endd
17176 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17177 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17178 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17179 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17180 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17181 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17182
17183
17184 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17185 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17186 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17187 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17188 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17189 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17190 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17191 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17192 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17193 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17194 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17195
17196
17197 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17198 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17199 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17200 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17201 files which contains the server's certificates. Commonly only one file is
17202 needed.
17203 The server's private key is also
17204 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17205 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17206
17207 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17208 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17209 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17210 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17211
17212 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17213 separator in the usual way to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17214
17215 &*Note*&: Under current versions of OpenSSL, when a list of more than one
17216 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17217
17218 &*Note*&: OCSP stapling is not usable under OpenSSL
17219 when a list of more than one file is used.
17220
17221 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17222 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17223 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17224 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17225
17226 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17227 generated for every connection.
17228
17229 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17230 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17231 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17232 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17233 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17234
17235 .new
17236 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17237
17238 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17239 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17240 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17241 .wen
17242
17243 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17244
17245
17246 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17247 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17248 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17249 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17250 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17251 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17252
17253 The value must be at least 1024.
17254
17255 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17256 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17257 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17258
17259 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17260 number.
17261
17262 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17263 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17264 larger prime than requested.
17265
17266
17267 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17268 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17269 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17270 to be used by Exim.
17271
17272 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17273 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17274 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17275 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17276
17277 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17278 then it names a file from which DH
17279 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17280 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17281 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17282 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17283 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17284 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17285
17286 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17287 loaded by Exim.
17288
17289 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17290 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17291 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17292 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17293
17294 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17295 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17296
17297 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17298 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17299 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17300
17301 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17302 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17303 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17304 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17305 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17306
17307 The available standard primes are:
17308 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17309 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17310 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17311 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17312
17313 The available additional primes are:
17314 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17315
17316 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17317 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17318 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17319 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17320 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17321
17322 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17323 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17324 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17325
17326 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17327 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17328 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17329 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17330 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17331 userbase.
17332
17333 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17334 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17335 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17336 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17337 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17338 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17339 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17340
17341
17342 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17343 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17344 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17345 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17346
17347 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17348 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17349 for valid selections.
17350
17351 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17352 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17353 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17354
17355 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17356
17357
17358 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17359 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17360 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17361 This option
17362 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17363 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17364 Certificate Authority.
17365
17366 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17367
17368 .new
17369 For GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17370 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17371 The ordering of the two lists must match.
17372 .wen
17373
17374
17375 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17376 .cindex SSMTP
17377 .cindex SMTPS
17378 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17379 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17380 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17381 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17382
17383
17384
17385 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17386 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17387 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17388 files which contains the server's private keys.
17389 If this option is unset, or if
17390 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17391 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17392 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17393
17394 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17395
17396
17397 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17398 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17399 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17400 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17401 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17402 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17403 TLS session.
17404
17405
17406 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17407 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17408 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17409 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17410 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17411 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17412 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17413 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17414 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17415 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17416 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17417
17418
17419 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17420 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17421 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17422 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17423
17424
17425 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17426 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17427 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17428 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17429 word "system"
17430 or the absolute path to
17431 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17432 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17433
17434 The "system" value for the option will use a
17435 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17436 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17437 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17438 must be specified.
17439
17440 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17441 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17442
17443 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17444 explicitly
17445 either by file or directory
17446 are added to those given by the system default location.
17447
17448 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17449 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17450 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17451 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17452 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17453 use the explicit directory version.
17454
17455 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17456
17457 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17458 being unset.
17459
17460
17461 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17462 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17463 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17464 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17465 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17466 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17467 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17468 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17469
17470 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17471 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17472 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17473 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17474 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17475 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17476 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17477
17478 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17479 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17480 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17481 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17482 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17483 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17484 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17485 certificate"&.
17486
17487 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17488 certificates.
17489
17490
17491 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17492 .cindex "trusted groups"
17493 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17494 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17495 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17496 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17497 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17498 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17499 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17500 are trusted.
17501
17502 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17503 .cindex "trusted users"
17504 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17505 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17506 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17507 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17508 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17509 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17510 Exim user are trusted.
17511
17512 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17513 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17514 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17515 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17516 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17517 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17518 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17519 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17520 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17521 &%-F%& option.
17522
17523 .option unknown_username main string unset
17524 See &%unknown_login%&.
17525
17526 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17527 .cindex "trusted users"
17528 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17529 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17530 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17531 .cindex "envelope sender"
17532 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17533 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17534 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17535 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17536 is used) is ignored.
17537
17538 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17539 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17540 .code
17541 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17542 .endd
17543 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17544 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17545 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17546 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17547 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17548 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17549 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17550 followed by a hyphen
17551 by a setting like this:
17552 .code
17553 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17554 .endd
17555 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17556 restriction, you can use
17557 .code
17558 untrusted_set_sender = *
17559 .endd
17560 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17561 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17562 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17563 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17564 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17565 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17566 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17567 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17568
17569 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17570 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17571 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17572 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17573 sender address.
17574
17575
17576 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17577 .cindex "&""From""& line"
17578 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17579 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17580 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17581 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17582 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17583 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17584 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17585 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17586 .code
17587 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17588 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17589 .endd
17590 The pattern can be seen by running
17591 .code
17592 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17593 .endd
17594 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17595 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17596 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17597 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17598 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17599 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17600
17601
17602 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17603 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17604
17605
17606 .option warn_message_file main string unset
17607 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17608 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17609 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17610 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17611 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17612 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17613 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17614
17615
17616 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17617 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17618 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17619 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17620 .ecindex IIDconfima
17621 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
17622
17623
17624
17625
17626 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17627 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17628
17629 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17630 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17631 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17632 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17633 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
17634
17635 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17636 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17637 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17638 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17639 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17640
17641
17642
17643 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
17644 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17645 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17646 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17647 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17648 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17649 delivery of the address to be deferred.
17650
17651 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17652 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17653 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17654 routers, and the eventual transport.
17655
17656 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17657 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17658 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17659 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17660 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17661
17662 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17663 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17664 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17665 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17666 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17667
17668 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17669 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17670 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17671 .code
17672 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17673 .endd
17674 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17675 .code
17676 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17677 .endd
17678 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17679 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17680
17681 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17682 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17683 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17684 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17685 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17686 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17687 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17688
17689
17690
17691 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17692 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
17693 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17694 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17695 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17696 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17697 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17698 routing.
17699
17700
17701
17702 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17703 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17704 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17705 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17706 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17707 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17708 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17709 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17710 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17711 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17712 you could put:
17713 .code
17714 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17715 .endd
17716 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17717 and
17718 .code
17719 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17720 .endd
17721 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17722 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17723 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17724 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17725
17726
17727 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17728 .cindex "case of local parts"
17729 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17730 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17731 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17732 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17733 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17734 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17735 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17736 more details.
17737
17738 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17739 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17740 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17741 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17742 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17743 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17744 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17745 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17746 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17747
17748 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17749 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17750 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17751 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17752
17753
17754
17755 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17756 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17757 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17758 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17759 .vindex "&$home$&"
17760 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17761 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17762 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17763 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17764 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17765 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17766 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17767 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17768 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17769 the router is skipped.
17770
17771 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17772 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17773 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17774 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17775 setting to achieve this. For example:
17776 .code
17777 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17778 .endd
17779 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17780 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17781 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17782
17783
17784
17785 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17786 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17787 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17788 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17789 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17790 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17791 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17792 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17793
17794 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17795 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17796
17797 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17798 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17799
17800 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17801 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17802 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17803 .code
17804 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17805 .endd
17806 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17807 .code
17808 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17809 .endd
17810
17811 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17812 .code
17813 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17814 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17815 condition = foobar
17816 .endd
17817
17818 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17819 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17820 be specified using &%condition%&.
17821
17822 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17823 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17824 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17825 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17826 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17827 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17828 Router rules processing behavior.
17829
17830 This is best illustrated in an example:
17831 .code
17832 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17833 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17834
17835 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17836 true {yes} {no}}
17837
17838 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17839 {yes} {no}}
17840 .endd
17841 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17842 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17843 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17844 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17845 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17846 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17847 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17848 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17849
17850 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17851 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17852 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17853 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17854 string characters.
17855
17856 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17857 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17858 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17859 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17860 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17861
17862
17863 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17864 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17865 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17866 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17867 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17868 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17869 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17870 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17871 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17872 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17873 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17874 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17875 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17876 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17877
17878
17879
17880 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17881 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17882 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17883 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17884 transport option of the same name.
17885
17886 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17887 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17888 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17889 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17890 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17891 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17892 the dnssec request bit set.
17893 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17894
17895 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17896 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17897 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17898 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17899 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17900 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
17901 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17902 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17903 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17904
17905
17906 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17907 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17908 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17909 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17910 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17911 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17912 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17913 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17914
17915
17916
17917 .option driver routers string unset
17918 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17919 to be used.
17920
17921
17922 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17923 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17924 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17925 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17926 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17927 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17928 Not effective on redirect routers.
17929
17930
17931
17932 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17933 .cindex "envelope sender"
17934 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17935 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17936 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17937 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17938 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17939 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17940 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17941
17942 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17943 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17944 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17945 setting.
17946
17947 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17948 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17949 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17950 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17951
17952 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17953 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17954 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17955 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17956 settings:
17957 .code
17958 errors_to =
17959 errors_to = ""
17960 .endd
17961 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17962 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17963 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17964 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17965 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17966
17967 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17968 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17969 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17970 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17971 setting &%return_path%&.
17972
17973 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17974 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17975 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17976
17977
17978
17979 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17980 .cindex "address" "testing"
17981 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17982 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17983 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17984 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17985 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17986 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17987 on for the system alias file.
17988 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17989 are evaluated.
17990
17991 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17992 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17993 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17994
17995
17996
17997 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17998 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17999 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18000 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18001
18002
18003
18004 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18005 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18006 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18007
18008
18009
18010 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18011 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18012 verifying a sender, verification fails.
18013
18014
18015
18016 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18017 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18018 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18019 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18020 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18021 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
18022 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18023 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18024 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18025
18026 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18027 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18028 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18029 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18030 transport for further details.
18031
18032
18033 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
18034 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18035 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18036 .cindex "transport" "local"
18037 .cindex "router" "setting group"
18038 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18039 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18040 process.
18041 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18042 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18043 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18044 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18045 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18046
18047
18048
18049 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18050 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
18051 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18052 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18053 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
18054 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18055 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18056 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18057 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18058 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18059 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18060 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18061 &"see"& the added header lines.
18062
18063 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18064 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18065 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18066 failures are treated as configuration errors.
18067
18068 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18069 for a router; all listed headers are added.
18070
18071 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18072 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18073
18074 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18075 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
18076 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18077 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18078 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18079 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18080 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18081 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18082 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18083 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18084
18085
18086
18087 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18088 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18089 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18090 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18091 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
18092 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18093 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18094 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18095 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18096 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18097 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18098 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18099 &"see"& the original header lines.
18100
18101 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18102 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18103 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18104 errors.
18105
18106 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18107 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18108
18109 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18110 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18111
18112 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18113 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18114 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18115 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18116
18117 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18118 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18119 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18120
18121
18122
18123 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18124 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18125 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18126 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18127 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18128 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18129 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18130 like
18131 .code
18132 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18133 .endd
18134 by setting
18135 .code
18136 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18137 .endd
18138 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18139 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18140 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18141 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18142 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18143 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18144
18145 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18146 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18147 .code
18148 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18149 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18150 .endd
18151 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18152 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18153
18154 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18155 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18156 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18157 domain that is being routed.
18158
18159 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18160 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18161 checked.
18162
18163 .option initgroups routers boolean false
18164 .cindex "additional groups"
18165 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18166 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18167 .cindex "transport" "local"
18168 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18169 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18170 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18171 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18172 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18173
18174
18175
18176 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18177 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18178 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18179 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18180 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18181 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18182 evaluated.
18183
18184 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18185 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18186 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18187 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18188 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18189 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18190 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18191 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18192 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18193
18194 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18195 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18196 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18197 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18198 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18199 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18200 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18201 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18202 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18203 the relevant transport.
18204
18205 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18206 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18207 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18208 callout.
18209
18210 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18211 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18212 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18213 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18214 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18215 .code
18216 real_localuser:
18217 driver = accept
18218 local_part_prefix = real-
18219 check_local_user
18220 transport = local_delivery
18221 .endd
18222 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18223 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18224 .code
18225 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18226 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18227 .endd
18228
18229 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18230 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18231 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18232 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18233
18234
18235 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18236 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18237
18238
18239
18240 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18241 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18242 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18243 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18244 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18245 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18246 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18247 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18248 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18249 &%username-foo%&.
18250
18251
18252 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18253 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18254
18255
18256
18257 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18258 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18259 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18260 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18261 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18262 are evaluated, and
18263 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18264 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18265 example:
18266 .code
18267 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18268 .endd
18269 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18270 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18271 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18272 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18273 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18274 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18275 each virtual domain:
18276 .code
18277 postmaster:
18278 driver = redirect
18279 local_parts = postmaster
18280 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18281 .endd
18282
18283
18284 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18285 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18286 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18287 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18288 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18289 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18290 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18291 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18292 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18293 redirect addresses.
18294
18295
18296
18297 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18298 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18299 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18300 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18301 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18302 delivery to be deferred.
18303
18304 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18305 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18306 .oindex "&%self%&"
18307 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18308 means of the setting
18309 .code
18310 self = pass
18311 .endd
18312 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18313 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18314 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18315
18316 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18317 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18318 controls what happens next.
18319
18320
18321 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18322 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18323 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18324 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18325 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18326 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18327 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18328 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18329
18330 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18331 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18332 applies to all of them.
18333
18334
18335
18336 .option pass_router routers string unset
18337 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18338 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18339 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18340 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18341 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18342 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18343 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18344 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18345 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18346 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18347
18348
18349
18350 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18351 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18352 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18353 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18354 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18355 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18356
18357 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18358 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18359 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18360 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18361
18362
18363
18364 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18365 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18366 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18367 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18368 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18369 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18370 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18371
18372 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18373 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
18374 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18375 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18376
18377 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18378 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18379 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18380 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18381 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18382
18383 .cindex "NFS"
18384 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18385 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18386 unavailable.
18387
18388 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18389 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18390 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18391 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18392 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18393 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18394 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18395 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
18396
18397 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18398 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18399 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18400 operates as follows:
18401
18402 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18403 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18404 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18405 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18406 used. For example:
18407 .code
18408 require_files = mail:/some/file
18409 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18410 .endd
18411 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18412 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18413
18414 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18415 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18416 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18417 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18418
18419 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18420 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18421 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18422 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18423 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18424
18425 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18426 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18427 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18428 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18429 check again in that process.
18430
18431 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18432 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18433 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18434 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18435 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
18436 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18437 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18438 .code
18439 require_files = +/some/file
18440 .endd
18441 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18442 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18443 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18444
18445
18446
18447 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18448 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18449 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18450 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18451 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18452 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18453 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18454 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18455 latter kind.
18456
18457 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18458 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18459 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18460 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18461 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18462 same name.
18463
18464 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18465 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18466 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18467
18468
18469
18470 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18471 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
18472 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
18473 .vindex "&$home$&"
18474 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18475 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18476 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18477 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18478 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18479 cause the router to defer.
18480
18481 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18482 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18483 place.
18484 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18485 are evaluated.)
18486 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18487 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18488
18489 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18490 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18491 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18492 of these values that is set:
18493
18494 .ilist
18495 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18496 .next
18497 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18498 .next
18499 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18500 .next
18501 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18502 .endlist
18503
18504 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18505 router, but not for the transport.
18506
18507
18508
18509 .option self routers string freeze
18510 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18511 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18512 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18513 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18514 and &(manualroute)& routers.
18515 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18516 of remote hosts.
18517 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18518 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18519 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18520 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18521 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18522
18523 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18524 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18525 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18526 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18527 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18528 cases:
18529
18530 .vlist
18531 .vitem &%defer%&
18532 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18533
18534 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18535 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18536 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18537 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18538
18539 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18540 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18541 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18542 rewritten.
18543
18544 .vitem &%pass%&
18545 .oindex "&%more%&"
18546 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18547 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18548 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18549 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18550 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18551 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18552 combination
18553 .code
18554 self = pass
18555 no_more
18556 .endd
18557 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18558 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18559 be passed to the next router.
18560
18561 .vitem &%fail%&
18562 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18563
18564 .vitem &%send%&
18565 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
18566 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18567 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18568 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18569 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18570 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18571 .endlist
18572
18573
18574
18575 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18576 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
18577 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18578 address matches something on the list.
18579 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18580 are evaluated.
18581
18582 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18583 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18584 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18585 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18586 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18587 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18588 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18589 matters.
18590
18591
18592 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18593 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
18594 .cindex "packet radio"
18595 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18596 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18597 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18598 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18599 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18600 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18601 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18602 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18603
18604 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18605 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18606 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18607 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18608 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18609 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18610 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18611 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18612 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18613 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18614 .code
18615 translate_ip_address = \
18616 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18617 {$value}fail}}
18618 .endd
18619 The file would contain lines like
18620 .code
18621 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
18622 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18623 .endd
18624 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18625 are doing.
18626
18627
18628
18629 .option transport routers string&!! unset
18630 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18631 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18632 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18633 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18634 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18635 delivery is deferred.
18636
18637 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18638 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18639 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18640
18641
18642
18643 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18644 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18645 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18646 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18647 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18648 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18649 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18650 overridden by a setting on the transport.
18651 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18652 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18653 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18654 environment.
18655
18656
18657
18658
18659 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18660 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18661 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18662 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18663 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18664 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18665 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18666 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18667 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18668 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18669
18670 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18671 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18672 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18673 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18674 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18675
18676 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18677 environment.
18678
18679
18680
18681
18682 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18683 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18684 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18685 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18686 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18687 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18688 delivery to be deferred.
18689
18690 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18691 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18692 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18693 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18694 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18695 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18696
18697 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18698 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18699 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18700 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18701 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18702 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18703 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18704 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18705
18706 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18707 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18708 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18709 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18710 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18711 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18712 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18713 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18714 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18715 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18716
18717 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18718 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18719 subsequent routers.
18720
18721
18722 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18723 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18724 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18725 .cindex "transport" "local"
18726 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18727 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18728 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18729 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18730 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18731 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18732 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18733 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18734 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18735 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18736 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18737 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18738
18739
18740
18741 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18742 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18743 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18744
18745
18746 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18747 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18748 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
18749 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18750 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18751 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18752 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18753 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18754 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18755 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18756
18757 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18758 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18759 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18760 user or group.
18761
18762
18763 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18764 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18765 addresses,
18766 delivering in cutthrough mode
18767 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18768 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18769 are evaluated.
18770 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18771
18772
18773 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18774 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18775 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18776 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18777 are evaluated.
18778 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18779 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18780 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18781
18782
18783
18784
18785
18786
18787 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18788 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18789
18790 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18791 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18792 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18793 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18794 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18795 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18796 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18797 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18798 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18799 .code
18800 localusers:
18801 driver = accept
18802 domains = mydomain.example
18803 check_local_user
18804 transport = local_delivery
18805 .endd
18806 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18807 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18808 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18809 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18810
18811
18812
18813
18814
18815
18816 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18817 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18818
18819 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18820 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18821 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18822 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18823 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18824 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18825
18826 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18827 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18828 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18829 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18830 records.
18831
18832 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18833 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18834 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18835 .new
18836 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18837 .wen
18838 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18839 generic option, the router declines.
18840
18841 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18842 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18843 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18844
18845 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18846 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18847 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18848 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18849 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18850 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18851
18852
18853 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18854 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18855 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18856 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18857 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18858 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18859
18860 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18861 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18862 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18863 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18864 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18865 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18866 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18867 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18868 case routing fails.
18869
18870
18871 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18872 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18873 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18874 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18875 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18876
18877 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18878 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18879
18880 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18881 .ilist
18882 The domain does not exist in DNS
18883 .next
18884 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18885 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18886 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18887 .next
18888 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18889 .next
18890 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18891 .next
18892 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18893 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18894 .next
18895 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18896 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18897 .next
18898 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18899 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18900 .next
18901 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18902 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18903 .endlist
18904
18905
18906
18907
18908 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18909 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18910 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18911
18912 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18913 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18914 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18915 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18916 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18917 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18918 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18919
18920
18921 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18922 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18923 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18924 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18925 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18926 required. For example,
18927 .code
18928 check_srv = smtp
18929 .endd
18930 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18931 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18932 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18933 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18934 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18935 normal way.
18936
18937 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18938 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18939 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18940 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18941 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18942 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18943
18944 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18945 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18946 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18947 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18948 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18949 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18950 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18951 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18952
18953 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18954 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18955
18956
18957
18958
18959 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18960 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18961 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18962 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18963 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18964 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18965 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18966 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18967 also being queued.
18968
18969
18970 .new
18971 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
18972 .cindex IPv6 disabling
18973 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
18974 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
18975 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
18976 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
18977 only A records are used.
18978
18979 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
18980 .cindex IPv4 preference
18981 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
18982 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
18983 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
18984 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
18985 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
18986 .wen
18987
18988 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18989 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18990 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18991 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18992 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18993 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18994 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18995 setting:
18996 .code
18997 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18998 .endd
18999 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19000 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19001 the address record.
19002
19003
19004 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19005 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19006 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19007 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19008
19009
19010
19011
19012 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19013 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19014 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19015 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19016 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19017 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19018 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19019 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19020 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19021 &'resolv.conf'&.
19022
19023
19024
19025 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19026 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19027 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19028 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19029 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19030 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19031 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19032 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19033 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19034 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19035 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19036
19037 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19038 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19039 sense.
19040
19041 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19042 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19043 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19044 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19045 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19046 header rewriting.
19047
19048
19049 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19050 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19051 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19052 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19053 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19054 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19055 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19056 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19057
19058 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19059 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19060 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19061 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19062 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19063 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19064 without processing them independently,
19065 provided the following conditions are met:
19066
19067 .ilist
19068 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19069 &%headers_remove%&.
19070 .next
19071 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19072 the domain.
19073 .endlist
19074
19075
19076
19077
19078 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19079 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19080 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19081 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19082 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19083 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19084 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19085 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19086 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19087 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19088
19089 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19090 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19091 local wildcard.
19092
19093
19094
19095 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19096 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19097 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19098 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19099
19100
19101
19102
19103 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19104 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19105 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19106 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19107 if
19108 .code
19109 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19110 .endd
19111 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19112 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19113 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19114 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19115 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19116 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19117
19118
19119 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19120 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19121 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19122 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19123 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19124
19125 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19126 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19127 such as that implied by
19128 .code
19129 domains = @mx_any
19130 .endd
19131 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19132 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19133 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19134 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19135
19136
19137
19138
19139
19140
19141
19142
19143
19144 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19145 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19146
19147 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19148 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19149 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19150 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19151 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19152 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19153 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19154 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19155 router handles the address
19156 .code
19157 root@[192.168.1.1]
19158 .endd
19159 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19160 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19161 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19162 .code
19163 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19164 .endd
19165 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19166 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19167
19168 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19169 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19170 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19171 &%self%& option determines what happens.
19172
19173 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19174 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19175 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19176 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19177
19178
19179
19180 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19181 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19182
19183 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19184 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19185 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19186 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19187 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19188 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19189 must set
19190 .code
19191 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19192 .endd
19193 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19194
19195 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19196 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19197 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19198 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19199 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19200 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19201 must not be specified for it.
19202
19203 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19204 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19205 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19206 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19207 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19208 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19209 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19210
19211
19212 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19213 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19214 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19215 delivery to the address is deferred.
19216
19217
19218 .option port iplookup integer 0
19219 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19220 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19221 call.
19222
19223
19224 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19225 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19226 protocols is to be used.
19227
19228
19229 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19230 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19231 default value is:
19232 .code
19233 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19234 .endd
19235 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19236 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19237
19238
19239 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19240 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19241 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19242 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19243 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19244 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19245 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19246 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19247
19248
19249 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19250 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19251 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19252 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19253 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19254 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19255 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19256 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19257 following could be used:
19258 .code
19259 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19260 reroute = $local_part@$1
19261 .endd
19262
19263 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19264 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19265 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19266 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19267
19268
19269
19270
19271 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19272 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19273
19274 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19275 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19276 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19277 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19278 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19279 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19280 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19281 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19282 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19283 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19284
19285 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19286 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19287 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19288 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19289 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19290 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19291 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19292
19293 .vindex "&$host$&"
19294 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19295 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19296 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19297 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19298 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19299 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19300 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19301 text string.
19302
19303 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19304 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19305 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19306 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19307 below, following the list of private options.
19308
19309
19310 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19311
19312 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19313 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19314
19315 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19316 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19317
19318 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19319 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19320 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19321 of the following values:
19322 .code
19323 decline
19324 defer
19325 fail
19326 freeze
19327 ignore
19328 pass
19329 .endd
19330 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19331 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19332 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19333 &%pass_router%&),
19334 .oindex "&%more%&"
19335 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19336 router only if &%more%& is true.
19337
19338 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19339 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19340 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19341 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19342
19343 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19344 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19345 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19346
19347
19348 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19349 .cindex "randomized host list"
19350 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19351 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19352 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19353 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19354 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19355 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19356 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19357 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19358
19359 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19360 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19361 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19362 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19363 .code
19364 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19365 .endd
19366 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19367 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19368 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19369 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19370 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19371
19372
19373 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19374 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19375 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19376 example:
19377 .code
19378 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19379 .endd
19380 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19381 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19382 deferred.
19383
19384
19385 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19386 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19387 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19388 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19389
19390
19391 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19392 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19393 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19394 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19395 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19396 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19397 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19398 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19399
19400 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19401 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19402 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19403 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19404 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19405 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19406 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19407 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19408
19409
19410
19411
19412 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19413 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19414 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19415 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19416 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19417 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19418 .display
19419 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19420 .endd
19421 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19422 no options:
19423 .code
19424 route_list = \
19425 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19426 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19427 .endd
19428 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19429 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19430 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19431 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19432 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19433 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19434 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19435 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19436 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19437 in a &%route_list%&).
19438
19439 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19440 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19441 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19442 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19443
19444
19445
19446 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19447 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19448 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19449 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19450 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19451 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19452 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19453 like this:
19454 .code
19455 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19456 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19457 .endd
19458 This data can be accessed by setting
19459 .code
19460 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19461 .endd
19462 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19463 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19464 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19465 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19466 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19467
19468
19469
19470
19471 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19472 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19473 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19474 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19475 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
19476 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19477 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19478
19479 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19480 variables are set during its expansion:
19481
19482 .ilist
19483 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19484 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19485 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19486 .code
19487 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19488 .endd
19489 .next
19490 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19491 .next
19492 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19493
19494 .next
19495 .vindex "&$value$&"
19496 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19497 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19498 .code
19499 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19500 .endd
19501 .endlist
19502
19503 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19504 semicolon is the default route list separator.
19505
19506
19507
19508 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19509 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19510 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19511 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19512 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19513 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19514
19515 .ilist
19516 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19517 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19518 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19519 .code
19520 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19521 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19522 .endd
19523 .next
19524 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19525 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19526 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19527 number follows. For example:
19528 .code
19529 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19530 .endd
19531 .endlist
19532
19533 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19534 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19535 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19536 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19537 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19538 transport.
19539
19540 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19541 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19542 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19543 records in the DNS. For example:
19544 .code
19545 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19546 .endd
19547 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19548 example:
19549 .code
19550 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19551 .endd
19552 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19553 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19554 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19555 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19556 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19557 happens is controlled by the
19558 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19559 &%self%& option of the router.
19560
19561 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19562 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19563 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19564 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19565 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19566 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19567 defined by MX preferences.
19568
19569 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19570 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19571 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19572
19573 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19574 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19575 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19576 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19577
19578 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19579 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19580 router.
19581
19582 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19583 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19584 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19585
19586 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19587 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19588
19589
19590
19591 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19592 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
19593 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19594 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19595 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19596 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19597 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19598
19599 .ilist
19600 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19601 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19602 .next
19603 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19604 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19605 .next
19606 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19607 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19608 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19609 .next
19610 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19611 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19612 timeout), delivery is deferred.
19613 .new
19614 .next
19615 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
19616 .next
19617 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
19618 .wen
19619 .endlist
19620
19621 For example:
19622 .code
19623 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19624 domain2 host4:host5
19625 .endd
19626 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19627 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19628 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19629 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19630 call.
19631
19632 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19633 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19634 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19635 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19636 function called.
19637
19638 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
19639 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
19640 option specified.
19641
19642
19643
19644 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19645 &%host_find_failed%& option.
19646
19647 .vindex "&$host$&"
19648 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19649 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19650
19651
19652
19653 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
19654 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
19655 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
19656
19657 .ilist
19658 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
19659 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19660 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19661 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19662 .code
19663 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19664 .endd
19665 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19666 your first router something like this:
19667 .code
19668 smart_route:
19669 driver = manualroute
19670 domains = !+local_domains
19671 transport = remote_smtp
19672 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19673 .endd
19674 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19675 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19676 they are tried in order
19677 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19678 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19679 .code
19680 smart_route:
19681 driver = manualroute
19682 transport = remote_smtp
19683 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19684 .endd
19685 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19686 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19687 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19688 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19689 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19690 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19691 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19692 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19693
19694 .next
19695 .cindex "mail hub example"
19696 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19697 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19698 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19699 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19700 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19701 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19702 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19703 lookup is easier to manage.
19704
19705 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19706 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19707 example:
19708 .code
19709 hub_route:
19710 driver = manualroute
19711 transport = remote_smtp
19712 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19713 .endd
19714 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19715 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19716 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19717 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19718 domain can be used to find the host:
19719 .code
19720 through_firewall:
19721 driver = manualroute
19722 transport = remote_smtp
19723 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19724 .endd
19725 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19726 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19727 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19728 next router.
19729
19730 .next
19731 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19732 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19733 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19734 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19735 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19736 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19737 .code
19738 save_in_file:
19739 driver = manualroute
19740 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19741 route_list = saved.domain.example
19742 .endd
19743 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19744 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19745 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19746 .code
19747 save_in_file:
19748 driver = manualroute
19749 route_list = \
19750 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19751 *.saved.domain2.example \
19752 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19753 batch_pipe
19754 .endd
19755 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19756 .vindex "&$host$&"
19757 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19758 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19759 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19760 the address if the lookup fails.
19761
19762 .next
19763 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19764 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19765 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19766 one way it can be done:
19767 .code
19768 # Transport
19769 uucp:
19770 driver = pipe
19771 user = nobody
19772 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19773 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19774 return_fail_output = true
19775
19776 # Router
19777 uucphost:
19778 transport = uucp
19779 driver = manualroute
19780 route_data = \
19781 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19782 .endd
19783 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19784 .code
19785 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19786 .endd
19787 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19788 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19789 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19790 .endlist
19791 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19792 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19793
19794
19795
19796
19797
19798
19799
19800
19801 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19802 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19803
19804 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19805 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19806 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19807 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19808 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19809 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19810 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19811 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19812 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19813 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19814 options:
19815 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19816
19817 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19818 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19819 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19820 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19821 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19822
19823
19824 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19825 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19826 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19827 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19828 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19829 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19830
19831
19832 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19833 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19834 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19835 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19836 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19837 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19838 not set, a value for the gid also.
19839
19840 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19841 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19842 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19843 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19844 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19845 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19846 gid.
19847
19848
19849 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19850 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19851 before running the command.
19852
19853
19854 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19855 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19856 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19857 timeout.
19858
19859
19860 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19861 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19862 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19863 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19864 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19865
19866 .ilist
19867 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19868 below).
19869 .next
19870 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19871 &%no_more%& is set.
19872 .next
19873 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19874 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19875 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19876 included in the SMTP response.
19877 .next
19878 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19879 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19880 included in any SMTP response.
19881 .next
19882 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19883 .next
19884 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19885 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19886 .next
19887 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19888 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19889 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19890 .endlist
19891
19892 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19893 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19894 the page):
19895 .code
19896 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19897 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19898 .endd
19899 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19900 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19901 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19902 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19903
19904 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19905 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19906 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19907 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19908 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19909
19910 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19911 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19912 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19913 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19914 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19915
19916 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19917 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19918 variable. For example, this return line
19919 .code
19920 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19921 .endd
19922 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19923 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19924 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19925 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19926
19927
19928
19929
19930 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19931 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19932
19933 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19934 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19935 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19936 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19937 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19938 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19939 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19940 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19941 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19942 redirected in several different ways:
19943
19944 .ilist
19945 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19946 independently.
19947 .next
19948 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19949 .next
19950 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19951 .next
19952 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19953 .next
19954 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19955 .next
19956 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19957 .next
19958 It can be discarded.
19959 .endlist
19960
19961 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19962 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19963 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19964 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19965
19966 If success DSNs have been requested
19967 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19968 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19969 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19970
19971
19972
19973 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19974 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19975 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19976 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19977 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19978 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19979 .code
19980 system_aliases:
19981 driver = redirect
19982 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19983 .endd
19984 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19985 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19986 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19987 cause delivery to be deferred.
19988
19989 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19990 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19991 .code
19992 userforward:
19993 driver = redirect
19994 check_local_user
19995 file = $home/.forward
19996 no_verify
19997 .endd
19998 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19999 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20000 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20001 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20002 comments.
20003
20004
20005
20006 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20007 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20008 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20009 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20010
20011 .ilist
20012 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20013 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20014 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20015 practice the router may not be able to operate.
20016 .next
20017 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20018 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20019 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20020 saves some resources.
20021 .endlist
20022
20023
20024
20025
20026
20027
20028 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20029 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20030 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20031 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20032 can be interpreted in two different ways:
20033
20034 .ilist
20035 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20036 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20037 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20038 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20039 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20040 document is intended for use by end users.
20041 .next
20042 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20043 described in the next section.
20044 .endlist
20045
20046 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
20047 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20048 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20049 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20050 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20051
20052
20053
20054 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20055 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20056 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20057 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20058 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20059 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20060 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20061 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20062 commas or newlines.
20063 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20064 quotes.
20065
20066 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20067 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20068 next newline character is ignored.
20069
20070 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20071 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20072 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20073 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20074 removed.
20075
20076 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20077 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20078 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20079 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20080 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20081 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20082 setting:
20083 .code
20084 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20085 .endd
20086
20087
20088 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20089 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
20090 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20091 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20092 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20093 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20094 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20095 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20096 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20097 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20098 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20099
20100 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20101 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20102 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20103 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20104 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20105 .code
20106 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20107 .endd
20108 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
20109 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20110 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20111 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20112 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20113 synonymously.
20114
20115 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
20116 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20117 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20118 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20119 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20120
20121 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20122 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20123 contains:
20124 .code
20125 Sam.Reman: spqr
20126 .endd
20127 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20128 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20129 this forward file:
20130 .code
20131 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20132 .endd
20133 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20134 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20135 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20136 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20137 should really contain
20138 .code
20139 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20140 .endd
20141 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20142 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20143 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20144
20145
20146
20147 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20148 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20149 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20150
20151 .ilist
20152 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20153 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20154 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20155 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20156 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20157 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20158 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20159
20160 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20161 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20162 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20163 in double quotes, for example:
20164 .code
20165 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20166 .endd
20167 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20168 quote just the command. An item such as
20169 .code
20170 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20171 .endd
20172 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20173
20174 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20175 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20176 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20177 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20178 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20179 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20180 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20181 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20182 an &%accept%& router.
20183
20184 .next
20185 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20186 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20187 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20188 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20189 .code
20190 /home/world/minbari
20191 .endd
20192 is treated as a file name, but
20193 .code
20194 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20195 .endd
20196 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
20197 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20198 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20199 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20200
20201 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20202 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20203
20204 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20205 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20206 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20207 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20208
20209 .next
20210 .cindex "included address list"
20211 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20212 If an item is of the form
20213 .code
20214 :include:<path name>
20215 .endd
20216 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20217 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20218 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20219 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20220 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20221 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20222 .code
20223 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20224 .endd
20225 It must be given as
20226 .code
20227 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20228 .endd
20229 .next
20230 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20231 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20232 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20233 .cindex "black hole"
20234 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20235 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20236 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20237 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20238 .code
20239 :blackhole:
20240 .endd
20241 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20242 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20243 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20244
20245 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20246 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20247 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20248 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20249 &_/dev/null_&.
20250
20251 .next
20252 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20253 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20254 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20255 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20256 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20257 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20258 redirection items of the form
20259 .code
20260 :defer:
20261 :fail:
20262 .endd
20263 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20264 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20265 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20266 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20267 .code
20268 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20269 .endd
20270 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20271 of a
20272 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20273 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20274 default.
20275 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20276 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20277 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20278
20279 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20280 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20281 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20282 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20283 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20284 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20285 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20286 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20287 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20288 ignored.
20289
20290 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20291 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20292 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20293 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20294
20295 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20296 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20297 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20298 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20299 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20300
20301 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20302 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20303 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
20304 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20305 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20306 rules still apply.
20307
20308 .next
20309 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20310 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20311 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20312 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20313 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20314 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20315 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20316 .endlist
20317
20318
20319 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20320 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20321 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20322 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20323 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20324 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20325 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20326 aliasing scheme of the type
20327 .code
20328 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20329 localpart1: pipe
20330 localpart2: pipe
20331 .endd
20332 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20333 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20334 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20335 such as
20336 .code
20337 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20338 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20339 .endd
20340 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20341 the pipes are distinct.
20342
20343
20344
20345 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20346 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20347 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20348 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20349 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20350 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20351 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20352 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20353 can be used to avoid this.
20354
20355
20356 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20357 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20358 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20359 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20360 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20361 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20362 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20363
20364
20365
20366 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20367
20368 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20369 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20370
20371
20372 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20373 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20374 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20375
20376
20377 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20378 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20379 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20380 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20381
20382
20383 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20384 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20385 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20386 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20387 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20388 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20389 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20390
20391 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20392 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20393
20394
20395 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20396 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20397 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20398 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20399 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20400
20401
20402
20403 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20404 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20405 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20406 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20407 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20408 let ordinary users do.
20409
20410
20411
20412 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20413 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20414 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20415 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20416 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20417 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20418
20419 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20420 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20421 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20422 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20423 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20424 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20425 .code
20426 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20427 .endd
20428 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20429 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20430 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20431 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20432 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20433 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20434 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20435 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20436
20437
20438 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20439 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20440 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20441 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20442 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20443 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20444 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20445 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20446
20447
20448
20449 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20450 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20451 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20452 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20453 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20454 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20455
20456
20457 .option data redirect string&!! unset
20458 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20459 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20460 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20461 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20462 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20463
20464 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20465 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20466 terminated with newline characters. For example:
20467 .code
20468 data = #Exim filter\n\
20469 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20470 .endd
20471 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20472 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20473 choice into a newline.
20474
20475
20476 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20477 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20478 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20479 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20480 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20481
20482
20483 .option file redirect string&!! unset
20484 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20485 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20486 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20487 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20488 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20489 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20490 entirely of comments), the router declines.
20491
20492 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20493 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20494 runs a check on the containing directory,
20495 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20496 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20497 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20498 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20499 not, the router declines.
20500
20501
20502 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20503 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20504 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20505 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20506 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20507 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20508 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
20509
20510
20511 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20512 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20513 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20514 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20515 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20516
20517
20518 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20519 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20520 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20521 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20522 redirection list.
20523
20524
20525 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20526 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20527 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20528 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20529 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20530
20531
20532
20533
20534 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20535 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20536 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20537 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20538 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20539 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20540 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20541 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20542 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20543 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20544 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20545
20546
20547 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20548 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20549 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20550 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20551 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20552 functions.
20553
20554 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20555 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20556 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20557 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20558 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20559 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20560
20561 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20562 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20563 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20564 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20565 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20566 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20567 &_.forward_& files).
20568
20569
20570 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20571 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20572 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20573 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20574 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20575
20576
20577 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20578 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20579 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20580 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20581 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20582 of the embedded Perl support.
20583
20584
20585 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20586 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20587 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20588 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20589 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20590
20591
20592 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20593 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20594 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20595 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20596 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20597
20598
20599 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20600 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20601 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20602 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20603 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20604 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20605 &%one_time%& is set.
20606
20607
20608 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20609 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20610 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20611 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20612 to make use of &%run%& items.
20613
20614
20615 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20616 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20617 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20618 If this option is true, items of the form
20619 .code
20620 :include:<path name>
20621 .endd
20622 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20623
20624
20625 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20626 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20627 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20628 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20629 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20630 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20631 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20632
20633
20634 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20635 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20636 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20637 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20638 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20639
20640
20641 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20642 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20643 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20644 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20645 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20646
20647
20648
20649
20650 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20651 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
20652 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
20653 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
20654 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
20655 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
20656 bounce may well quote the generated address.
20657
20658
20659 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
20660 .cindex "EACCES"
20661 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20662 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
20663 file did not exist.
20664
20665
20666 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
20667 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
20668 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20669 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
20670 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
20671
20672 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
20673 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
20674 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
20675 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
20676 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
20677 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
20678 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
20679 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
20680
20681
20682
20683 .option include_directory redirect string unset
20684 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
20685 redirection list must start with this directory.
20686
20687
20688 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
20689 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
20690 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
20691
20692
20693 .option one_time redirect boolean false
20694 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20695 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20696 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20697 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20698 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20699 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20700 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20701 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20702 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20703 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20704 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20705 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20706 before they subscribed.
20707
20708 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20709 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20710 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20711 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20712 attempt.
20713
20714 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20715 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20716 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20717 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20718
20719 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20720 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20721 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20722
20723 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20724 &%one_time%&.
20725
20726 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20727 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20728 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20729 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20730 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20731 expansion.
20732
20733
20734 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
20735 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20736 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20737 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20738 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20739 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20740 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20741 See &%check_owner%& above.
20742
20743
20744 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20745 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20746 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20747 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20748
20749
20750 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20751 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20752 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20753 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20754 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20755 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20756 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20757
20758
20759 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20760 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20761 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20762 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20763 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20764 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20765 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20766 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20767
20768 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20769 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20770 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20771 addresses.
20772
20773 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20774 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20775 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20776 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20777 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20778 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20779 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20780 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20781 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20782 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20783
20784
20785 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20786 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20787 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20788 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20789 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20790 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20791
20792
20793 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20794 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20795 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20796 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20797 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20798 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20799
20800
20801 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20802 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20803 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20804 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20805 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20806
20807
20808 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20809 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20810 :subaddress part of an address.
20811
20812 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20813 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20814 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20815 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20816
20817
20818 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20819 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20820 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20821 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20822 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20823 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20824 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20825
20826
20827
20828 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20829 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20830 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20831 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20832 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20833 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20834 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20835 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20836 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20837 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20838 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20839 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20840 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20841 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20842 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20843 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20844
20845 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20846 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20847 the following routers.
20848
20849 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20850 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20851 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20852 so it is passed to the following routers.
20853
20854 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20855 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20856 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20857 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20858
20859 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20860 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20861 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20862 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20863 .code
20864 userforward:
20865 driver = redirect
20866 allow_filter
20867 check_local_user
20868 file = $home/.forward
20869 file_transport = address_file
20870 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20871 reply_transport = address_reply
20872 no_verify
20873 skip_syntax_errors
20874 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20875 syntax_errors_text = \
20876 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20877 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20878 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20879 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20880 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20881 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20882 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20883 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20884 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20885 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20886 .endd
20887 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20888 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20889 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20890 .code
20891 real_localuser:
20892 driver = accept
20893 check_local_user
20894 local_part_prefix = real-
20895 transport = local_delivery
20896 .endd
20897 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20898 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20899 .code
20900 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20901 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20902 .endd
20903
20904
20905 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20906 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20907
20908
20909 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20910 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20911 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20912 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20913
20914
20915
20916
20917
20918
20919 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20920 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20921
20922 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20923 "Environment for local transports"
20924 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20925 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
20926 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20927 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20928 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20929 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20930 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20931
20932 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20933 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20934 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20935 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20936
20937 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20938 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20939 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20940 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20941 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20942
20943
20944
20945 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20946 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20947 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20948 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20949 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20950 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20951 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20952 time.
20953
20954 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20955 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20956 .code
20957 my_transport:
20958 driver = pipe
20959 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20960 .endd
20961 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20962 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20963 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20964 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20965
20966
20967
20968
20969 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20970 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20971 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20972 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20973 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20974 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20975 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20976 group (set by the transport). For example:
20977 .code
20978 # Routers ...
20979 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20980 local_users:
20981 driver = accept
20982 check_local_user
20983 transport = group_delivery
20984
20985 # Transports ...
20986 # This transport overrides the group
20987 group_delivery:
20988 driver = appendfile
20989 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20990 group = mail
20991 .endd
20992 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20993 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20994 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20995 set.
20996
20997 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20998 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20999 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21000 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21001 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21002 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21003
21004 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21005 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21006 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21007 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21008 original gid is also used.
21009
21010 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21011 following that is set is used:
21012
21013 .ilist
21014 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21015 .next
21016 A &%group%& setting of the router;
21017 .next
21018 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21019 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21020 .next
21021 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21022 .next
21023 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21024 the uid is the creator's uid;
21025 .next
21026 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21027 .endlist
21028
21029 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21030 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21031 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21032 The first of the following that is set is used:
21033
21034 .ilist
21035 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21036 .next
21037 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21038 .next
21039 A &%user%& setting of the router;
21040 .next
21041 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21042 .next
21043 The Exim uid.
21044 .endlist
21045
21046 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21047 &%never_users%& list.
21048
21049
21050
21051
21052
21053 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21054 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
21055 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21056 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21057 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21058 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21059 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21060 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21061 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21062 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21063
21064 .ilist
21065 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21066 .next
21067 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21068 .next
21069 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21070 .next
21071 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21072 .endlist
21073
21074 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21075
21076 .ilist
21077 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21078 .next
21079 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21080 .endlist
21081
21082
21083 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21084 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21085 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21086
21087
21088
21089 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21090 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21091 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21092 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21093 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21094 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21095 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21096 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21097 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21098 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21099 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21100 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21101 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21102 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21103
21104
21105
21106
21107
21108
21109
21110 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21111 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21112
21113 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21114 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21115 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21116 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21117 The following generic options apply to all transports:
21118
21119
21120 .option body_only transports boolean false
21121 .cindex "transport" "body only"
21122 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21123 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21124 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21125 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21126 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21127 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21128 automatically suppress them.
21129
21130
21131 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21132 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21133 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21134 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21135 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21136 logged, and delivery is deferred.
21137
21138
21139 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
21140 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21141 deliveries by the transport or for any
21142 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21143 what you are doing.
21144
21145
21146 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21147 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21148 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21149 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21150 transport is run.
21151 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21152 output, and Exim carries on processing.
21153 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21154 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21155 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21156 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21157 one.
21158 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21159 transport and the router that called it.
21160
21161 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21162 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21163 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21164 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21165 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21166 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21167 safely be resent to other recipients.
21168
21169
21170 .option driver transports string unset
21171 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21172 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21173
21174
21175 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21176 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21177 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21178 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21179 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21180 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21181 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21182 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21183 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21184 resent to other recipients.
21185
21186
21187 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
21188 .cindex events
21189 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21190 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21191
21192
21193 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21194 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21195 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21196 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21197 &%user%& (see below).
21198
21199
21200 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21201 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21202 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21203 This option specifies a list of text headers,
21204 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
21205 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21206 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21207 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21208 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21209 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21210 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21211
21212 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21213 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21214
21215
21216 .option headers_only transports boolean false
21217 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21218 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21219 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21220 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21221 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21222 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21223 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21224
21225
21226 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21227 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
21228 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21229 This option specifies a list of header names,
21230 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
21231 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21232 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21233 routers.
21234 Each list item is separately expanded.
21235 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21236 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21237 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21238
21239 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21240 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21241
21242 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21243 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21244 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21245
21246
21247
21248 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21249 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21250 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21251 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21252 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21253 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21254 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21255 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21256 example,
21257 .code
21258 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21259 x@y w@z
21260 .endd
21261 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21262 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21263 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21264 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21265 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21266 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21267 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21268 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21269 change envelope recipients at this time.
21270
21271
21272 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21273 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21274 .vindex "&$home$&"
21275 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21276 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21277 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21278 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21279 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21280 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21281 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21282 deferred.
21283
21284
21285 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21286 .cindex "additional groups"
21287 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21288 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21289 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21290 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21291 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21292
21293
21294 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21295 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21296 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21297 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21298 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21299 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21300 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21301 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21302
21303 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21304 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21305 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21306 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21307 Obviously there is scope for
21308 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21309 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21310
21311 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21312 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21313 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21314 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21315 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21316
21317
21318 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21319 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21320 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21321 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21322 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21323 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21324 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21325 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21326 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21327 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21328 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21329 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21330 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21331 delivered.
21332
21333
21334
21335 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21336 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21337 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21338 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21339 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21340 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21341 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21342 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21343 that contains
21344 .code
21345 local_part_prefix = *-
21346 .endd
21347 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21348 is delivered with
21349 .code
21350 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21351 .endd
21352 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21353 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21354 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21355 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21356 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21357
21358
21359 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21360 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21361 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21362 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21363 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21364 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21365 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21366 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21367 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21368
21369 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21370 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21371 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21372 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21373
21374 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21375 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21376 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21377
21378
21379 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21380 .cindex "envelope sender"
21381 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21382 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21383 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21384 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21385 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21386 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21387 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21388 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21389 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21390
21391 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21392 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21393
21394 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
21395 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21396 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21397 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21398 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21399 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21400 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21401
21402 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21403 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21404 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21405 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21406 &%errors_to%& in a router.
21407
21408
21409
21410 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
21411 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21412 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21413 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21414 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21415 have easy access to it.
21416
21417 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21418 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21419 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21420 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21421 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21422 recipients.
21423
21424
21425 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21426 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21427
21428
21429 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
21430 .cindex "shadow transport"
21431 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
21432 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21433 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21434
21435 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21436 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21437 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21438 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21439 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21440 cause a log line to be written.
21441
21442 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21443 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21444 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21445 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21446 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21447 of the form
21448 .code
21449 ST=<shadow transport name>
21450 .endd
21451 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21452 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21453 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21454 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21455 headers that some sites insist on.
21456
21457
21458 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21459 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21460 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21461 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21462 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21463 individual users or via a system filter.
21464 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21465
21466 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21467 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21468 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21469 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21470 command must be specified as an absolute path.
21471
21472 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21473 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21474 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21475 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21476 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21477 &(pipe)& transports.
21478
21479 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21480 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21481 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21482 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21483 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21484
21485 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21486 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21487 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21488 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21489
21490 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21491 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21492 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21493 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21494 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21495 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21496
21497 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21498 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21499 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21500 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21501 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21502 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21503 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21504 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21505
21506 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21507 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21508 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21509 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21510 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21511 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21512 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21513 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21514 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21515 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21516
21517 .vindex "&$host$&"
21518 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21519 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21520 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21521 which the message is being sent. For example:
21522 .code
21523 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21524 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21525 .endd
21526
21527 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21528 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21529 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21530 .ilist
21531 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21532 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21533 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21534 example:
21535 .code
21536 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21537 .endd
21538 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21539 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21540 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21541 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21542 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21543 Exim tried to expand the first one.
21544 .next
21545 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21546 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21547 arguments. Consider this example:
21548 .code
21549 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21550 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21551 .endd
21552 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21553 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21554 .code
21555 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21556 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21557 .endd
21558 .endlist
21559
21560 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21561 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21562 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21563 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21564 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21565 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21566 bounced from a transport filter.
21567
21568 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21569 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21570 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21571
21572
21573 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21574 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21575 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21576 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21577 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21578 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21579 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21580 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21581 becomes a temporary error.
21582
21583
21584 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21585 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21586 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21587 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21588 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21589 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21590 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21591 option is not set.
21592
21593 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21594 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21595 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21596
21597 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21598 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21599 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21600 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21601 retry data.
21602 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21603 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21604 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21605
21606
21607
21608
21609
21610
21611 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21612 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21613
21614 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21615 "Address batching"
21616 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21617 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21618 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21619 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21620 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21621 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21622 copy of the message is delivered each time.
21623
21624 .cindex "batched local delivery"
21625 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21626 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21627 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21628 local transport, for example:
21629
21630 .ilist
21631 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21632 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21633 recipients saves space.
21634 .next
21635 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21636 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21637 .next
21638 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21639 to a scanner program or
21640 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21641 acceptable.
21642 .endlist
21643
21644 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21645 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21646 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21647
21648 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21649 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21650 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21651 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
21652 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
21653 to certain conditions:
21654
21655 .ilist
21656 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21657 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
21658 batching is possible.
21659 .next
21660 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21661 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
21662 addresses with the same domain are batched.
21663 .next
21664 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
21665 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
21666 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
21667 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
21668 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
21669 from taking place.
21670 .next
21671 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
21672 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
21673 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
21674 be the same.
21675 .endlist
21676
21677 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
21678 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
21679 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
21680 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
21681 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
21682 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
21683 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
21684 .code
21685 check_string = "."
21686 escape_string = ".."
21687 .endd
21688 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
21689 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
21690 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
21691
21692 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21693 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
21694 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
21695 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
21696 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
21697 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
21698
21699 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
21700 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21701 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
21702 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
21703 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
21704 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
21705 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
21706 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
21707 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
21708
21709
21710
21711
21712 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21713 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21714
21715 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21716 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21717 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21718 .cindex "directory creation"
21719 .cindex "creating directories"
21720 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21721 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21722 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21723 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21724 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21725 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21726 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21727 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21728 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21729 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21730
21731 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21732 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21733 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21734 included.
21735
21736 .cindex "quota" "system"
21737 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21738 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21739 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21740
21741 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21742 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21743 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21744 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21745
21746 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21747 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21748 private options.
21749
21750 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21751 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21752 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21753 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21754 option).
21755
21756
21757
21758 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21759 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21760 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21761 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21762 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21763
21764 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21765 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21766 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21767 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21768 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21769 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21770 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21771 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21772 operation. There are two cases:
21773
21774 .ilist
21775 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21776 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21777 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21778 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21779 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21780 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21781 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21782 .next
21783 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21784 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21785 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21786 .endlist
21787
21788
21789 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21790 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21791 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21792 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21793 form:
21794 .code
21795 save folder23
21796 .endd
21797 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21798 .code
21799 require "fileinto";
21800 fileinto "folder23";
21801 .endd
21802 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21803 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21804 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21805 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21806 way of handling this requirement:
21807 .code
21808 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21809 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21810 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21811 {$address_file} \
21812 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21813 }} \
21814 }
21815 .endd
21816 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21817 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21818 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21819
21820 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21821 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21822 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21823 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21824 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21825 path to the transport.
21826
21827 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21828 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21829
21830
21831
21832
21833 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21834 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21835
21836
21837
21838 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21839 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21840 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21841 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21842 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21843 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21844 delivery is deferred.
21845
21846
21847 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21848 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21849 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21850 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21851 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21852 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21853 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21854 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21855
21856
21857 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21858 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21859 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21860 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21861 file.
21862
21863
21864 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21865 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21866
21867
21868 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21869 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21870 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21871 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21872 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21873
21874
21875 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21876 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21877 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21878 process is running.
21879
21880
21881 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21882 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21883 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21884 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21885 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21886 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21887 contains is significant.
21888
21889 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21890 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21891 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21892 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21893 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21894
21895 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21896 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21897 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21898 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21899 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21900 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21901 .code
21902 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21903 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21904 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21905 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21906 .endd
21907 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21908 .cindex "directory creation"
21909 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21910 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21911 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21912
21913 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21914 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21915 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21916 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21917 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21918
21919
21920
21921 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21922 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21923 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21924 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21925 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21926 beneath.
21927
21928 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21929 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21930 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21931 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21932 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21933 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21934 &%file_must_exist%&.
21935
21936
21937 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21938 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21939 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21940 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21941
21942 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21943 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21944 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21945 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21946 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21947
21948
21949 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21950 .cindex "base62"
21951 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21952 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21953 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21954 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21955 .code
21956 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21957 .endd
21958 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21959 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21960 option.
21961
21962
21963 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21964 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21965 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21966
21967
21968 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21969 See &%check_string%& above.
21970
21971
21972 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21973 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21974 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21975 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21976 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21977 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21978 &%file%&.
21979
21980 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21981 .cindex "locking files"
21982 .cindex "lock files"
21983 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21984 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21985
21986 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21987 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21988 examples:
21989 .code
21990 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21991 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21992 file = $home/inbox
21993 .endd
21994 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21995 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21996 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21997 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21998 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21999 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22000
22001
22002
22003 .option file_format appendfile string unset
22004 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22005 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22006 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22007 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22008 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22009 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22010 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22011 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22012 this added to it:
22013 .code
22014 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22015 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22016 .endd
22017 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22018 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22019 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22020 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22021 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22022 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22023 delivery is deferred.
22024
22025
22026 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22027 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22028 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22029 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22030
22031
22032 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22033 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22034 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22035 .cindex "locking files"
22036 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22037 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22038 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22039 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22040 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22041 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22042 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22043 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22044
22045 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22046 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22047 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22048 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22049
22050 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22051 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22052 retries is
22053 .code
22054 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22055 .endd
22056 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22057 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22058 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22059
22060 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22061 local deliveries because of errors of the form
22062 .code
22063 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22064 .endd
22065
22066 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22067 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22068 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22069 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22070
22071
22072 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22073 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22074 for details of locking.
22075
22076
22077 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22078 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22079 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22080
22081
22082 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22083 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22084 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22085
22086
22087 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22088 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22089 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22090 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22091 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22092
22093
22094 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22095 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22096 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22097 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22098 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22099 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22100 external source that maintains the data.
22101
22102
22103 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22104 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22105 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22106 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22107 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22108 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22109 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22110 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22111
22112
22113
22114 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22115 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22116 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22117 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22118 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22119 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22120 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22121 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22122 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22123 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22124
22125
22126 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22127 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22128 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22129 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22130 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22131 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22132 calculation. The default value is:
22133 .code
22134 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22135 .endd
22136 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22137 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22138 &_Trash_&
22139 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22140 .code
22141 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22142 .endd
22143 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22144 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22145 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22146 directly into that directory.
22147
22148
22149 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22150 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22151 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22152
22153
22154 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22155 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22156 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22157
22158
22159 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22160 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22161 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22162 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22163 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22164 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22165 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22166 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22167
22168 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22169 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22170 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22171 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22172 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22173 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22174 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22175 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22176 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22177 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22178
22179
22180 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22181 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22182 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22183 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22184 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22185 below for further details.
22186
22187
22188 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22189 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22190 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22191
22192
22193 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22194 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22195 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22196
22197
22198 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22199 .cindex "locking files"
22200 .cindex "file" "locking"
22201 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
22202 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22203 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22204 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22205 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22206 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22207 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22208
22209 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22210 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22211 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22212 combination:
22213 .code
22214 mbx_format = true
22215 message_prefix =
22216 message_suffix =
22217 .endd
22218 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22219 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22220 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22221 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22222 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22223 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22224 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22225 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22226
22227 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22228 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22229 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22230 append messages to it.
22231
22232
22233 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22234 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22235 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22236 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22237 in which case it is:
22238 .code
22239 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22240 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22241 .endd
22242 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22243 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22244
22245 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22246 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22247 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22248 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22249 setting
22250 .code
22251 message_suffix =
22252 .endd
22253 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22254 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22255
22256 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22257 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22258 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22259 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22260 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22261 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22262 value, and this option is ignored.
22263
22264
22265 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22266 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22267 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22268 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22269 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22270
22271
22272 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22273 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22274 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22275 on users about incoming mail.
22276
22277
22278 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22279 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22280 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22281 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22282 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22283 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22284 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22285 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22286 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22287
22288 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22289 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22290 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22291
22292 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22293 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22294 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22295 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22296 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22297 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22298
22299 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22300 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22301 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22302 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22303 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22304 be handled.
22305
22306 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22307 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22308
22309 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22310
22311 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22312 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22313 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22314 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22315 system quota failures.
22316
22317 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22318 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22319 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22320 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22321 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22322 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22323 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22324 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22325 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22326 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22327
22328
22329 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22330 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22331 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22332 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22333 delivery directory.
22334
22335
22336 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22337 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22338 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22339 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22340 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22341 &"no quota"&.
22342
22343 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22344 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22345
22346 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22347 See &%quota%& above.
22348
22349
22350 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22351 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22352 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22353 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22354 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
22355 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22356 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22357
22358 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22359 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22360 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22361 the file length to the file name. For example:
22362 .code
22363 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22364 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22365 .endd
22366 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22367 number of lines in the message.
22368
22369 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22370 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22371 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
22372
22373 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22374
22375
22376 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22377 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22378 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22379 .code
22380 quota_warn_message = "\
22381 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22382 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22383 This message is automatically created \
22384 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22385 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22386 a warning threshold that is\n\
22387 set by the system administrator.\n"
22388 .endd
22389
22390
22391 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22392 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22393 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22394 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22395 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22396 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22397 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22398 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22399 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22400 sign. For example:
22401 .code
22402 quota = 10M
22403 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22404 .endd
22405 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22406 percent sign is ignored.
22407
22408 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22409 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22410 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22411 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22412 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22413 &'From:'& line, the default is:
22414 .code
22415 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22416 .endd
22417 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22418 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22419 option.
22420
22421 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22422 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22423 percentage.
22424
22425
22426 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22427 .cindex "envelope sender"
22428 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22429 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22430 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22431 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22432 for details of batch SMTP.
22433
22434
22435 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22436 .cindex "carriage return"
22437 .cindex "linefeed"
22438 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22439 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22440 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22441 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22442
22443 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22444 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22445 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22446 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22447 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22448 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22449
22450
22451 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22452 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22453 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22454 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22455 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22456 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22457
22458
22459 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22460 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22461 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22462 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22463 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22464
22465 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22466 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22467 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22468 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22469
22470 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22471 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22472 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22473 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22474 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22475 error.
22476
22477 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22478 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22479
22480
22481 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22482 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22483 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22484 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22485 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22486 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22487 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22488
22489 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22490 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22491 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22492 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22493 file corruption.
22494
22495 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22496 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22497 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22498
22499
22500 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22501 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22502 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22503 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22504 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22505 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22506 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22507 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22508 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22509
22510 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22511 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22512 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22513 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22514
22515
22516
22517
22518 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22519 .cindex "appending to a file"
22520 .cindex "file" "appending"
22521 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22522
22523 .ilist
22524 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22525 return is given.
22526
22527 .next
22528 .cindex "directory creation"
22529 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22530 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22531 &%directory_mode%& option.
22532
22533 .next
22534 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22535 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22536 transport.
22537
22538 .next
22539 .cindex "file" "locking"
22540 .cindex "locking files"
22541 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22542 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22543 reliably over NFS, as follows:
22544
22545 .olist
22546 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22547 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22548 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22549 .next
22550 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
22551 .next
22552 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22553 Unlink the hitching post name.
22554 .next
22555 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22556 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22557 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22558 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22559 .next
22560 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22561 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22562 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22563 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22564 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22565 it before trying again.
22566 .endlist olist
22567
22568 .next
22569 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22570 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22571 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22572
22573 .next
22574 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22575 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22576 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22577 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22578 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22579 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22580 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22581 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22582 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22583 checked.
22584
22585 .next
22586 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22587 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22588 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22589 delivery is deferred.
22590
22591 .next
22592 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22593 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22594 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22595 permissions.
22596
22597 .next
22598 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22599 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22600 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22601
22602 .next
22603 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22604 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22605 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22606
22607 .next
22608 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22609 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22610 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22611 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22612 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22613 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22614 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22615 that prevents link following.
22616
22617 .next
22618 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22619 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22620 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22621 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22622 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22623
22624 .next
22625 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22626
22627 .next
22628 .cindex "file" "locking"
22629 .cindex "locking files"
22630 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22631 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22632 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22633 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22634 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22635 .code
22636 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22637 .endd
22638 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22639 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22640 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22641
22642 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22643 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22644 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22645
22646 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22647 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22648 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22649 delivery is deferred.
22650
22651 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
22652 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
22653 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
22654 immediately. It retries up to
22655 .code
22656 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
22657 .endd
22658 times (rounded up).
22659 .endlist
22660
22661 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
22662 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
22663
22664
22665 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
22666 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
22667 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22668 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
22669 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
22670 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
22671 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
22672 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
22673 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
22674 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
22675
22676 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
22677 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
22678 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
22679 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
22680 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
22681 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
22682 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
22683
22684 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
22685 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
22686 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
22687 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
22688
22689
22690 .cindex "maildir format"
22691 .cindex "mailstore format"
22692 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
22693 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
22694 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
22695 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
22696 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
22697
22698 .cindex "directory creation"
22699 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
22700 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
22701 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
22702 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
22703 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
22704 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
22705 deferred.
22706
22707
22708
22709 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
22710 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
22711 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
22712 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
22713 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
22714 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
22715 &_new_& subdirectory.
22716
22717 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22718 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22719 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22720 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22721 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22722 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22723 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22724
22725 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22726 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22727 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22728 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22729 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22730 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22731 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22732 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22733
22734 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22735 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22736 folders. Consider this example:
22737 .code
22738 maildir_format = true
22739 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22740 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22741 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22742 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22743 .endd
22744 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22745 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22746 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22747 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22748 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22749 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22750
22751 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22752 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22753 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22754 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22755 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22756
22757 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22758 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22759 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22760
22761 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22762 .cindex "maildir++"
22763 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22764 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22765 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22766 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22767 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22768 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22769 amount of space used.
22770
22771 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22772 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22773 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22774 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22775 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22776 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22777
22778
22779
22780
22781 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22782 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22783 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22784 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22785 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22786 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22787
22788
22789 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22790 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22791 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22792 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22793 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22794 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22795 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22796 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22797 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22798 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22799 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22800 backwards compatibility).
22801
22802 For one common implementation, you might set:
22803 .code
22804 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22805 .endd
22806 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22807
22808 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22809 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22810 &[stat()]& each message file.
22811
22812
22813 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22814 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22815 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22816 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22817 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22818 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22819 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22820 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22821 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22822
22823 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22824 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22825 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22826 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22827 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22828 need to know the quota.
22829
22830 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22831 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22832
22833 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22834 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22835 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22836 details.
22837
22838
22839 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22840 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22841 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22842 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22843 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22844 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22845 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22846 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22847
22848 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22849 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22850 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22851 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22852 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22853 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22854
22855 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22856 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22857 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22858 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22859 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22860 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22861
22862 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22863 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22864 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22865 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22866
22867
22868 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22869 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22870 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22871 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22872 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22873 .code
22874 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22875 .endd
22876 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22877 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22878 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22879 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22880 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22881
22882
22883
22884
22885
22886
22887 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22889
22890 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22891 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22892 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22893 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22894 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22895 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22896 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22897 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22898
22899 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22900 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22901 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22902 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22903 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22904
22905
22906 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22907 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22908 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22909 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22910 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22911
22912 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22913 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22914 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22915 transport is run as a consequence of a
22916 &%mail%&
22917 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22918 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22919 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22920 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22921 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22922 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22923
22924 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22925 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22926 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22927 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22928
22929 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22930 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22931 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22932 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22933 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22934 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22935 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22936
22937 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22938 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22939 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22940 the transport defers.
22941 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22942 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22943
22944 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22945 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22946 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22947 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22948
22949 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22950 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22951 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22952 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22953 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22954 problems. They are just discarded.
22955
22956
22957
22958 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22959 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22960
22961 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22962 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22963 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22964
22965
22966 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22967 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22968 when the message is specified by the transport.
22969
22970
22971 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22972 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22973 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22974 string comes first.
22975
22976
22977 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22978 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22979 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22980
22981
22982 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22983 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22984 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22985
22986
22987 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22988 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22989 specified by the transport.
22990
22991
22992 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22993 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22994 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22995 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22996
22997
22998 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22999 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23000 the message is specified by the transport.
23001
23002
23003 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23004 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23005 used.
23006
23007
23008 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23009 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23010 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23011 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23012 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23013
23014
23015
23016 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
23017 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23018 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23019 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23020
23021 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23022 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
23023 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23024 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23025 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23026 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23027 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23028 infinity.
23029
23030 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23031 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23032 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23033 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23034 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23035
23036 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23037 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23038 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23039 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23040 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23041 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23042
23043
23044 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23045 See &%once%& above.
23046
23047
23048 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23049 See &%once%& above.
23050 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23051
23052
23053 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23054 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23055 specified by the transport.
23056
23057
23058 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
23059 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23060 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23061 configuration option.
23062
23063
23064 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23065 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23066 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23067 automatic responses. For example:
23068 .code
23069 subject = Re: $h_subject:
23070 .endd
23071 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23072 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23073 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23074 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23075 small.
23076
23077
23078
23079 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
23080 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23081 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23082 the text comes first.
23083
23084
23085 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
23086 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23087 when the message is specified by the transport.
23088 .ecindex IIDauttra1
23089 .ecindex IIDauttra2
23090
23091
23092
23093
23094 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23095 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23096
23097 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23098 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23099 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23100 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23101 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23102 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23103 specified command
23104 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23105 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23106 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23107 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23108 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23109 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23110 .code
23111 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
23112 .endd
23113 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23114 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23115 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23116 as follows:
23117
23118 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23119 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23120
23121
23122 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23123 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23124 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23125 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23126 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23127
23128
23129 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
23130 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23131 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23132 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23133 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23134 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23135 LMTP protocol.
23136
23137 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23138 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23139 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23140 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23141 in its response to the LHLO command.
23142
23143 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23144 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23145 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23146 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23147
23148
23149 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
23150 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23151 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23152 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23153 LMTP transport:
23154 .code
23155 lmtp:
23156 driver = lmtp
23157 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23158 batch_max = 20
23159 user = exim
23160 .endd
23161 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23162 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23163
23164
23165
23166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23168
23169 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23170 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23171 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23172 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23173 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23174 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23175 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23176 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23177 following ways:
23178
23179 .ilist
23180 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23181 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23182 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23183 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23184 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23185 .next
23186 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23187 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23188 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23189 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23190 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23191 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23192 that are routed to the transport.
23193 .next
23194 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23195 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23196 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23197 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23198 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23199 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23200 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23201 .endlist
23202
23203
23204 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23205 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23206 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23207
23208 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23209 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23210 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23211 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23212 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23213 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23214 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23215
23216
23217 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23218 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23219 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23220 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23221 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23222 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23223 of "1" to enforce serialization.
23224
23225
23226
23227
23228 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23229 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23230 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23231 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23232 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23233 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23234 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23235 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23236 &"local delivery failed"&.
23237
23238 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23239 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23240 will be sent as normal.
23241
23242 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23243 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23244 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23245 apply in this case.
23246
23247 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23248 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23249 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23250 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23251
23252 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23253 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23254 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23255 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23256 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23257 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23258 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23259 &%temp_errors%&.
23260
23261
23262
23263 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23264 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23265 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23266 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23267 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23268 run.
23269
23270 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23271 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23272 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23273 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23274
23275 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23276 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23277 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23278 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23279 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23280 .code
23281 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23282 .endd
23283 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23284 arguments. You have to write
23285 .code
23286 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23287 .endd
23288 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23289 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23290 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23291 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23292 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23293 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23294 example:
23295 .code
23296 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23297 .endd
23298
23299 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23300 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23301 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23302 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23303 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23304 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23305 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23306 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23307 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23308 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23309
23310 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
23311 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23312 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23313 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23314 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23315 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23316 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23317 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23318
23319 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23320 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23321 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23322 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23323 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23324 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23325 control what is done with it.
23326
23327 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23328 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23329 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23330 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23331 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23332 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23333 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23334 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23335 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23336 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23337 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23338
23339
23340
23341 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23342 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23343 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23344 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23345 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23346 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23347 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23348 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23349 .display
23350 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23351 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23352 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23353 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23354 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23355 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23356 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23357 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23358 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23359 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23360 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23361 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23362 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23363 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23364 &`USER `& see below
23365 .endd
23366 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23367 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23368 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23369 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23370 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23371 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23372 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23373
23374 .cindex "HOST"
23375 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23376 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23377 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23378 the router.
23379
23380 .cindex "HOME"
23381 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23382 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23383 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23384 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23385
23386
23387 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23388 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23389
23390
23391
23392 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23393 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23394 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23395 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23396 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23397 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23398 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23399 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23400 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23401 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23402 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23403 example, if
23404 .code
23405 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23406 .endd
23407 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23408 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23409 &%use_shell%& is set.
23410
23411
23412 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23413 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23414
23415
23416 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
23417 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23418 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23419
23420
23421 .option check_string pipe string unset
23422 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23423 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23424 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23425 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23426 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23427 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23428 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23429 ignored.
23430
23431
23432 .option command pipe string&!! unset
23433 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23434 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23435 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23436 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23437 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23438 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23439
23440
23441 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
23442 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23443 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23444 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23445 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23446 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23447 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23448
23449
23450 .option escape_string pipe string unset
23451 See &%check_string%& above.
23452
23453
23454 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23455 .cindex "exec failure"
23456 .cindex "failure of exec"
23457 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23458 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23459 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23460 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23461 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23462
23463
23464 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23465 .cindex "signal exit"
23466 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23467 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23468 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23469 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23470
23471
23472 .option force_command pipe boolean false
23473 .cindex "force command"
23474 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23475 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23476 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23477 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23478 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23479 command. For example:
23480 .code
23481 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23482 force_command
23483 .endd
23484
23485 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23486 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23487 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23488
23489
23490 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23491 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23492 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23493 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23494 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23495 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23496
23497 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23498 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23499
23500
23501 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23502 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23503 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23504 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23505 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23506 written to the main log.
23507
23508
23509 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23510 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23511 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23512 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23513 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23514 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23515 be set.
23516
23517
23518 .option log_output pipe boolean false
23519 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23520 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23521 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23522 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23523
23524
23525 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
23526 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23527 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23528 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23529 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23530 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23531 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23532 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23533
23534
23535 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23536 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23537 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23538 .code
23539 message_prefix = \
23540 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23541 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
23542 .endd
23543 .cindex "Cyrus"
23544 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
23545 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23546 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23547 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23548 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23549 setting
23550 .code
23551 message_prefix =
23552 .endd
23553 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23554 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23555
23556
23557 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23558 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23559 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23560 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23561 .code
23562 message_suffix =
23563 .endd
23564 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23565 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23566
23567
23568 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
23569 This option is expanded and
23570 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23571 variable of the subprocess.
23572 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23573 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23574 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23575
23576
23577 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23578 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23579 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23580 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23581 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23582 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23583 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23584 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23585 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23586
23587
23588 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23589 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23590 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23591 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23592 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23593 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23594 accept the message is used.
23595
23596
23597 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23598 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23599 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23600 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23601 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23602 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23603
23604
23605 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23606 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23607 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23608 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23609 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23610 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23611 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23612
23613
23614
23615 .option return_output pipe boolean false
23616 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23617 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23618 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23619 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23620 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23621 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23622 of them may be set.
23623
23624
23625
23626 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23627 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23628 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23629 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23630 and &%return_output%& is not set,
23631 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23632 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23633 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23634 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23635 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23636 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23637 and 73, respectively.
23638
23639
23640 .option timeout pipe time 1h
23641 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23642 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23643 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23644 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23645 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23646 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23647
23648 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23649 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23650 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
23651 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
23652 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
23653 delivery to be deferred.
23654
23655 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
23656 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
23657
23658
23659 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
23660 .cindex "envelope sender"
23661 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
23662 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
23663 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
23664 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
23665 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
23666
23667 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
23668 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
23669 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
23670 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
23671 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
23672 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
23673 class database.
23674
23675
23676 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
23677 .cindex "carriage return"
23678 .cindex "linefeed"
23679 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23680 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23681 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
23682 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23683
23684 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
23685 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
23686 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
23687 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
23688 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23689
23690
23691 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
23692 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23693 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
23694 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
23695 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
23696 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
23697 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
23698 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
23699 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
23700 its &%-c%& option.
23701
23702
23703
23704 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
23705 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
23706 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
23707 .cindex "external local delivery"
23708 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
23709 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
23710 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
23711 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
23712 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23713 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23714 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23715 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23716 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23717 configuration for &%procmail%&:
23718 .code
23719 # transport
23720 procmail_pipe:
23721 driver = pipe
23722 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23723 return_path_add
23724 delivery_date_add
23725 envelope_to_add
23726 check_string = "From "
23727 escape_string = ">From "
23728 umask = 077
23729 user = $local_part
23730 group = mail
23731
23732 # router
23733 procmail:
23734 driver = accept
23735 check_local_user
23736 transport = procmail_pipe
23737 .endd
23738 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23739 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23740 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23741 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23742 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23743 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23744
23745 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23746 .code
23747 IFS=" "
23748 .endd
23749 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23750 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23751
23752 .cindex "Cyrus"
23753 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23754 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23755 .code
23756 # transport
23757 local_delivery_cyrus:
23758 driver = pipe
23759 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23760 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23761 user = cyrus
23762 group = mail
23763 return_output
23764 log_output
23765 message_prefix =
23766 message_suffix =
23767
23768 # router
23769 local_user_cyrus:
23770 driver = accept
23771 check_local_user
23772 local_part_suffix = .*
23773 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23774 .endd
23775 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23776 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23777 sender.
23778 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23779 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23780
23781
23782 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23783 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23784
23785 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23786 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23787 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23788 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23789 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23790 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23791 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23792 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23793
23794
23795 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23796 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23797 two ways:
23798
23799 .ilist
23800 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23801 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23802 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23803 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23804 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23805 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23806 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23807 .next
23808 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23809 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23810 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23811 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23812 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23813 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23814 process.
23815 .endlist
23816
23817
23818 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23819 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23820 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23821
23822
23823
23824 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23825 .vindex "&$host$&"
23826 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23827 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23828 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23829 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23830 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23831 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23832 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23833 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23834
23835
23836 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23837 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23838 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23839 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23840 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23841 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23842 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23843 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23844 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23845 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23846 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23847 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23848 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23849 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23850
23851 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23852 and will be removed in a future release.
23853
23854
23855 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23856 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23857 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23858
23859
23860 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23861 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23862 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23863 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23864 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23865 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23866 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23867 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23868
23869 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23870 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23871 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23872 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23873 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23874 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23875 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23876 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23877 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23878
23879
23880 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23881 .cindex "Cyrus"
23882 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23883 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23884 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23885 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23886 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23887 ignored.
23888
23889 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23890 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23891 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23892 particular connection.
23893
23894 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23895 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23896 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23897 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23898
23899 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23900 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23901 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23902 .code
23903 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23904 .endd
23905 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23906 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23907
23908 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23909 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23910 value.
23911
23912
23913 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23914 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23915 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23916 authenticated as a client.
23917
23918
23919 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23920 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23921 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23922 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23923
23924
23925 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23926 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23927 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23928 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23929 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23930 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23931 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23932
23933
23934 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23935 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23936 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23937 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23938 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23939 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23940 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23941 option.
23942
23943
23944 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23945 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23946 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23947 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23948
23949
23950 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
23951 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
23952 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
23953 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
23954 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
23955 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
23956 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
23957 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
23958 DKIM signing options. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
23959
23960
23961 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23962 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23963 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23964 cutoff times.
23965
23966 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23967 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23968 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23969 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23970 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23971 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23972
23973 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23974 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23975 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23976 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23977 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23978 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23979 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23980 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23981 to them.
23982
23983
23984 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23985 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23986 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23987 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23988 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23989
23990
23991 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23992 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23993 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23994 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23995 details.
23996
23997
23998 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23999 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24000 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24001 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24002 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24003 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24004 the dnssec request bit set.
24005 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24006
24007
24008
24009 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24010 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24011 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24012 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24013 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24014 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24015 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
24016 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
24017 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24018
24019
24020
24021 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24022 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24023 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24024 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24025 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24026 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24027 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24028
24029 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24030 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24031 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24032 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24033 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24034
24035
24036 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24037 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24038 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24039 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24040 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24041 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24042 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24043 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24044
24045 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24046 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24047 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24048 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24049 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24050 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24051
24052 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24053 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24054 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24055 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24056 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24057
24058 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24059 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24060 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24061 copy of the message is sent.
24062
24063 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24064 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24065 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24066 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24067 fails"& facility.
24068
24069
24070 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24071 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24072 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24073 zero.
24074
24075 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24076 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24077 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24078 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24079 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24080 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24081
24082 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24083 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24084 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24085 implementations of TLS.
24086
24087 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24088 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24089 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24090 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24091 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24092 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24093 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24094 option is:
24095 .code
24096 $primary_hostname
24097 .endd
24098 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24099 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24100 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24101 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24102 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24103 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24104 interface address, you could use this:
24105 .code
24106 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24107 {$primary_hostname}}
24108 .endd
24109 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24110 callouts.
24111
24112 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24113 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24114 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24115 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24116 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24117 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24118
24119 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24120 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24121 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24122 &%hosts_override%& is set.
24123
24124 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24125 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24126 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24127 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24128 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24129 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24130 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24131
24132 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24133 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24134 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24135 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24136 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24137 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24138 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24139 address are used.
24140
24141 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24142 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24143
24144
24145 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24146 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24147 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24148 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24149 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24150 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24151 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24152 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24153 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24154 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24155
24156
24157 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24158 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24159 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24160 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24161
24162
24163 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24164 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24165 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24166 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24167
24168 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24169 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24170 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24171 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24172 to any host that matches this list.
24173
24174
24175 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24176 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24177 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24178 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24179 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24180 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24181 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24182 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24183
24184
24185 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24186 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24187 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24188 why it exists.
24189
24190
24191
24192 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24193 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24194 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24195 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24196 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24197 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24198 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24199 explanation of when this might be needed.
24200
24201 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
24202 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24203 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24204 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24205 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24206 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24207 message on the same session.
24208
24209 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24210 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24211 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24212 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24213 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24214 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24215 logging.
24216
24217
24218
24219 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24220 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24221 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24222 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24223 &%fallback_hosts%&.
24224
24225
24226 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24227 .cindex "randomized host list"
24228 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24229 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24230 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24231 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24232 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24233 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24234 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24235 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24236
24237 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24238 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24239 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24240 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24241 .code
24242 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24243 .endd
24244 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24245 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24246 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24247
24248 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24249 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24250 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24251 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24252 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24253 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24254 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24255 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24256 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24257
24258
24259 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24260 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24261 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24262 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24263 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24264
24265 .new
24266 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24267 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24268 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24269 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24270 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24271 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
24272 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24273 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24274 .wen
24275
24276 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24277 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24278 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24279 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24280 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24281
24282 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24283 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24284 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24285 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24286 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24287 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24288
24289 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24290 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24291 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24292 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24293 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24294 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24295 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24296
24297 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24298 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24299 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24300 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24301 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24302 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24303 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24304
24305 .new
24306 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24307 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24308 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24309 If built with DANE support, Exim will lookup a
24310 TLSA record for any host matching the list.
24311 If found and verified by DNSSEC,
24312 a DANE-verified TLS connection is made to that host;
24313 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24314 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24315 .wen
24316
24317 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" unset
24318 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24319 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24320 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24321 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24322 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24323 perform a TCP Fast Open.
24324 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24325 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24326 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24327
24328 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24329 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24330
24331 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24332 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24333 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24334 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24335 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24336
24337 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24338 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24339 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24340 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24341 for multi-recipient messages.
24342 The option can usually be left as default.
24343
24344 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24345 .cindex "bind IP address"
24346 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
24347 .vindex "&$host$&"
24348 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24349 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24350 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24351 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24352 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24353 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24354 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24355 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24356 unknown.
24357
24358 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24359 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24360 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24361 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24362 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24363 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
24364 .code
24365 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24366 .endd
24367 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24368 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24369 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24370 interface to use if the host has more than one.
24371
24372
24373 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
24374 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24375 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24376 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24377 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24378 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24379 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24380 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24381 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24382 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24383 unreachable hosts.
24384
24385
24386 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24387 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24388 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24389 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24390 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24391
24392 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24393 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24394 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24395 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24396 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24397 permits this.
24398
24399
24400 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24401 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24402 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24403 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24404 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24405 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24406 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24407 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24408
24409 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24410 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24411 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24412
24413 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24414 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24415 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24416 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24417 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24418 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24419 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24420 variable that contains an outgoing port.
24421
24422 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24423 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24424 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
24425 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24426 is deferred.
24427
24428
24429
24430 .option protocol smtp string smtp
24431 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24432 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24433 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24434 .vindex "&$port$&"
24435 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24436 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24437 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24438 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24439 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24440
24441 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24442 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
24443 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
24444 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
24445
24446
24447 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
24448 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
24449 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
24450 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
24451 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
24452 addresses is not affected.
24453
24454 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
24455 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
24456 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
24457 Exim to use only the host name.
24458 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
24459
24460
24461 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24462 .cindex "serializing connections"
24463 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
24464 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
24465 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
24466 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
24467 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
24468 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
24469 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
24470
24471 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
24472 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
24473 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
24474 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
24475 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
24476 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
24477
24478 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
24479 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
24480 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
24481 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
24482 are used for ETRN serialization.
24483
24484 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
24485
24486
24487 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
24488 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
24489 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
24490 .cindex "size" "of message"
24491 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24492 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24493 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
24494 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
24495 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
24496 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24497 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24498 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24499
24500 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24501 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24502
24503
24504 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
24505 .cindex proxy SOCKS
24506 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
24507 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
24508
24509
24510 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
24511 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
24512 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
24513 .vindex "&$host$&"
24514 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24515 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24516 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
24517 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
24518 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
24519 details of TLS.
24520
24521 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
24522 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
24523 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
24524 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
24525 client.
24526
24527
24528 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
24529 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
24530 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
24531 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
24532 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
24533
24534
24535 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
24536 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
24537 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
24538 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
24539 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
24540 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
24541 will fail.
24542
24543 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
24544
24545
24546 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
24547 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
24548 .vindex "&$host$&"
24549 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24550 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24551 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24552 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24553 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24554 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24555 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24556 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24557
24558
24559 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24560 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24561 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24562 .vindex "&$host$&"
24563 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24564 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24565 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24566 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24567 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24568 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24569 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24570 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24571 ciphers is a preference order.
24572
24573
24574
24575 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24576 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24577 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24578 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24579 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24580 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24581 certificate and private key for the session.
24582
24583 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24584
24585 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24586 TLS extensions.
24587
24588
24589
24590
24591 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24592 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24593 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24594 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24595 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24596 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24597 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24598 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24599 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24600 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24601 in clear.
24602
24603
24604 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24605 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24606 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24607 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24608 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24609 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24610 Note that unless the host is in this list
24611 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24612 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24613 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24614 certificate verification succeeds.
24615
24616
24617 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
24618 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
24619 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24620 This option give a list of hosts for which,
24621 while verifying the server certificate,
24622 checks will be included on the host name
24623 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24624 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24625 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24626
24627 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
24628
24629
24630 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
24631 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24632 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24633 .vindex "&$host$&"
24634 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24635 The value of this option must be either the
24636 word "system"
24637 or the absolute path to
24638 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
24639 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
24640
24641 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
24642 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
24643 is taken as empty and an explicit location
24644 must be specified.
24645
24646 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
24647 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
24648
24649 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
24650 explicitly
24651 either by file or directory
24652 are added to those given by the system default location.
24653
24654 The values of &$host$& and
24655 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24656 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24657
24658 For back-compatibility,
24659 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
24660 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
24661 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
24662
24663
24664 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24665 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24666 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24667 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24668 certificate verification must succeed.
24669 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24670 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
24671 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
24672
24673
24674
24675
24676 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
24677 "SECTvalhosmax"
24678 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24679 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
24680 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
24681 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
24682 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
24683
24684
24685 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
24686 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
24687 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
24688 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
24689 retrying.
24690
24691 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
24692 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
24693 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
24694
24695 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
24696 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
24697 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
24698 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
24699 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
24700
24701 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
24702 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
24703 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
24704 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
24705 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
24706 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
24707 see below for an exception).
24708
24709 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
24710 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
24711 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
24712 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
24713 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
24714
24715 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
24716 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
24717 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
24718 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
24719 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
24720 reached their retry times.
24721
24722 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
24723 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
24724 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
24725 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
24726 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
24727 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
24728 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
24729 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
24730 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
24731 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
24732 reached.
24733
24734 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
24735 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
24736 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
24737 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
24738 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
24739 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
24740
24741 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
24742 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
24743 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
24744 possible IP addresses have been tried.
24745 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
24746 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
24747
24748
24749
24750
24751
24752 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24753 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24754
24755 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
24756 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
24757 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
24758 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
24759 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
24760 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
24761
24762 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
24763 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
24764 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
24765 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
24766 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
24767 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
24768 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
24769
24770 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
24771 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
24772 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
24773 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
24774
24775
24776 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
24777 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
24778 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
24779 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
24780
24781 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
24782 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
24783 facility; you do not have to use it.
24784
24785 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
24786 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
24787 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
24788 address to which it applies.
24789
24790 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
24791 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
24792 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
24793 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
24794 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
24795 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24796 rules.
24797
24798 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24799 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24800 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24801 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24802
24803
24804 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24805 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24806 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24807 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24808 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24809 discouraged.
24810
24811 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24812 illustrated by these examples:
24813
24814 .ilist
24815 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24816 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24817 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24818 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24819 .next
24820 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24821 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24822 .endlist
24823
24824
24825
24826 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24827 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24828 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24829 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24830 message's processing.
24831
24832 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24833 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24834 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24835 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24836 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24837 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24838 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24839 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24840 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24841
24842 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24843 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24844 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24845 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24846 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24847 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24848 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24849 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24850 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24851 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24852
24853 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24854 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24855 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24856 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24857 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24858 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24859
24860 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24861 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24862 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24863
24864 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24865 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24866 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24867 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24868 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24869 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24870 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24871 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24872 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24873
24874 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24875 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24876 transport time.
24877
24878
24879
24880
24881 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24882 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24883 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24884 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24885 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24886 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
24887 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24888 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24889 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24890 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24891 .code
24892 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24893 .endd
24894 might produce the output
24895 .code
24896 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24897 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24898 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24899 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24900 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24901 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24902 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24903 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24904 .endd
24905 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24906 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24907 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24908 set for a particular transport.
24909
24910
24911 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24912 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24913 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24914 rules in the form
24915 .display
24916 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24917 .endd
24918 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24919 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24920 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24921 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24922
24923 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24924 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24925 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24926 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24927 ignored.
24928
24929 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24930 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24931 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24932
24933 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24934 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24935 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24936 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24937 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24938 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24939 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24940
24941 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24942 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24943 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24944 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24945 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24946 .code
24947 *@* ${lookup ...
24948 .endd
24949 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24950 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24951
24952
24953 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24954 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24955 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24956 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24957 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24958 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24959 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24960 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24961 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24962
24963 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24964 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24965 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24966
24967 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24968 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24969 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24970 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24971 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24972 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24973 of pattern they are set as follows:
24974
24975 .ilist
24976 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24977 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24978 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24979 pattern
24980 .code
24981 *queen@*.fict.example
24982 .endd
24983 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24984 .code
24985 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24986 $1 = hearts-
24987 $2 = wonderland
24988 .endd
24989 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24990 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24991
24992 .next
24993 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24994 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24995 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24996 rewriting rule of the form
24997 .display
24998 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24999 .endd
25000 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25001 .code
25002 $1 = foo
25003 $2 = bar
25004 $3 = baz.example
25005 .endd
25006 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25007 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25008 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25009 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25010 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25011 .endlist
25012
25013
25014 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25015 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25016 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25017 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25018 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25019 .code
25020 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25021 .endd
25022 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25023 &'From:'& headers.
25024
25025 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25026 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25027 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25028 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25029 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25030 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25031 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25032 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25033 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25034 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25035 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25036 entry written to the panic log.
25037
25038
25039
25040 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25041 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25042
25043 .ilist
25044 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25045 c, f, h, r, s, t.
25046 .next
25047 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25048 .next
25049 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25050 .endlist
25051
25052 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25053 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25054
25055
25056
25057 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25058 "SECID154"
25059 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25060 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25061 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25062 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25063 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25064 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25065 .display
25066 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25067 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25068 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25069 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25070 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25071 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25072 &`h`& rewrite all headers
25073 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25074 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25075 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25076 .endd
25077 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25078 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25079 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25080
25081 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25082 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25083
25084
25085 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25086 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25087 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25088 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25089 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25090 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25091 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25092 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25093 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25094
25095 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25096 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25097 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25098 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25099 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25100 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25101 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25102 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25103
25104
25105 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25106 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25107 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25108 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25109
25110 .ilist
25111 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25112 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25113 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25114 .next
25115 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25116 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25117 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25118 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25119 .next
25120 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25121 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25122 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25123 .next
25124 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25125 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25126 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25127 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25128 .code
25129 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25130 .endd
25131 into
25132 .code
25133 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25134 .endd
25135 .cindex "RFC 2047"
25136 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25137 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25138 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25139 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
25140 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25141 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25142 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25143 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25144
25145 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25146 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25147 .endlist
25148
25149
25150 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25151 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25152 .code
25153 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25154 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25155 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25156 .endd
25157 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25158 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25159 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25160 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25161 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25162 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25163 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25164 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25165
25166 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25167 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25168 .code
25169 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25170 .endd
25171 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25172 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25173
25174 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25175 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25176 messages that originate outside the local host:
25177 .code
25178 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25179 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25180 .endd
25181 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25182 space.
25183
25184 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25185 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25186 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25187 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25188 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25189 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25190 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25191 components. For example, the rule
25192 .code
25193 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25194 .endd
25195 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25196 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25197 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25198 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25199 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25200 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25201 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25202 .ecindex IIDaddrew
25203
25204
25205
25206
25207
25208 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25209 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25210
25211 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25212 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25213 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25214 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25215 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25216 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25217 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25218 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25219 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25220 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25221 address, domain and error.
25222
25223 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25224 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25225 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25226 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25227 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25228 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25229 log selector is set, the message
25230 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25231 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25232 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25233 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25234
25235 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25236 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25237 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25238 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25239 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25240 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25241 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25242 domain are maintained independently.
25243
25244 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25245 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25246 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25247 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25248 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25249 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25250 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25251 the local address is reached.
25252
25253 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25254 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25255 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25256 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25257 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25258
25259 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25260 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25261 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25262 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25263 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25264 messages that it should now be retaining.
25265
25266
25267
25268 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25269 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25270 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25271 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25272 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25273 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25274 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25275 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25276 message's sender, respectively.
25277
25278
25279 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25280 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25281 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25282 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25283 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25284 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25285 example,
25286 .code
25287 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25288 .endd
25289 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25290 whereas
25291 .code
25292 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25293 .endd
25294 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25295 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25296 part.
25297
25298 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25299 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25300 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25301 expressions work in address lists.
25302 .display
25303 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25304 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25305 .endd
25306
25307
25308 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25309 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25310 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25311 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25312 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25313 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25314 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25315 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25316 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25317
25318 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25319 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25320 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25321 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25322 local transports).
25323
25324 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25325 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25326 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25327 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25328 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25329 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25330 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25331 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25332 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25333 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25334 commands.
25335
25336
25337
25338 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25339 "SECID160"
25340 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25341 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25342 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25343 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25344 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25345 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25346 .code
25347 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25348 MX 6 p.q.r.example
25349 MX 7 m.n.o.example
25350 .endd
25351 and the retry rules are
25352 .code
25353 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25354 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25355 .endd
25356 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25357 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25358 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25359 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25360 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25361 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25362
25363 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25364 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25365 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25366 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25367
25368 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25369 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25370 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25371 .code
25372 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25373 .endd
25374 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25375 textual form of the IP address.
25376
25377 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25378 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25379 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25380 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25381
25382 .vlist
25383 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
25384 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25385 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25386
25387 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
25388 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25389 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25390
25391 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25392 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25393
25394 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25395 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25396 .endlist
25397
25398 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25399 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25400 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25401 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25402 retry rule of this form:
25403 .code
25404 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25405 .endd
25406 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25407 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25408
25409 .vlist
25410 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
25411 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25412 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25413 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25414
25415 .vitem &%lookup%&
25416 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25417 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25418 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25419 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25420 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25421
25422 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
25423 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25424
25425 .vitem &%refused_A%&
25426 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25427
25428 .vitem &%refused%&
25429 A connection was refused.
25430
25431 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
25432 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
25433
25434 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
25435 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
25436
25437 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
25438 A connection attempt timed out.
25439
25440 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
25441 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
25442 obtained from an MX record.
25443
25444 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
25445 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
25446 obtained from an MX record.
25447
25448 .vitem &%timeout%&
25449 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
25450
25451 .vitem &%tls_required%&
25452 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
25453 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
25454 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
25455
25456 .vitem &%quota%&
25457 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25458 transport.
25459
25460 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
25461 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
25462 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
25463 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25464 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
25465 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
25466 for four days.
25467 .endlist
25468
25469 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
25470 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
25471 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
25472 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
25473 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
25474 heuristic rules:
25475
25476 .ilist
25477 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
25478 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
25479 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
25480 .next
25481 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
25482 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
25483 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
25484 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
25485 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
25486 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
25487 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
25488 .next
25489 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
25490 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
25491 .endlist
25492
25493 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
25494 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
25495 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
25496 error).
25497
25498
25499
25500 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
25501 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
25502 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
25503 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
25504 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
25505 form:
25506 .display
25507 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
25508 .endd
25509 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
25510 .code
25511 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
25512 .endd
25513 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
25514 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
25515 For example:
25516 .code
25517 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
25518 .endd
25519 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
25520 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
25521 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
25522 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
25523 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
25524
25525 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
25526 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
25527 .code
25528 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
25529 .endd
25530 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
25531 list is never matched.
25532
25533
25534
25535
25536
25537 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
25538 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
25539 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
25540 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
25541 .display
25542 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
25543 .endd
25544 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
25545 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
25546 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
25547 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
25548 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
25549
25550 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
25551 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25552 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25553 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25554 The available algorithms are:
25555
25556 .ilist
25557 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25558 the interval.
25559 .next
25560 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25561 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25562 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25563 .next
25564 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25565 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25566 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25567 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25568 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25569 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25570 queue processing times.
25571 .endlist
25572
25573 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25574 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25575 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25576 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25577 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25578 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25579 interval is found. The main configuration variable
25580 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25581 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25582 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25583 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25584 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25585
25586 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25587 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25588 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25589 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25590 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25591 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25592 time.
25593
25594 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25595 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25596 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25597 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25598 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25599 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25600 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25601 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25602 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25603 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25604 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25605 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
25606
25607 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
25608 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
25609 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
25610 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
25611 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
25612 deliveries that have been deferred.
25613
25614
25615 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
25616 Here are some example retry rules:
25617 .code
25618 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
25619 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
25620 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
25621 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25622 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
25623 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
25624 .endd
25625 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
25626 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
25627 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
25628 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
25629 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
25630 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
25631 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
25632 days.
25633
25634 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
25635 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
25636 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
25637 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
25638 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
25639
25640 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
25641 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
25642 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
25643 were not obtained from an MX record.
25644
25645 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
25646 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
25647 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
25648 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
25649 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
25650
25651
25652
25653 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
25654 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
25655 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
25656 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
25657 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
25658 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
25659 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
25660 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
25661 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
25662 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
25663 failing for the first time.
25664
25665 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
25666 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
25667 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
25668 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
25669
25670 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
25671 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
25672 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
25673
25674
25675
25676
25677 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
25678 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
25679 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
25680 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
25681 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
25682 default retry rule:
25683 .code
25684 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
25685 .endd
25686 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
25687 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
25688 failure for the recipient address that counts.
25689
25690 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
25691 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
25692 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
25693 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
25694 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
25695
25696 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
25697 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
25698 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
25699
25700 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
25701 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
25702 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
25703 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
25704 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
25705 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
25706 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
25707 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
25708
25709 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
25710 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
25711 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
25712 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
25713 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
25714 notice.
25715
25716 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25717 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
25718 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25719 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
25720 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
25721 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
25722 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
25723 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
25724 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
25725 true.
25726
25727 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
25728 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
25729 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
25730 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
25731 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
25732 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
25733 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
25734 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
25735 reached.
25736
25737 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
25738 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
25739 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
25740 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
25741 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
25742 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
25743 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
25744 time out the address.
25745
25746 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
25747 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
25748 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
25749 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
25750 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
25751 considered immediately.
25752 .ecindex IIDretconf1
25753 .ecindex IIDregconf2
25754
25755
25756
25757
25758
25759
25760 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25761 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25762
25763 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
25764 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
25765 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
25766 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
25767 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
25768 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
25769 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
25770 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
25771 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
25772 other.
25773
25774 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
25775 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
25776
25777 .ilist
25778 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
25779 the client's EHLO command.
25780 .next
25781 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
25782 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
25783 .next
25784 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
25785 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
25786 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
25787 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
25788 with the AUTH command.
25789 .next
25790 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
25791 .next
25792 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
25793 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
25794 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25795 connection.
25796 .next
25797 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25798 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25799 unauthenticated connection.
25800 .endlist
25801
25802 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25803 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25804 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25805 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25806 .display
25807 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25808 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25809 &`Connected to server.example.`&
25810 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
25811 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25812 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25813 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25814 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25815 &`250-PIPELINING`&
25816 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
25817 &`250 HELP`&
25818 .endd
25819 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25820 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25821 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25822 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25823 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25824 included by setting
25825 .code
25826 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
25827 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25828 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
25829 AUTH_GSASL=yes
25830 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25831 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
25832 AUTH_SPA=yes
25833 AUTH_TLS=yes
25834 .endd
25835 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25836 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25837 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25838 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25839 work via a socket interface.
25840 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25841 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25842 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25843 supporting setting a server keytab.
25844 The sixth can be configured to support
25845 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25846 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25847 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25848 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25849 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25850
25851 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25852 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25853 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25854 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25855 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25856 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25857 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25858
25859 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25860 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25861 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25862 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25863 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25864 both sets of options, is required. For example:
25865 .code
25866 cram:
25867 driver = cram_md5
25868 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25869 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25870 client_name = ph10
25871 client_secret = secret2
25872 .endd
25873 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25874 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25875
25876 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25877 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25878 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25879 in Exim.
25880
25881 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25882 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25883 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25884 authenticating data.
25885
25886 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25887 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25888 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25889 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25890 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25891 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25892 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25893 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25894 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25895 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25896 choose to honour.
25897
25898 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25899 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25900 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25901 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25902
25903
25904
25905 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25906 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25907 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25908
25909 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25910 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25911 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25912 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25913 encrypted by a setting such as:
25914 .code
25915 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25916 .endd
25917
25918
25919 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25920 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25921 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25922 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25923
25924
25925 .option driver authenticators string unset
25926 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25927 authenticators is to be used.
25928
25929
25930 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25931 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25932 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25933 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25934 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25935 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25936
25937
25938 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25939 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25940 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25941 mechanism is not advertised.
25942 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25943 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25944 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25945
25946
25947 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25948 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25949 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25950 for details.
25951
25952 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25953 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25954
25955 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25956 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25957 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25958 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25959 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25960 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25961 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25962 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25963 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25964 the error text.
25965
25966
25967 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25968 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25969 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25970 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25971 out the values of variables.
25972 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25973 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25974
25975
25976 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25977 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25978 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25979 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25980 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25981 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25982 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25983 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25984 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25985
25986
25987 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25988 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25989 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25990 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25991 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25992 remembered for later use.
25993 How it is used is described in the following section.
25994
25995
25996
25997
25998
25999 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26000 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26001 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26002 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26003 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26004 message:
26005
26006 .ilist
26007 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26008 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26009 .next
26010 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26011 .next
26012 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26013 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26014 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26015 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26016 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26017 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26018 given for the MAIL command.
26019 .next
26020 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26021 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26022 authenticated.
26023 .next
26024 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26025 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26026 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26027 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26028 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26029 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26030 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26031 message.
26032 .endlist
26033
26034
26035 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26036 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26037 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26038 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26039
26040 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26041 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26042 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26043 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26044 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26045 ACL is run.
26046
26047
26048
26049 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26050 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26051 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26052 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26053 conditions:
26054
26055 .ilist
26056 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26057 .next
26058 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26059 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26060 .endlist
26061
26062 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26063 the mechanisms are advertised.
26064
26065 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26066 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26067 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26068 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26069 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26070 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26071 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26072 .code
26073 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26074 .endd
26075 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26076
26077 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26078 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26079 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26080 such as:
26081 .code
26082 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26083 .endd
26084 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26085 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26086 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26087
26088 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26089 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26090 command. This is the case if
26091
26092 .ilist
26093 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26094 .next
26095 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26096 .next
26097 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26098 server authenticators.
26099 .endlist
26100
26101
26102 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26103 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26104 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26105
26106 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26107 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26108 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26109 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26110 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26111 rejected with a 504 error.
26112
26113 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26114 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26115 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26116 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26117 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26118 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26119 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26120 no successful authentication.
26121
26122 .new
26123 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
26124 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26125 &$authresults$& expansion item.
26126 .wen
26127
26128
26129
26130
26131 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26132 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26133 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26134 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26135 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26136 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26137 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26138 script:
26139 .code
26140 use MIME::Base64;
26141 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26142 .endd
26143 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26144 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26145 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26146 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26147 command line to run this script on such data might be
26148 .code
26149 encode '\0user\0password'
26150 .endd
26151 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26152 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26153 whose code value is zero.
26154
26155 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26156 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26157 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26158 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26159
26160 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26161 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26162 example, a command such as
26163 .code
26164 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26165 .endd
26166 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26167
26168 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26169 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26170 .code
26171 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26172 .endd
26173 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26174 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26175 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26176 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26177
26178
26179
26180 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26181 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26182 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26183 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26184 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26185 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26186
26187 .ilist
26188 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26189 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26190 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26191 of the authenticator.
26192 .next
26193 .vindex "&$host$&"
26194 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26195 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26196 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26197 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26198 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26199 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26200 delivery to be deferred.
26201 .next
26202 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26203 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26204 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26205 usual way.
26206 .next
26207 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26208 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26209 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26210 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26211 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26212 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26213 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26214 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26215 deliver the message unauthenticated.
26216 .endlist
26217
26218 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26219 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26220 on and the transport running. For example, with a manualroute
26221 router given a host name, and DNS "round-robin" use by that name: if
26222 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26223 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26224 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26225 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26226
26227 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26228
26229 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26230 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26231 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26232 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26233 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26234 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26235 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26236 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26237 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26238 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26239 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26240 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
26241 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
26242
26243
26244
26245
26246
26247
26248 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26249 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26250
26251 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26252 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26253 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26254 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26255 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26256 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26257 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26258 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26259 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26260 connections as you do for login accounts.
26261
26262 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26263 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26264 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26265
26266 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26267 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26268 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26269
26270 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26271 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26272 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26273 given.
26274
26275 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26276 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26277 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26278 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26279 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26280 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26281 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26282
26283 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26284 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26285 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26286 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26287 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26288 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26289 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26290
26291 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26292 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26293 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26294 string expansions that also use them for other things.
26295
26296 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26297 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26298 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26299
26300 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26301 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26302 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26303 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26304 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26305 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26306 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26307 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26308 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26309 string as the error text
26310
26311 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26312 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26313 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26314
26315
26316
26317 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26318 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26319 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26320 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26321 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26322 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26323 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26324 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26325
26326 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26327 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26328 configured as follows:
26329 .code
26330 fixed_plain:
26331 driver = plaintext
26332 public_name = PLAIN
26333 server_prompts = :
26334 server_condition = \
26335 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26336 server_set_id = $auth2
26337 .endd
26338 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26339 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26340 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26341 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26342
26343 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26344 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26345 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26346 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26347 .code
26348 250-AUTH PLAIN
26349 .endd
26350 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26351 .code
26352 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26353 .endd
26354 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26355 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26356 .code
26357 AUTH PLAIN
26358 .endd
26359 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26360 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26361
26362 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26363 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26364 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26365 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26366 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26367
26368 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26369 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26370 authenticating clients it could make sense.
26371
26372 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26373 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26374 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26375 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26376 This is an incorrect example:
26377 .code
26378 server_condition = \
26379 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26380 .endd
26381 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26382 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26383 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26384 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26385 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26386 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26387 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26388 .code
26389 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26390 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26391 .endd
26392 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26393 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26394 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26395 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26396 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26397
26398
26399 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26400 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26401 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26402 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26403 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26404 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26405 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26406 .code
26407 fixed_login:
26408 driver = plaintext
26409 public_name = LOGIN
26410 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26411 server_condition = \
26412 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26413 server_set_id = $auth1
26414 .endd
26415 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26416 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26417 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26418 strings are used to obtain two data items.
26419
26420 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26421 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
26422 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
26423 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
26424 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
26425 .code
26426 login:
26427 driver = plaintext
26428 public_name = LOGIN
26429 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
26430 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
26431 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
26432 ldapauth{\
26433 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
26434 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
26435 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
26436 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
26437 .endd
26438 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
26439 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
26440 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
26441 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
26442 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
26443 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
26444 uninterpreted string.
26445
26446
26447 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
26448 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
26449 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
26450 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
26451 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
26452 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
26453
26454
26455
26456
26457 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
26458 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
26459 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
26460
26461 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
26462 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
26463 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
26464 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
26465 usual.
26466
26467 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
26468 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
26469 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
26470 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
26471 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
26472 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
26473 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
26474 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
26475 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
26476 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
26477 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
26478 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
26479
26480 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
26481 splitting takes priority and happens first.
26482
26483 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
26484 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
26485 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
26486 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
26487 the string.
26488
26489 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
26490 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
26491 .code
26492 fixed_plain:
26493 driver = plaintext
26494 public_name = PLAIN
26495 client_send = ^username^mysecret
26496 .endd
26497 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
26498 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
26499 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
26500 .code
26501 fixed_login:
26502 driver = plaintext
26503 public_name = LOGIN
26504 client_send = : username : mysecret
26505 .endd
26506 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
26507 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
26508 prompts.
26509 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
26510 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
26511
26512
26513
26514
26515 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26516 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26517
26518 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
26519 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26520 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
26521 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
26522 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
26523 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
26524 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
26525 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
26526 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
26527 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
26528 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
26529 available in plain text at either end.
26530
26531
26532 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
26533 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
26534 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
26535 authenticator as a server:
26536
26537 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26538 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26539 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
26540 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
26541 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
26542 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
26543 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
26544 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
26545 returned to the client.
26546
26547 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
26548 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
26549 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
26550 numeric variables for other things.
26551
26552 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
26553 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
26554 user name, authentication fails.
26555 .code
26556 fixed_cram:
26557 driver = cram_md5
26558 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26559 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
26560 server_set_id = $auth1
26561 .endd
26562 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26563 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
26564 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
26565 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
26566 .code
26567 lookup_cram:
26568 driver = cram_md5
26569 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26570 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26571 {$value}fail}
26572 server_set_id = $auth1
26573 .endd
26574 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26575 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26576
26577 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26578 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26579 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26580 realm, with:
26581 .code
26582 cyrusless_crammd5:
26583 driver = cram_md5
26584 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26585 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26586 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26587 server_set_id = $auth1
26588 .endd
26589
26590 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26591 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26592 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26593
26594
26595
26596 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
26597 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
26598 computing the response to the server's challenge.
26599
26600
26601 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26602 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
26603 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
26604
26605
26606 .vindex "&$host$&"
26607 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26608 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
26609 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
26610 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
26611 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
26612 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
26613 send the message to the current server.
26614
26615 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
26616 strings, is:
26617 .code
26618 fixed_cram:
26619 driver = cram_md5
26620 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26621 client_name = ph10
26622 client_secret = secret
26623 .endd
26624 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
26625 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
26626
26627
26628
26629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26630 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26631
26632 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
26633 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
26634 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
26635 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
26636 .cindex "Kerberos"
26637 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
26638 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
26639
26640 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
26641 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
26642 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
26643 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
26644 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
26645
26646 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
26647 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
26648 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
26649 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
26650
26651 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
26652 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
26653 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
26654 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
26655 depending on the driver you are using.
26656
26657 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
26658 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
26659 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
26660 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
26661 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
26662 implementation.
26663
26664 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
26665 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
26666 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
26667 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
26668 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
26669 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
26670 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
26671 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
26672
26673
26674 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
26675 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
26676 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
26677 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
26678 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
26679 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
26680 things.
26681
26682
26683 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
26684 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26685 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
26686 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
26687
26688
26689 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
26690 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26691 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26692 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26693 example:
26694 .code
26695 sasl:
26696 driver = cyrus_sasl
26697 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26698 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26699 server_set_id = $auth1
26700 .endd
26701
26702 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
26703 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26704
26705
26706 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
26707 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26708
26709
26710 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
26711 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
26712 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
26713 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
26714 .code
26715 sasl_cram_md5:
26716 driver = cyrus_sasl
26717 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26718 server_set_id = $auth1
26719
26720 sasl_plain:
26721 driver = cyrus_sasl
26722 public_name = PLAIN
26723 server_set_id = $auth2
26724 .endd
26725 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
26726 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
26727 but it is present in many binary distributions.
26728 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
26729 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
26730
26731
26732
26733
26734 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26735 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26736 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
26737 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
26738 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
26739 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
26740 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
26741 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
26742 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
26743 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
26744 authenticator only. There is only one option:
26745
26746 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
26747
26748 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
26749 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
26750 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
26751 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
26752 .code
26753 dovecot_plain:
26754 driver = dovecot
26755 public_name = PLAIN
26756 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26757 server_set_id = $auth1
26758
26759 dovecot_ntlm:
26760 driver = dovecot
26761 public_name = NTLM
26762 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26763 server_set_id = $auth1
26764 .endd
26765 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
26766 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
26767 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
26768 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
26769 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
26770 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
26771 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
26772 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
26773
26774
26775 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26776 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26777 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
26778 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
26779 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
26780 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
26781 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
26782 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26783 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26784 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
26785 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
26786 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
26787 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
26788 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
26789 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
26790 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
26791 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
26792 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
26793 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
26794 without code changes in Exim.
26795
26796
26797 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
26798 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
26799 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
26800 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
26801 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
26802 context.
26803
26804 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
26805 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
26806 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
26807
26808 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
26809 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
26810 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
26811
26812 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26813 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26814 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26815
26816
26817 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26818 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26819 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26820 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26821
26822
26823 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26824 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26825 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26826 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26827 example:
26828 .code
26829 sasl:
26830 driver = gsasl
26831 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26832 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26833 server_set_id = $auth1
26834 .endd
26835
26836
26837 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26838 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26839 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26840 the password itself.
26841
26842 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26843 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26844 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26845 if available, else the empty string.
26846 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26847 else the empty string.
26848
26849 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26850
26851 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26852 option to be simply "true".
26853
26854
26855 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26856 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26857 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26858
26859
26860 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26861 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26862 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26863 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26864
26865
26866 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26867 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26868 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26869 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26870
26871
26872 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26873 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26874 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26875
26876
26877 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26878 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26879 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26880 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26881
26882 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26883 meanings for these variables:
26884
26885 .ilist
26886 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26887 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26888 .next
26889 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26890 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26891 .next
26892 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
26893 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26894 .endlist
26895
26896 On a per-mechanism basis:
26897
26898 .ilist
26899 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26900 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26901 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26902 .next
26903 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26904 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26905 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26906 .next
26907 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26908 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26909 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26910 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26911 .endlist
26912
26913 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26914 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26915 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26916
26917
26918 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26919 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26920 .code
26921 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26922 driver = gsasl
26923 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26924 server_realm = imap.example.org
26925 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26926 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26927 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26928 server_condition = yes
26929 .endd
26930
26931
26932 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26933 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26934
26935 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26936 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26937 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26938 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26939 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26940 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26941 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26942 reliably.
26943
26944 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26945 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26946 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26947 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26948
26949 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26950 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26951 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26952 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26953
26954 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26955 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26956 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26957 from the keytab.
26958
26959
26960 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26961 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26962 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26963 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26964
26965 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26966 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26967 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26968 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26969
26970 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26971 .ilist
26972 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26973 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26974 .next
26975 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26976 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26977 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26978 GSS Display Name.
26979 .endlist
26980
26981
26982 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26983 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26984
26985 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26986 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26987 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26988 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26989 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26990 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26991 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
26992 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26993 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26994 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26995 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26996 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26997 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26998 follows:
26999
27000 .ilist
27001 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27002 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27003 .next
27004 The server sends back a challenge.
27005 .next
27006 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27007 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27008 .endlist
27009
27010 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27011
27012
27013
27014 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27015 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27016 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27017
27018 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
27019 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27020 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27021 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27022 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27023 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27024 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27025 for other things. For example:
27026 .code
27027 spa:
27028 driver = spa
27029 public_name = NTLM
27030 server_password = \
27031 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27032 .endd
27033 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27034 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27035
27036
27037
27038
27039
27040 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27041 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27042 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27043
27044
27045
27046 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27047 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27048
27049
27050 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
27051 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27052
27053
27054 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
27055 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27056 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27057 &'msn.com'&:
27058 .code
27059 msn:
27060 driver = spa
27061 public_name = MSN
27062 client_username = msn/msn_username
27063 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27064 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27065 .endd
27066 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
27067 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
27068
27069
27070
27071
27072
27073 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27074 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27075
27076 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27077 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27078 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27079 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27080 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27081 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27082 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27083 authentication based on client certificates.
27084
27085 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27086 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27087 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27088 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27089 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27090 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27091
27092 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27093 for which it must have been requested via the
27094 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27095 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27096
27097 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27098 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27099 and can authenticate the connection.
27100 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27101
27102 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27103
27104
27105 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27106 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27107
27108 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27109 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27110 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27111 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27112 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27113 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27114
27115 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27116 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27117 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27118
27119 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27120
27121
27122 Example:
27123 .code
27124 tls:
27125 driver = tls
27126 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27127 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27128 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
27129 {!= {0} \
27130 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27131 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27132 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27133 } } } }
27134 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27135 .endd
27136 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27137 of your configured trust-anchors
27138 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27139 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27140 Note that the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27141 whereas a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27142
27143 . An alternative might use
27144 . .code
27145 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27146 . .endd
27147 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27148 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27149 . This would help for per-device use.
27150 .
27151 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27152 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27153
27154 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27155 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27156
27157
27158 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27159 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27160 a connect- or helo-ACL.
27161
27162
27163
27164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27165 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27166
27167 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27168 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27169 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27170 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27171 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27172 .cindex "OpenSSL"
27173 .cindex "GnuTLS"
27174 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27175 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27176 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27177 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27178 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27179 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27180 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27181 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27182 certificates are used.
27183
27184 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27185 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27186 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27187 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27188 between them is encrypted.
27189
27190 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27191 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27192 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27193 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27194 encryption state.
27195
27196 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27197 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27198 in order to get TLS to work.
27199
27200
27201
27202 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27203 "SECID284"
27204 .cindex "submissions protocol"
27205 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27206 .cindex "smtps protocol"
27207 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
27208 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27209 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27210 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
27211 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
27212 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
27213 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
27214 in preference to STARTTLS.
27215
27216 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
27217 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
27218 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
27219
27220 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
27221 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
27222 reassigned for other use.
27223 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
27224 this port.
27225 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only supported submissions, not
27226 submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
27227 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
27228
27229 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
27230 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
27231 the most common use is expected to be:
27232 .code
27233 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27234 .endd
27235 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27236 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27237 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27238 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27239 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27240 defined elsewhere.
27241
27242 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27243 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
27244
27245
27246
27247
27248
27249
27250 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
27251 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
27252 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
27253 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
27254 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
27255 .code
27256 USE_GNUTLS=yes
27257 .endd
27258 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
27259 .code
27260 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
27261 .endd
27262 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
27263 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
27264
27265 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
27266
27267 .ilist
27268 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
27269 cannot be the path of a directory
27270 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
27271 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
27272 .next
27273 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
27274 .next
27275 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27276 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
27277 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
27278 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
27279 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
27280 .next
27281 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
27282 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
27283 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
27284 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
27285 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
27286 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
27287 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
27288 option).
27289 .next
27290 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
27291 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
27292 .next
27293 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
27294 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
27295 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
27296 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
27297 .next
27298 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
27299 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
27300 .next
27301 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
27302 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
27303 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
27304 implementation, then patches are welcome.
27305 .endlist
27306
27307
27308 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
27309 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
27310 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
27311 but not the chosen filename.
27312 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
27313 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
27314
27315 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
27316 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
27317 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
27318 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
27319 of bits requested.
27320 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
27321 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
27322 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
27323 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
27324 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
27325 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
27326 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
27327
27328 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
27329 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
27330 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
27331 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
27332 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
27333
27334 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
27335 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
27336 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
27337 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
27338 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
27339 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
27340
27341 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
27342 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
27343 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
27344
27345 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
27346 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
27347 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
27348 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
27349 .code
27350 # ls
27351 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
27352 # rm -f new-params
27353 # touch new-params
27354 # chown exim:exim new-params
27355 # chmod 0600 new-params
27356 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
27357 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
27358 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
27359 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
27360 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
27361 # chmod 0400 new-params
27362 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
27363 .endd
27364 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
27365 stalling is removed.
27366
27367 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
27368 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
27369 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
27370 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
27371 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
27372 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
27373 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
27374 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
27375 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
27376 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
27377 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
27378
27379 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
27380 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
27381 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
27382 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
27383
27384 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
27385 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
27386 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
27387 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
27388 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
27389
27390
27391 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
27392 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
27393 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
27394 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
27395 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
27396 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
27397 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
27398 directly to this function call.
27399 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
27400 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
27401 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
27402 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
27403
27404 .ilist
27405 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
27406 .next
27407 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
27408 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
27409 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
27410 SSL v3 algorithms.
27411 .next
27412 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
27413 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
27414 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
27415 algorithms.
27416 .endlist
27417
27418 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
27419 &`-`& or &`+`&.
27420 .ilist
27421 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
27422 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
27423 stated.
27424 .next
27425 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
27426 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
27427 .next
27428 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
27429 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
27430 .endlist
27431
27432 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
27433 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
27434 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
27435 not be moved to the end of the list.
27436 .endlist
27437
27438 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
27439 string:
27440 .code
27441 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
27442 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
27443 .endd
27444
27445 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27446 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
27447 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
27448 choice of clients used:
27449 .code
27450 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
27451 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27452 {DEFAULT}\
27453 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
27454 .endd
27455
27456 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
27457 .code
27458 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
27459 .endd
27460
27461
27462 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
27463 "SECTreqciphgnu"
27464 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
27465 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
27466 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
27467 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
27468 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
27469 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
27470 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
27471 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
27472 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
27473 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
27474
27475 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
27476 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
27477
27478 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
27479 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
27480 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
27481 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
27482 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
27483 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
27484
27485 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
27486 "Priority strings". This is online as
27487 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
27488 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
27489 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
27490 then the example code
27491 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
27492 on that site can be used to test a given string.
27493
27494 For example:
27495 .code
27496 # Disable older versions of protocols
27497 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
27498 .endd
27499
27500 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
27501 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
27502 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
27503
27504 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27505 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
27506 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
27507 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
27508 used:
27509 .code
27510 # GnuTLS variant
27511 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27512 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
27513 {SECURE128}}
27514 .endd
27515
27516
27517 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
27518 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
27519 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
27520 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
27521 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
27522 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
27523 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
27524
27525 If STARTTLS is to be used you
27526 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
27527
27528 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
27529 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
27530 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
27531 with the error
27532 .code
27533 554 Security failure
27534 .endd
27535 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
27536 rejected with a 554 error code.
27537
27538 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
27539 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
27540
27541 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
27542 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
27543 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
27544 from someone able to intercept the communication.
27545
27546 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
27547
27548 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
27549 .code
27550 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
27551 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
27552 .endd
27553 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
27554 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
27555 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
27556 that goes with it. These files need to be
27557 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
27558 always be given as full path names.
27559 The key must not be password-protected.
27560 They can be the same file if both the
27561 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
27562 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
27563 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
27564 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
27565 the server's certificate.
27566
27567 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
27568 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
27569 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
27570 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
27571 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
27572 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
27573
27574 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
27575 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
27576 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
27577
27578 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
27579 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
27580 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
27581 transport.
27582
27583 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
27584 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
27585 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
27586 .code
27587 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
27588 .endd
27589 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
27590 with the parameters contained in the file.
27591 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
27592 available:
27593 .code
27594 tls_dhparam = none
27595 .endd
27596 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
27597 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
27598 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
27599 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
27600
27601 See the command
27602 .code
27603 openssl dhparam
27604 .endd
27605 for a way of generating file data.
27606
27607 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
27608 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
27609 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
27610 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
27611 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
27612
27613 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27614 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27615 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27616 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
27617 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
27618 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
27619 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
27620 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
27621 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
27622
27623 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
27624 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
27625 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
27626 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
27627 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
27628 documentation for more details.
27629
27630 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
27631 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
27632
27633
27634 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
27635 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27636 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27637 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
27638 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
27639 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
27640 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
27641 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
27642 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
27643 expected certificates.
27644 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27645 an explicit file or,
27646 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
27647 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
27648
27649 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
27650 directory is used
27651 (OpenSSL only),
27652 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
27653 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
27654 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
27655 .code
27656 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
27657 .endd
27658 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
27659
27660 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
27661 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
27662 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
27663 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
27664 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
27665 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
27666 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
27667 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
27668 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
27669 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
27670
27671 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27672 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
27673 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
27674 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
27675
27676 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27677 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
27678 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
27679 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
27680 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
27681 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
27682
27683
27684 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
27685 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
27686 .cindex "revocation list"
27687 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
27688 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
27689 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
27690 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
27691 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
27692 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
27693 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
27694 CRL in PEM format.
27695 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
27696 file from every certificate authority they know of.
27697
27698 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
27699 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
27700 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
27701 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
27702 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
27703 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
27704
27705 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
27706 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
27707 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
27708 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
27709
27710 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
27711 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
27712 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
27713 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
27714 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
27715 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
27716 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
27717 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
27718
27719 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
27720 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
27721 support for OCSP stapling is included.
27722
27723 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27724 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
27725 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
27726 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
27727 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
27728
27729 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
27730 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
27731 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
27732 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
27733 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
27734 next connection.
27735
27736 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
27737 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
27738 ignored.
27739
27740 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
27741 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
27742 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
27743 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
27744 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
27745 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27746
27747 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
27748 not any of the chain from CA to it.
27749
27750 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
27751
27752 .code
27753 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
27754 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
27755 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
27756
27757 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
27758 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
27759 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
27760 .endd
27761
27762
27763
27764
27765 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
27766 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27767 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27768 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27769 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
27770 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
27771 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
27772 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
27773 within the &(smtp)& transport.
27774
27775 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
27776 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
27777 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
27778 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
27779 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
27780
27781 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
27782 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
27783 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
27784 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
27785 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
27786 usual way.
27787
27788 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
27789 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
27790 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
27791 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
27792 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
27793 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
27794 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
27795 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
27796 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
27797 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
27798 unencrypted.
27799
27800 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
27801 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
27802 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
27803 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
27804
27805 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
27806 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
27807 These may be
27808 the system default set (depending on library version),
27809 a file,
27810 or (depending on library version) a directory.
27811 The client verifies the server's certificate
27812 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
27813 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
27814 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
27815 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
27816
27817 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
27818 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
27819 or need not succeed respectively.
27820
27821 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
27822 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
27823 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
27824 value is empty.
27825 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
27826 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
27827 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
27828 otherwise.
27829
27830 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
27831 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
27832 for OCSP to be relevant.
27833
27834 If
27835 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
27836 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
27837 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
27838 alternative hosts, if any.
27839
27840 &*Note*&:
27841 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
27842 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
27843 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
27844 client.
27845
27846 .vindex "&$host$&"
27847 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27848 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
27849 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
27850 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
27851 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
27852
27853 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
27854 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
27855 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
27856 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
27857 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
27858 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
27859 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
27860 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27861 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27862 outgoing connection.
27863
27864
27865
27866 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27867 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27868 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27869 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27870 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27871 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27872 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27873 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27874 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27875 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27876 for this session.
27877
27878 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27879 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27880 address.
27881
27882 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27883 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27884 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27885 be of limited use in that environment.
27886
27887 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27888 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27889 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27890 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27891 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27892
27893 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27894 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27895 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27896 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27897 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27898
27899 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27900 received from a client.
27901 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27902
27903 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27904 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27905 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27906
27907 .ilist
27908 &%tls_certificate%&
27909 .next
27910 &%tls_crl%&
27911 .next
27912 &%tls_privatekey%&
27913 .next
27914 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
27915 .next
27916 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
27917 .endlist
27918
27919 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27920 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27921 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
27922 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27923 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI is arrived, so
27924 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
27925 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
27926
27927 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27928 are re-expanded.
27929
27930 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27931 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27932 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27933 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27934
27935 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
27936 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27937 built, then you have SNI support).
27938
27939
27940
27941 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27942 "SECTmulmessam"
27943 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27944 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27945 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27946 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27947 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27948 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27949 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27950 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
27951 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
27952 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
27953
27954 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
27955 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
27956 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
27957 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
27958 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27959 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27960 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27961
27962 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27963 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27964 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27965 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27966 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27967 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27968 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27969 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27970 and delay other deliveries to that host.
27971
27972 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27973 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27974 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27975 information is recorded.
27976
27977 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27978 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27979 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27980
27981
27982
27983
27984 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27985 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27986 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27987 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27988 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27989 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27990 to Apache, currently at
27991 .display
27992 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27993 .endd
27994 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27995 links to further files.
27996 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
27997 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27998 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27999 .display
28000 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
28001 .endd
28002
28003
28004 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28005 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28006 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28007 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28008 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28009 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28010 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28011 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28012 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28013 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28014 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28015 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28016 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28017
28018 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28019 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28020 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28021 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28022
28023
28024
28025 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28026 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28027 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28028 with OpenSSL, like this:
28029 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28030 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28031 .code
28032 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28033 -days 9999 -nodes
28034 .endd
28035 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28036 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28037 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28038 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28039 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28040 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28041 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28042
28043 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28044 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28045 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28046 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28047 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28048 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28049 . ==== -pdp, 2012
28050 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28051 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28052 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28053 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28054 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28055 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28056 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28057 be a sensible resolution).
28058
28059 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28060 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28061 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28062
28063 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28064 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28065 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28066 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28067 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28068 signed with that self-signed certificate.
28069
28070 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28071 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28072 Open-source PKI book, available online at
28073 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
28074 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28075 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28076
28077
28078
28079 .new
28080 .section DANE "SECDANE"
28081 .cindex DANE
28082 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28083 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28084 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28085 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28086 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28087 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28088
28089 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28090 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28091 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28092
28093 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28094 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28095
28096 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28097 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28098 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28099
28100 DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28101 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28102 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28103 DNSSEC.
28104 2) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
28105 3) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is traceable to the one
28106 defined by (one of?) the TSLA records
28107
28108 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
28109 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
28110 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
28111 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
28112
28113 The TLSA record for the server may have "certificate usage" of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3). The latter specifies
28114 the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server (and should be the sole one transmitted
28115 during the TLS handshake); this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
28116 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
28117 well-known one. A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate which is used to sign
28118 cerver certificates, but running one securely does require careful arrangement. If a private CA is used
28119 then either all clients must be primed with it, or (probably simpler) the server TLS handshake must transmit
28120 the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate. If a public CA is used then all clients must be primed with it
28121 (losing one advantage of DANE) - but the attack surface is reduced from all public CAs to that single CA.
28122 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
28123 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
28124
28125 The TLSA record should have a Selector field of SPKI(1) and a Matching Type field of SHA2-512(2).
28126
28127 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
28128 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records; and commands like
28129
28130 .code
28131 openssl x509 -in -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
28132 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
28133 | openssl sha512 \
28134 | awk '{print $2}'
28135 .endd
28136
28137 are workable for 4th-field hashes.
28138
28139 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
28140
28141 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
28142 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
28143 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
28144
28145 .code
28146 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
28147 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
28148 {*}{}}
28149 .endd
28150
28151 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
28152 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
28153 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
28154 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
28155 control the OCSP request.
28156
28157 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
28158 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
28159
28160
28161 For client-side DANE there are two new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%& and &%hosts_require_dane%&.
28162 The latter variant will result in failure if the target host is not DNSSEC-secured.
28163
28164 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
28165
28166 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
28167 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
28168 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
28169 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
28170
28171 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
28172 .code
28173 hosts_require_tls
28174 tls_verify_hosts
28175 tls_try_verify_hosts
28176 tls_verify_certificates
28177 tls_crl
28178 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
28179 .endd
28180
28181 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
28182 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
28183
28184 Currently the &%dnssec_request_domains%& must be active and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
28185
28186 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
28187
28188 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
28189 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
28190 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
28191 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
28192
28193 .cindex DANE reporting
28194 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
28195 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
28196 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
28197 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
28198 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
28199 Section 4.3 of that document.
28200
28201 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
28202 .wen
28203
28204
28205
28206 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28207 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28208
28209 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
28210 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
28211 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
28212 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
28213 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
28214 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
28215 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
28216 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
28217 one very small ACL:
28218 .code
28219 begin acl
28220 small_acl:
28221 accept hosts = one.host.only
28222 .endd
28223 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
28224 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
28225
28226 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
28227 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
28228 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
28229 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
28230 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
28231 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
28232 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
28233 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28234
28235
28236 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
28237 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
28238 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
28239
28240
28241 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
28242 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
28243 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
28244 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
28245 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
28246 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28247 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
28248 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
28249 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28250 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28251 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
28252 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
28253 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28254 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
28255 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
28256 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
28257 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28258 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28259 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
28260 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28261
28262 .table2 140pt
28263 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
28264 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
28265 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
28266 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
28267 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
28268 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
28269 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
28270 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
28271 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
28272 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
28273 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
28274 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
28275 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
28276 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
28277 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
28278 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
28279 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
28280 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
28281 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
28282 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
28283 .endtable
28284
28285 For example, if you set
28286 .code
28287 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
28288 .endd
28289 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
28290 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
28291 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
28292 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
28293 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
28294 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
28295 testing as possible at RCPT time.
28296
28297
28298 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
28299 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28300 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
28301 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
28302 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
28303 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
28304 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
28305 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
28306 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
28307 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
28308 in any of these ACLs.
28309
28310 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
28311 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
28312 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
28313 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
28314 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
28315 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
28316 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
28317 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
28318 .code
28319 control = suppress_local_fixups
28320 .endd
28321 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
28322 run, it is too late.
28323
28324 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28325 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28326
28327 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
28328 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
28329 temporary error for these kinds of message.
28330
28331
28332 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
28333 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28334 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
28335 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
28336 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
28337 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
28338 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
28339 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
28340 &%smtp_banner%& option.
28341
28342
28343 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
28344 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28345 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28346 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
28347 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
28348 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
28349 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
28350 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
28351 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
28352
28353 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
28354 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
28355 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
28356
28357 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
28358 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
28359 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
28360 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
28361 an EHLO response.
28362
28363
28364 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
28365 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28366 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
28367 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
28368 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
28369 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
28370 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
28371 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
28372 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
28373 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
28374
28375 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
28376 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
28377 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
28378 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
28379 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
28380 associated with the DATA command.
28381
28382 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
28383 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
28384 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
28385 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
28386 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
28387 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
28388 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
28389 the data specified is received.
28390
28391 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
28392 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
28393 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
28394 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
28395 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
28396 your resources.
28397
28398 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
28399 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
28400 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
28401 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
28402
28403 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
28404 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
28405 enabled (which is the default).
28406
28407 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
28408 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
28409 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
28410
28411 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28412
28413 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
28414
28415
28416 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
28417 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28418 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28419
28420 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28421
28422
28423 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
28424 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28425 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
28426 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
28427 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
28428 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
28429 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
28430 has been accepted.
28431
28432 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
28433 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
28434 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
28435 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
28436 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
28437 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
28438 for some or all recipients.
28439
28440 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
28441 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
28442 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
28443 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
28444 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
28445 is &"yes"&.
28446 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
28447 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
28448 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
28449
28450 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
28451 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
28452
28453 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28454 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
28455 the feature was not requested by the client.
28456
28457 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
28458 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28459 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
28460 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
28461 does not in fact control any access.
28462 For this reason, it may only accept
28463 or warn as its final result.
28464
28465 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
28466 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
28467 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
28468 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
28469
28470 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
28471 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
28472
28473 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
28474 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
28475 response to QUIT.
28476
28477 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
28478 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
28479 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
28480 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
28481 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
28482
28483
28484 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
28485 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
28486 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
28487 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
28488 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
28489 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
28490 situation even worse.
28491
28492 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
28493 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
28494 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
28495 and &%warn%&.
28496
28497 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
28498 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
28499 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
28500 connection. The possible values are:
28501 .table2
28502 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
28503 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
28504 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
28505 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
28506 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
28507 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
28508 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
28509 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
28510 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
28511 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
28512 .endtable
28513 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
28514 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
28515 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
28516 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
28517 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
28518 used.
28519
28520
28521 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
28522 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
28523 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
28524 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
28525 .code
28526 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
28527 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
28528 .endd
28529 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
28530 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
28531 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
28532 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
28533 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
28534
28535 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
28536 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
28537 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
28538
28539 .ilist
28540 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
28541 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
28542 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
28543 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
28544 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
28545 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
28546 .code
28547 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
28548 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
28549 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
28550 .endd
28551 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
28552 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
28553 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
28554 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
28555 .next
28556 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
28557 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
28558 matches the string.
28559 .next
28560 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
28561 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
28562 want to have something like
28563 .code
28564 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
28565 .endd
28566 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
28567 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
28568 .endlist
28569
28570
28571
28572
28573 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
28574 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
28575 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
28576 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
28577 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
28578 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
28579 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
28580 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
28581 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
28582
28583 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
28584 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
28585 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
28586
28587
28588 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
28589 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
28590 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
28591 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
28592
28593 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
28594 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
28595 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
28596 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
28597 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
28598 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
28599 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
28600
28601 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
28602 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
28603
28604
28605 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
28606 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
28607 recipients; it may create new recipients.
28608
28609
28610
28611 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
28612 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
28613 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
28614 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
28615 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
28616 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
28617
28618 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
28619 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
28620 used to accept or reject anything.
28621
28622 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
28623 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
28624 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
28625 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
28626
28627 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
28628 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
28629 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
28630 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
28631 configuration file.
28632
28633
28634
28635
28636 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
28637 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
28638 .vindex &$domain$&
28639 .vindex &$local_part$&
28640 .vindex &$sender_address$&
28641 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
28642 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28643 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
28644 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
28645 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
28646 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
28647 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
28648 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28649
28650 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
28651 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
28652 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
28653 how it is used.
28654
28655 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
28656 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
28657 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
28658 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
28659 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
28660 received).
28661
28662 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
28663 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
28664 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
28665 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
28666 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
28667 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
28668 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
28669 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
28670
28671
28672
28673
28674
28675 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
28676 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
28677 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
28678 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28679 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
28680 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
28681 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28682 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
28683 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
28684 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
28685 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
28686 unencrypted connections.
28687 .code
28688 acl_check_auth:
28689 accept encrypted = *
28690 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
28691 {CRAM-MD5}}
28692 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
28693 .endd
28694 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
28695 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
28696 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
28697 option to do this.)
28698
28699
28700
28701 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
28702 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
28703 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
28704 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
28705 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
28706 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
28707 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
28708
28709 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
28710 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
28711 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
28712 example:
28713 .code
28714 deny dnslists = list1.example
28715 dnslists = list2.example
28716 .endd
28717 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
28718 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
28719 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
28720 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
28721 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
28722
28723
28724 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
28725 The ACL verbs are as follows:
28726
28727 .ilist
28728 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
28729 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
28730 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
28731 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
28732 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
28733 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
28734 check a RCPT command:
28735 .code
28736 accept domains = +local_domains
28737 endpass
28738 verify = recipient
28739 .endd
28740 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
28741 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
28742 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
28743 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
28744 &%endpass%&.
28745
28746 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
28747 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
28748 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
28749 configuration.
28750
28751 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
28752 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
28753 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
28754 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
28755 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
28756 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
28757 .display
28758 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
28759 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
28760 .endd
28761 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
28762 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
28763 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
28764
28765 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
28766 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
28767 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
28768 of &%endpass%&.
28769
28770
28771 .next
28772 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
28773 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
28774 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
28775 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
28776 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
28777 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
28778 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
28779
28780
28781 .next
28782 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
28783 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
28784 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
28785 example,
28786 .code
28787 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28788 .endd
28789 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
28790
28791
28792 .next
28793 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
28794 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
28795 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
28796 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
28797 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
28798 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
28799 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
28800 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
28801 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
28802
28803 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
28804 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
28805 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
28806
28807
28808 .next
28809 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
28810 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
28811 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
28812 .code
28813 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
28814 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
28815 .endd
28816 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
28817 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
28818
28819 .next
28820 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
28821 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
28822 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
28823 example, when checking a RCPT command,
28824 .code
28825 require message = Sender did not verify
28826 verify = sender
28827 .endd
28828 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
28829 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
28830 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
28831 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
28832
28833 .next
28834 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28835 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
28836 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
28837 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
28838 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
28839 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
28840 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
28841
28842 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
28843 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
28844 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
28845 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
28846 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28847
28848 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
28849 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
28850 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
28851 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
28852 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
28853 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
28854 onwards.
28855
28856
28857 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28858 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
28859 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
28860 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
28861 .code
28862 warn !verify = sender
28863 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
28864 .endd
28865 .endlist
28866
28867 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
28868
28869 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
28870 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
28871 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
28872 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
28873 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
28874
28875
28876
28877 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
28878 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
28879 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
28880 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
28881 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
28882 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
28883 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
28884 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
28885 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
28886 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
28887 .ilist
28888 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
28889 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
28890 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
28891 on the same SMTP connection.
28892 .next
28893 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
28894 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
28895 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
28896 .endlist
28897
28898 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
28899 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
28900 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
28901 .code
28902 accept hosts = whatever
28903 set acl_m4 = some value
28904 accept authenticated = *
28905 set acl_c_auth = yes
28906 .endd
28907 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
28908 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
28909 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
28910
28911 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
28912 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
28913 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
28914 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
28915 error is generated.
28916
28917 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
28918 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
28919
28920
28921 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
28922 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
28923 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
28924 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
28925 .code
28926 deny domains = *.dom.example
28927 !verify = recipient
28928 .endd
28929 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
28930 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
28931 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
28932 two statements are equivalent:
28933 .code
28934 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
28935 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
28936 .endd
28937 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
28938 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
28939
28940 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
28941 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
28942 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
28943 .code
28944 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28945 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
28946 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28947 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
28948 .endd
28949 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
28950 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
28951 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
28952 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
28953 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
28954 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
28955 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
28956
28957 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
28958 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
28959 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
28960 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
28961 message is handled.
28962
28963 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
28964 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
28965 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
28966 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
28967 .code
28968 require message = Can't verify sender
28969 verify = sender
28970 message = Can't verify recipient
28971 verify = recipient
28972 message = This message cannot be used
28973 .endd
28974 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
28975 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
28976 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
28977 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
28978 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
28979 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
28980
28981 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
28982 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
28983 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
28984 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
28985 .code
28986 deny hosts = ...
28987 !senders = *@my.domain.example
28988 message = Invalid sender from client host
28989 .endd
28990 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
28991 by which time Exim has set up the message.
28992
28993
28994
28995 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
28996 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
28997 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
28998
28999 .vlist
29000 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29001 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
29002 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
29003 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29004
29005 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29006 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
29007 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
29008 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
29009 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
29010 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
29011 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
29012 write rather ugly lines like this:
29013 .display
29014 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
29015 .endd
29016 Instead, all you need is
29017 .display
29018 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
29019 .endd
29020
29021 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29022 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29023 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
29024 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
29025 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
29026 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
29027 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
29028 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
29029
29030 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
29031 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
29032 in several different ways. For example:
29033
29034 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
29035 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
29036 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
29037 . ==== way.
29038
29039 .ilist
29040 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
29041 .code
29042 accept ...some conditions
29043 control = queue_only
29044 .endd
29045 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
29046 other words, when the conditions are all true.
29047
29048 .next
29049 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
29050 .code
29051 accept ...some conditions...
29052 control = queue_only
29053 ...some more conditions...
29054 .endd
29055 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
29056 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
29057 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
29058 to be relevant.
29059
29060 .next
29061 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
29062 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
29063 example:
29064 .code
29065 warn ...some conditions...
29066 control = freeze
29067 accept ...
29068 .endd
29069 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
29070 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
29071 log entry.
29072
29073 .next
29074 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
29075 &%require%& verb. For example:
29076 .code
29077 require control = no_multiline_responses
29078 .endd
29079 .endlist
29080
29081 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
29082 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
29083 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
29084 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
29085 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
29086 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
29087 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
29088 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
29089 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
29090
29091 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
29092 example:
29093 .code
29094 deny ...some conditions...
29095 delay = 30s
29096 .endd
29097 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
29098 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
29099 .code
29100 deny delay = 30s
29101 ...some conditions...
29102 .endd
29103 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
29104 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
29105 .code
29106 warn ...some conditions...
29107 delay = 2m
29108 control = freeze
29109 accept ...
29110 .endd
29111
29112 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
29113 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
29114 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
29115 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
29116 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
29117 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
29118 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
29119
29120
29121 .vitem &*endpass*&
29122 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
29123 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
29124 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
29125 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
29126 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
29127 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
29128 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
29129
29130
29131 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29132 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
29133 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
29134 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
29135 .code
29136 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
29137 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
29138 .endd
29139 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
29140 example:
29141 .display
29142 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
29143 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
29144 .endd
29145 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
29146 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
29147 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
29148 message.
29149
29150 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
29151 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
29152 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
29153 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
29154 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
29155 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
29156 ignored.
29157
29158 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29159 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
29160 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
29161 error message.
29162
29163 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
29164 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
29165 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
29166 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
29167 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
29168 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
29169
29170 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
29171 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
29172 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
29173 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
29174 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
29175 logging rejections.
29176
29177
29178 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
29179 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
29180 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
29181 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
29182 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
29183 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
29184 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
29185 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
29186 .display
29187 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
29188 &` log_reject_target =`&
29189 .endd
29190 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
29191 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
29192 current ACL.
29193
29194
29195 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29196 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
29197 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
29198 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
29199 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
29200 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
29201 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
29202 ACLs. For example:
29203 .display
29204 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
29205 &` control = freeze`&
29206 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
29207 .endd
29208 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
29209 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
29210 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
29211 example:
29212 .code
29213 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
29214 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
29215 .endd
29216
29217
29218 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29219 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
29220 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
29221 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
29222 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
29223 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
29224 &%accept%& for details.)
29225
29226 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
29227 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
29228 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
29229 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
29230 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
29231 .code
29232 require message = Host not recognized
29233 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
29234 .endd
29235 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
29236 processed.)
29237
29238 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
29239 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
29240 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
29241 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
29242 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
29243 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
29244 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
29245 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
29246 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
29247 EHLO options.
29248
29249 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
29250 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
29251 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
29252 .code
29253 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
29254 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
29255 .endd
29256 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
29257 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
29258 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
29259 2&'xx'&.
29260
29261 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
29262 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
29263
29264 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
29265 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
29266 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
29267 response.
29268
29269 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29270 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
29271 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
29272
29273 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
29274 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
29275 However, the original message is available in the variable
29276 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
29277 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
29278 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
29279 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
29280
29281 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
29282 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
29283 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
29284 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
29285 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
29286 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
29287 effect.
29288
29289
29290 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29291 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
29292 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
29293 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
29294 for the message.
29295 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
29296 the DATA ACL).
29297 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
29298 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
29299 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
29300 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
29301
29302
29303 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29304 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
29305 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
29306 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
29307
29308
29309 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
29310 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
29311 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
29312 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
29313
29314
29315 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
29316 .cindex "UDP communications"
29317 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
29318 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
29319 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
29320 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
29321 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
29322 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
29323 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
29324 when:
29325 .code
29326 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
29327 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
29328 .endd
29329 .endlist
29330
29331
29332
29333
29334 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
29335 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29336 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
29337
29338 .vlist
29339 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
29340 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
29341 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
29342 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
29343 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
29344 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
29345 not work without it. For example:
29346 .code
29347 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
29348 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
29349 .endd
29350 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
29351 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
29352 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
29353 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
29354 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
29355
29356
29357 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
29358 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
29359 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
29360 .cindex "case of local parts"
29361 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29362 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
29363 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
29364 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
29365 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
29366 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
29367 is encountered.
29368
29369 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
29370 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
29371 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
29372 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
29373 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
29374
29375 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
29376 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
29377 spam score:
29378 .code
29379 warn control = caseful_local_part
29380 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
29381 $acl_m4 + \
29382 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
29383 }
29384 control = caselower_local_part
29385 .endd
29386 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
29387 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
29388
29389
29390 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
29391 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
29392 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
29393 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
29394
29395 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
29396 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
29397 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
29398 is used for all recipients of the message,
29399 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
29400 and data is copied from one to the other.
29401
29402 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
29403 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
29404 If a recipient-verify callout
29405 (with use_sender)
29406 connection is subsequently
29407 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
29408 any subsequent recipients and the data,
29409 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
29410
29411 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
29412 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
29413 Note also that headers cannot be
29414 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
29415 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
29416 The Received-By: header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
29417 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
29418 this will affect the timestamp.
29419
29420 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
29421 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
29422 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
29423 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
29424 message body.
29425
29426 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
29427 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
29428 before the entire message has been received from the source.
29429 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
29430 or CHUNKING
29431 options in use.
29432
29433 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
29434 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
29435 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
29436 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
29437 before the acceptance "<=" line.
29438
29439 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
29440 usual fashion.
29441 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
29442 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
29443 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
29444 and does not queue the message.
29445 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
29446
29447 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
29448 (possibly faked)
29449 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
29450
29451
29452 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
29453 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
29454 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
29455 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
29456 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
29457 by default called &'debuglog'&.
29458 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
29459 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
29460 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
29461 option.
29462 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
29463 with the &'kill'& option.
29464 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
29465 contexts):
29466 .code
29467 control = debug
29468 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
29469 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
29470 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
29471 control = debug/kill
29472 .endd
29473
29474
29475 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
29476 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
29477 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
29478 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
29479 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29480
29481
29482 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
29483 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
29484 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
29485 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
29486 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
29487 strings or to numeric value.
29488 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
29489 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
29490 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
29491
29492 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
29493 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
29494 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
29495 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
29496 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
29497
29498
29499 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
29500 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
29501 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
29502 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
29503 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
29504 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
29505 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
29506 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
29507
29508 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
29509 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
29510 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
29511 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
29512 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
29513 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
29514 work with.
29515
29516
29517 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
29518 .cindex "fake defer"
29519 .cindex "defer, fake"
29520 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
29521 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
29522 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
29523 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
29524 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
29525
29526 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
29527 .cindex "fake rejection"
29528 .cindex "rejection, fake"
29529 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
29530 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
29531 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
29532 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
29533 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29534 the same SMTP connection.
29535
29536 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
29537 message is supplied, the following is used:
29538 .code
29539 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
29540 550-kept for evaluation.
29541 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
29542 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
29543 .endd
29544 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
29545
29546 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
29547 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
29548 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29549 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29550 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
29551 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
29552 SMTP connection.
29553
29554 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
29555 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
29556 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
29557 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
29558
29559 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
29560 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
29561 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
29562 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29563 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
29564 disables such output flushing.
29565
29566 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
29567 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29568 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
29569 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29570 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
29571 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
29572
29573 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
29574 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
29575 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
29576 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
29577 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
29578 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
29579 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29580 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
29581 to be useful in production.
29582
29583 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
29584 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
29585 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
29586 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
29587 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
29588
29589 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
29590 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
29591 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
29592 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
29593 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
29594 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
29595
29596 .ilist
29597 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
29598 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
29599 verification failed"&) is sent.
29600 .next
29601 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
29602 line is output.
29603 .endlist
29604
29605 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
29606 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
29607
29608 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
29609 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
29610 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
29611 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
29612 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
29613 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
29614 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
29615
29616 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
29617 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
29618 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
29619 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29620 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29621 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
29622 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
29623 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
29624 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
29625 same SMTP connection.
29626
29627 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
29628 .cindex "message" "submission"
29629 .cindex "submission mode"
29630 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
29631 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
29632 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
29633 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
29634 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
29635 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
29636 late (the message has already been created).
29637
29638 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
29639 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
29640 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
29641 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
29642 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
29643
29644 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
29645 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
29646 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
29647 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
29648 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
29649
29650 .ilist
29651 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
29652 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
29653 .next
29654 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
29655 .next
29656 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
29657 .endlist ilist
29658
29659 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
29660 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
29661 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29662 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
29663 data is read.
29664
29665 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
29666 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
29667
29668 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
29669 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
29670 to a-label form.
29671 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
29672 .endlist vlist
29673
29674
29675 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
29676 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
29677
29678 .ilist
29679 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
29680 .next
29681 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
29682 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
29683 .next
29684 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
29685 .next
29686 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
29687 .endlist
29688
29689
29690
29691 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
29692 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
29693 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
29694 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
29695 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
29696 to an incoming message, as in this example:
29697 .code
29698 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29699 dialup.mail-abuse.org
29700 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
29701 .endd
29702 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29703 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29704 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29705 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
29706 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
29707 RCPT ACL).
29708
29709 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
29710 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29711
29712 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
29713 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
29714 contains one or more newlines that
29715 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
29716 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
29717 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
29718
29719 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29720 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29721 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
29722 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
29723 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
29724 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
29725 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
29726 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
29727 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
29728 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
29729 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
29730
29731 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
29732 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
29733 of message headers
29734 until they are added to the
29735 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
29736 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
29737 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
29738 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
29739 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
29740 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
29741 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29742
29743 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
29744
29745 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29746 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29747 .display
29748 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29749 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29750
29751 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29752 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29753 .endd
29754 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
29755 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
29756 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
29757 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
29758 honoured.
29759
29760 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29761 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
29762 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
29763 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
29764 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
29765 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
29766 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
29767 specifications.
29768
29769 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
29770 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
29771 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
29772 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
29773 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
29774
29775 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
29776 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
29777 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
29778 to be a header name first.) For example:
29779 .code
29780 warn add_header = \
29781 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
29782 .endd
29783 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
29784 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
29785 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
29786 up in reverse order.
29787
29788 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29789 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
29790 system filter or in a router or transport.
29791
29792
29793
29794 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
29795 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
29796 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
29797 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
29798 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
29799 from an incoming message, as in this example:
29800 .code
29801 warn message = Remove internal headers
29802 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29803 .endd
29804 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29805 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29806 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29807 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
29808 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
29809 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
29810
29811 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
29812 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29813
29814 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
29815 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
29816 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
29817 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
29818 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
29819 .code
29820 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
29821 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29822 warn message = Remove internal headers
29823 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
29824 .endd
29825 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29826 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29827 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
29828 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
29829 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
29830 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
29831 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
29832 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
29833 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
29834 would have been removed.
29835
29836 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
29837 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
29838 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
29839 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
29840 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
29841 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
29842 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
29843 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
29844 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29845
29846 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29847 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29848 .display
29849 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
29850 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29851
29852 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29853 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
29854 .endd
29855 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
29856 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
29857 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
29858 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
29859 are honoured.
29860
29861 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29862 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
29863 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
29864
29865
29866
29867
29868 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
29869 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
29870 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
29871 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
29872 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
29873 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29874
29875 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
29876 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
29877 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
29878 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
29879 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
29880 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
29881 The conditions are as follows:
29882
29883
29884 .vlist
29885 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
29886 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
29887 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
29888 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
29889 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
29890 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
29891 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
29892 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
29893 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
29894 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
29895 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
29896 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
29897
29898 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
29899 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
29900 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
29901 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
29902 The name and values are expanded separately.
29903 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
29904 will act as argument separators.
29905
29906 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
29907 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
29908 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
29909 conditions are tested.
29910
29911 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
29912 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
29913 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
29914 for different local users or different local domains.
29915
29916 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29917 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
29918 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
29919 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
29920 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
29921 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
29922 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
29923 .code
29924 authenticated = *
29925 .endd
29926
29927 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
29928 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
29929 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
29930 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
29931 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
29932 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
29933 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
29934 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
29935 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
29936 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
29937 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
29938 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
29939 negative.
29940
29941 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
29942 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
29943 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29944 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29945 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
29946 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
29947 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
29948 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29949
29950 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
29951 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
29952 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29953 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29954 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29955 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
29956 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
29957 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
29958 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
29959 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
29960
29961 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29962 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
29963 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
29964 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
29965 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
29966 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
29967 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
29968 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
29969 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
29970 &%domains%& test.
29971
29972 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
29973 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
29974
29975
29976 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29977 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
29978 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
29979 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
29980 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
29981 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
29982 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
29983 .code
29984 encrypted = *
29985 .endd
29986
29987
29988 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
29989 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
29990 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
29991 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
29992 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
29993 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
29994 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
29995 .code
29996 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29997 .endd
29998 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
29999 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
30000 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
30001
30002 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
30003 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
30004 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
30005 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
30006 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
30007 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
30008
30009 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
30010 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
30011 .code
30012 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30013 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
30014 .endd
30015 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
30016 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
30017 statement can then check the IP address.
30018
30019 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
30020 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
30021 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
30022 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
30023 .code
30024 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
30025 message = $host_data
30026 .endd
30027 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
30028
30029 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
30030 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
30031 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
30032 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
30033 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
30034 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
30035 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
30036 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
30037 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
30038 the next &%local_parts%& test.
30039
30040 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
30041 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
30042 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
30043 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
30044 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30045 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
30046 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30047
30048 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30049 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
30050 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30051 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30052 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30053 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
30054 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
30055 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30056
30057 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
30058 .cindex "rate limiting"
30059 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
30060 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
30061
30062 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30063 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
30064 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
30065 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
30066 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
30067 recipient address against a list of recipients.
30068
30069 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30070 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
30071 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30072 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30073 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
30074 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
30075 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30076
30077 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30078 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
30079 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30080 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
30081 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30082 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
30083 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
30084 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
30085 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
30086 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
30087 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
30088 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
30089 influence the sender checking.
30090
30091 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30092 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30093
30094 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30095 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
30096 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30097 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
30098 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
30099 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
30100 .code
30101 senders = :
30102 .endd
30103 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30104 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30105
30106 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
30107 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
30108 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
30109 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30110 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
30111 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30112
30113 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
30114 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30115 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
30116 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
30117 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
30118 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
30119 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
30120 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
30121 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
30122 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
30123
30124 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
30125 .cindex "CSA verification"
30126 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
30127 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
30128 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
30129
30130 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
30131 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30132 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30133 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30134 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
30135 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30136 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30137 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
30138 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
30139 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
30140
30141 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
30142 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
30143 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
30144
30145 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
30146 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30147 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
30148 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
30149 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
30150 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
30151 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30152 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30153 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
30154 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
30155 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
30156 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
30157 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
30158 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
30159 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
30160
30161 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
30162 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
30163 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
30164 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
30165 .code
30166 deny senders = :
30167 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
30168 !verify = header_sender
30169 .endd
30170
30171 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
30172 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30173 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
30174 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
30175 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
30176 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30177 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30178 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
30179 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
30180 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
30181 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
30182 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
30183 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
30184 appropriate.
30185
30186 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
30187 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
30188 .code
30189 To: @
30190 .endd
30191 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
30192 common as they used to be.
30193
30194 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
30195 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30196 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
30197 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
30198 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
30199 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
30200 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
30201 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
30202 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
30203 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
30204 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
30205 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
30206 independently of this condition.
30207
30208 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
30209 option), this condition is always true.
30210
30211
30212 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
30213 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
30214 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
30215 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
30216 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
30217 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
30218 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
30219 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
30220 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
30221
30222 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
30223 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
30224
30225
30226 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
30227 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30228 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
30229 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
30230 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
30231 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30232 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
30233 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
30234 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
30235 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
30236 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
30237 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
30238 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
30239 value for the child address.
30240
30241 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
30242 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30243 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
30244 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
30245 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
30246 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
30247 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
30248 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
30249 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
30250 original IP address.
30251
30252 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
30253 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
30254
30255 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
30256 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
30257
30258 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
30259 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30260 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
30261 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
30262 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
30263 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
30264 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
30265 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
30266 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
30267
30268 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30269 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
30270 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
30271 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
30272 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
30273 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
30274 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
30275
30276 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
30277 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
30278 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
30279
30280 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
30281 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30282 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
30283 verified as a sender.
30284
30285 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
30286 (eg. is generated from the received message)
30287 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
30288 .code
30289 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
30290 .endd
30291 .endlist
30292
30293
30294
30295 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
30296 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30297 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30298 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30299 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
30300 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
30301 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
30302 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
30303 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
30304 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
30305 .code
30306 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
30307 dialups.mail-abuse.org
30308 .endd
30309 the following records are looked up:
30310 .code
30311 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30312 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
30313 .endd
30314 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
30315 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
30316 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
30317 use two separate conditions:
30318 .code
30319 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30320 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30321 .endd
30322 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
30323 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
30324 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
30325 processed.
30326
30327 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
30328 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
30329 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
30330 following special items in the list:
30331 .display
30332 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
30333 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
30334 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
30335 .endd
30336 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
30337 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
30338 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
30339 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
30340 .code
30341 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
30342 .endd
30343 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
30344 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
30345 .code
30346 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30347 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
30348 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30349 .endd
30350 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
30351 .cindex DNS TTL
30352 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
30353 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
30354 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
30355 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
30356 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
30357 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
30358
30359
30360
30361 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
30362 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
30363 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
30364 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
30365 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
30366 .code
30367 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
30368 .endd
30369 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
30370 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
30371 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
30372 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
30373
30374
30375
30376
30377 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
30378 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
30379 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
30380 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
30381 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
30382 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
30383 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
30384 .code
30385 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
30386 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30387 .endd
30388 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
30389 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
30390 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
30391 up by this example is
30392 .code
30393 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
30394 .endd
30395 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
30396 addresses. For example:
30397 .code
30398 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30399 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30400 .endd
30401 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
30402 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
30403
30404
30405
30406
30407 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
30408 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
30409 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
30410 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
30411 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
30412 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
30413 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
30414 either to double the separators like this:
30415 .code
30416 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
30417 .endd
30418 or to change the separator character, like this:
30419 .code
30420 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
30421 .endd
30422 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
30423 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
30424 occurs. Consider this condition:
30425 .code
30426 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
30427 .endd
30428 The DNS lookups that occur are:
30429 .code
30430 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
30431 a.domain.black.list.tld
30432 .endd
30433 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
30434 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
30435 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
30436 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
30437 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
30438 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
30439 error for a previous item.
30440
30441 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
30442 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
30443 .code
30444 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
30445 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
30446 .endd
30447 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
30448 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
30449 .code
30450 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
30451 $sender_address_domain \
30452 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
30453 see $dnslist_text.
30454 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
30455 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
30456 $sender_address_domain} }} }
30457 .endd
30458 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
30459 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
30460 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
30461 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
30462 .code
30463 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
30464 .endd
30465 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
30466 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
30467
30468 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
30469 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
30470
30471
30472
30473
30474 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
30475 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
30476 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
30477 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
30478 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
30479 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
30480 .display
30481 127.1.0.1 RBL
30482 127.1.0.2 DUL
30483 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
30484 127.1.0.4 RSS
30485 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
30486 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
30487 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
30488 .endd
30489 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
30490 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
30491 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
30492
30493
30494 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
30495 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
30496 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
30497 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
30498 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
30499 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
30500 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
30501 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
30502 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
30503 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
30504 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
30505 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
30506 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
30507 cases, for example:
30508 .code
30509 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
30510 .endd
30511 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
30512 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
30513 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
30514 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
30515 .code
30516 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
30517 .endd
30518 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
30519 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
30520
30521 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
30522 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
30523 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
30524 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
30525 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
30526 information.
30527
30528 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
30529 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
30530 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
30531 .code
30532 deny hosts = !+local_networks
30533 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
30534 at $dnslist_domain
30535 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
30536 .endd
30537
30538
30539
30540 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
30541 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
30542 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
30543 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
30544 For example,
30545 .code
30546 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
30547 .endd
30548 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
30549 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
30550 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
30551 describes how multiple records are handled.
30552
30553 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
30554 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
30555 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
30556 .code
30557 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30558 .endd
30559 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
30560 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
30561 first. For example:
30562 .code
30563 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
30564 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
30565 .endd
30566
30567 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
30568 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
30569 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
30570 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
30571 tested. For example:
30572 .code
30573 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
30574 .endd
30575 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
30576 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
30577 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
30578 .code
30579 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30580 .endd
30581 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
30582 an odd number.
30583
30584
30585
30586 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
30587 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
30588 condition. Whereas
30589 .code
30590 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30591 .endd
30592 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30593 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
30594 .code
30595 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30596 .endd
30597 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30598 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
30599 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
30600 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
30601
30602 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
30603 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
30604
30605 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
30606 previous example is precisely equivalent to
30607 .code
30608 deny dnslists = a.b.c
30609 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30610 .endd
30611 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
30612 Consider this example:
30613 .code
30614 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30615 list.dsbl.org : \
30616 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
30617 relays.ordb.org
30618 .endd
30619 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
30620 .code
30621 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30622 list.dsbl.org
30623 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
30624 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
30625 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
30626 .endd
30627 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
30628
30629
30630
30631
30632 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
30633 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
30634 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
30635 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
30636 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
30637 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
30638 .code
30639 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
30640 .endd
30641 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
30642 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
30643 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
30644 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
30645 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
30646 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
30647
30648 .ilist
30649 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
30650 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
30651 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30652 .next
30653 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
30654 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
30655 changed to:
30656 .code
30657 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
30658 .endd
30659 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30660 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
30661 .code
30662 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
30663 .endd
30664 for the condition to be true.
30665 .endlist
30666
30667 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
30668 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
30669 .ilist
30670 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
30671 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
30672 .code
30673 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
30674 .endd
30675 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30676 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30677 .next
30678 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
30679 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
30680 .code
30681 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
30682 .endd
30683 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30684 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
30685 .code
30686 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30687 .endd
30688 for the condition to be false.
30689 .endlist
30690 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
30691 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
30692
30693
30694
30695
30696 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
30697 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
30698 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
30699 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
30700 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
30701 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
30702 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
30703 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
30704 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
30705 lists.
30706
30707 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
30708 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
30709 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
30710 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
30711 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
30712 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
30713 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
30714 .code
30715 reject message = \
30716 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
30717 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
30718 dnslists = \
30719 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
30720 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30721 .endd
30722 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
30723 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
30724 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
30725 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
30726 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
30727 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
30728
30729 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
30730 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
30731 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
30732 .code
30733 reject dnslists = \
30734 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
30735 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
30736 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
30737 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30738 .endd
30739 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
30740 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
30741 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
30742
30743
30744
30745 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
30746 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
30747 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
30748 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
30749 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
30750 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
30751 .code
30752 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
30753 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30754 .endd
30755 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
30756 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
30757 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
30758 .code
30759 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
30760 .endd
30761 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
30762 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
30763
30764 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
30765 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
30766 .code
30767 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
30768 dnslists = some.list.example
30769 .endd
30770
30771 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
30772 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
30773 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
30774 .code
30775 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
30776 .endd
30777
30778 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
30779 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
30780 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
30781 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
30782 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
30783 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
30784 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
30785 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
30786 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
30787 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
30788 .display
30789 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
30790 .endd
30791 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
30792 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
30793
30794 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
30795 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
30796 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
30797 of &'p'&.
30798
30799 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
30800 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
30801 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
30802 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
30803 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
30804 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
30805 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
30806 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
30807 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
30808
30809 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
30810 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
30811 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
30812 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
30813
30814 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
30815 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
30816 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
30817 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
30818 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
30819 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
30820 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
30821 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
30822 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
30823 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
30824
30825 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
30826 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
30827 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
30828 ACL.
30829
30830 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
30831 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
30832 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
30833 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
30834 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
30835 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
30836
30837 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
30838 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
30839 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
30840 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
30841 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
30842 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
30843 the &%count=%& option.
30844
30845
30846 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
30847 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
30848 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
30849 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
30850 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
30851
30852 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
30853 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
30854 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
30855 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
30856
30857 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
30858 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
30859 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
30860 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
30861 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
30862 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
30863 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
30864
30865 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
30866 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30867 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
30868 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
30869 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
30870 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
30871 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
30872
30873 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
30874 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
30875 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
30876 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
30877 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
30878
30879 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
30880 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
30881 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
30882 multiple different commands.
30883
30884 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
30885 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
30886 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
30887 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
30888 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
30889
30890 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
30891
30892
30893 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
30894 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
30895 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
30896 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
30897 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
30898
30899 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
30900 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
30901
30902 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
30903 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
30904 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
30905 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
30906 new rate.
30907 .code
30908 acl_check_connect:
30909 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
30910 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30911 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30912 # ...
30913 acl_check_mail:
30914 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
30915 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30916 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30917 .endd
30918
30919 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
30920 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
30921 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
30922 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
30923 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
30924 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
30925 checks.
30926
30927 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
30928 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
30929 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
30930 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
30931 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
30932
30933
30934 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
30935 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
30936 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
30937 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
30938 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
30939 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
30940 rest of the ACL.
30941
30942 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
30943 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
30944 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
30945 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
30946 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
30947 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
30948 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
30949 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
30950 from getting any email through.
30951
30952 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
30953 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
30954 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
30955 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
30956 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
30957 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
30958 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
30959 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
30960 .code
30961 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
30962 .endd
30963
30964
30965 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
30966 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
30967 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
30968 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
30969 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
30970 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
30971 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
30972 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
30973 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
30974
30975 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
30976 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
30977 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
30978 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
30979 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
30980 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
30981
30982 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
30983 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
30984 rate.
30985
30986 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
30987 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
30988 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
30989 required increases with larger limits.
30990
30991 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
30992 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
30993 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
30994 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
30995 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
30996 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
30997 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
30998 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
30999 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
31000 as intended.
31001
31002
31003 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
31004 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
31005 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
31006 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
31007 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
31008 message. For example:
31009 .code
31010 # Log all senders' rates
31011 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
31012 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
31013
31014 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
31015 # at the decimal point.
31016 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
31017 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
31018 $sender_rate_limit }s
31019
31020 # Keep authenticated users under control
31021 deny authenticated = *
31022 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
31023
31024 # System-wide rate limit
31025 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
31026 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
31027
31028 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
31029 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
31030 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
31031 messages per $sender_rate_period
31032 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
31033 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
31034 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
31035 .endd
31036 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
31037 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
31038 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
31039 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
31040 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
31041 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
31042 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
31043
31044
31045
31046 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
31047 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
31048 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
31049 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
31050 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
31051 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
31052 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
31053 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
31054 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
31055 .code
31056 verify = sender/callout
31057 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
31058 .endd
31059 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
31060 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
31061 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
31062 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
31063 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
31064 The available options are as follows:
31065
31066 .ilist
31067 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
31068 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
31069 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
31070 .next
31071 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
31072 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
31073 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
31074 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
31075 .next
31076 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
31077 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
31078 .next
31079 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
31080 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
31081 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
31082 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
31083 .endlist
31084
31085 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
31086 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
31087 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
31088 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31089 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
31090 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
31091 coding like this:
31092 .code
31093 warn !verify = sender
31094 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
31095 .endd
31096 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
31097 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
31098 verification failure.
31099
31100 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
31101 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
31102
31103 .ilist
31104 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
31105 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
31106 .next
31107 &%route%&: Routing failed.
31108 .next
31109 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
31110 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
31111 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
31112 .next
31113 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
31114 .next
31115 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
31116 .endlist
31117
31118 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
31119 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
31120
31121
31122
31123
31124 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
31125 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
31126 .cindex "callout" "verification"
31127 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
31128 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
31129 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
31130 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
31131 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
31132 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
31133 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
31134 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
31135 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
31136 sender's domain.
31137
31138 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
31139 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
31140 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
31141 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
31142 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
31143 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
31144
31145 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
31146 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
31147 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
31148 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
31149 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
31150
31151 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
31152 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
31153 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
31154 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
31155 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
31156 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
31157 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
31158 supplies a host list.
31159 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
31160
31161 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
31162 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
31163 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
31164 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
31165 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
31166 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
31167 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
31168
31169 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
31170 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
31171 following SMTP commands are sent:
31172 .display
31173 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
31174 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
31175 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
31176 &`QUIT`&
31177 .endd
31178 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
31179 set to &"lmtp"&.
31180
31181 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
31182 settings.
31183
31184 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
31185 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
31186 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
31187 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
31188 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
31189 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
31190
31191 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
31192 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
31193 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
31194 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
31195 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
31196
31197 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
31198 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
31199 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
31200 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
31201 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
31202
31203
31204
31205
31206 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
31207 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
31208 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
31209 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
31210 .code
31211 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
31212 .endd
31213 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
31214 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
31215 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
31216
31217
31218 .vlist
31219 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
31220 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
31221 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
31222 For example:
31223 .code
31224 verify = sender/callout=5s
31225 .endd
31226 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
31227 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
31228 the &%connect%& parameter.
31229
31230
31231 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31232 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
31233 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
31234 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
31235 .code
31236 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
31237 .endd
31238 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
31239
31240 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
31241 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
31242 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
31243 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
31244 updated in this circumstance.
31245
31246 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
31247 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
31248 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
31249 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
31250 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
31251 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
31252
31253
31254 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31255 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
31256 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
31257 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
31258 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
31259 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
31260 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
31261 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
31262 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
31263 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
31264 .code
31265 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
31266 .endd
31267 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
31268
31269
31270 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31271 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
31272 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
31273 For example:
31274 .code
31275 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
31276 .endd
31277 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
31278 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
31279 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
31280 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
31281 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
31282
31283
31284 .vitem &*no_cache*&
31285 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
31286 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
31287 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
31288
31289 .vitem &*postmaster*&
31290 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
31291 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
31292 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
31293 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
31294 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
31295 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
31296 made, until the cache record expires.
31297
31298 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31299 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
31300 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
31301 For example:
31302 .code
31303 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
31304 .endd
31305 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
31306 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
31307 .code
31308 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
31309 .endd
31310 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
31311 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
31312 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
31313 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
31314
31315
31316 .vitem &*random*&
31317 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
31318 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
31319 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
31320 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
31321 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
31322 .code
31323 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
31324 .endd
31325 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
31326 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
31327 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
31328 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
31329 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
31330
31331 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
31332 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
31333 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31334 .code
31335 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
31336 .endd
31337 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31338 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
31339 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
31340 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
31341 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
31342
31343 .vitem &*use_sender*&
31344 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31345 .code
31346 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
31347 .endd
31348 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
31349 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
31350 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
31351 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
31352 usefulness of callout caching.
31353
31354 .vitem &*hold*&
31355 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31356 .code
31357 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
31358 .endd
31359 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
31360 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
31361 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
31362 when that is used for the connections.
31363 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
31364 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
31365 if the use_sender option is used,
31366 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
31367 and if no other callouts intervene.
31368 .endlist
31369
31370 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
31371 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
31372 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
31373 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
31374 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
31375 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
31376 these circumstances.
31377
31378 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
31379 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
31380 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
31381 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
31382 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
31383 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
31384 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
31385
31386 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
31387 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
31388 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
31389 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
31390
31391
31392
31393
31394 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
31395 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
31396 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
31397 .cindex "caching" "callout"
31398 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
31399 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
31400 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
31401 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
31402 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
31403 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
31404
31405 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
31406 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
31407 is not available.
31408
31409 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
31410 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
31411 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
31412
31413 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
31414 commands up to and including
31415 .code
31416 MAIL FROM:<>
31417 .endd
31418 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
31419 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
31420 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
31421 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
31422 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
31423 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
31424 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
31425
31426 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
31427 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
31428 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
31429 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
31430 will eventually be noticed.
31431
31432 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
31433 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
31434 behaviour will be the same.
31435
31436
31437
31438 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
31439 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
31440 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
31441 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
31442 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
31443 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
31444 you might see:
31445 .code
31446 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
31447 250 OK
31448 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
31449 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
31450 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
31451 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
31452 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
31453 550 Sender verification failed
31454 .endd
31455 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
31456 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
31457 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
31458 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
31459 example:
31460 .code
31461 verify = sender/no_details
31462 .endd
31463
31464 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
31465 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
31466 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
31467 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
31468 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
31469 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
31470 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
31471
31472 .ilist
31473 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
31474 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
31475 verification also fails.
31476 .next
31477 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
31478 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
31479 .endlist
31480
31481 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
31482 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
31483 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
31484 .code
31485 A.Wol: aw123
31486 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
31487 .endd
31488 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
31489 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
31490 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
31491 verification to succeed.
31492
31493 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
31494 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
31495 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
31496 option. For example:
31497 .code
31498 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
31499 .endd
31500 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
31501 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
31502
31503 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
31504 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
31505 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
31506 address and a report is output for each of them.
31507
31508
31509
31510 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
31511 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
31512 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
31513 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
31514 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
31515 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
31516 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
31517 .code
31518 verify = csa
31519 .endd
31520 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
31521 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
31522 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
31523 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
31524 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
31525 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
31526
31527 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
31528 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
31529 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
31530 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
31531
31532 .ilist
31533 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
31534 .next
31535 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
31536 .next
31537 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
31538 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
31539 .next
31540 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
31541 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
31542 .endlist
31543
31544 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
31545 use for the DNS query. The default is:
31546 .code
31547 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
31548 .endd
31549 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
31550 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
31551 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
31552 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
31553 meaningful to say:
31554 .code
31555 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
31556 .endd
31557 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
31558 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
31559 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
31560
31561 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
31562 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
31563 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
31564 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
31565 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
31566 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
31567 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
31568 of legitimate HELO domains.
31569
31570 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
31571 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
31572 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
31573 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
31574 lookup such as:
31575 .code
31576 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
31577 .endd
31578 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
31579 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
31580 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
31581
31582
31583
31584
31585 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
31586 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
31587 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
31588 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
31589 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
31590 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
31591 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
31592 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
31593
31594 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
31595 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
31596 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
31597 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
31598 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
31599 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
31600 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
31601 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
31602
31603 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
31604 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
31605 like this:
31606 .code
31607 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
31608 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
31609 }{$value}}
31610 .endd
31611 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
31612 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
31613 use this:
31614 .code
31615 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
31616 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
31617 senders = :
31618 recipients = +batv_senders
31619
31620 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
31621 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
31622 senders = :
31623 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
31624 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
31625 !condition = $prvscheck_result
31626 .endd
31627 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
31628 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
31629 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
31630 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
31631 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
31632
31633 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
31634 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
31635 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
31636 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
31637 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
31638 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
31639 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
31640
31641 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
31642 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
31643 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
31644 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
31645 .code
31646 batv_redirect:
31647 driver = redirect
31648 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
31649 .endd
31650 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
31651 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
31652 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
31653 local addresses.
31654
31655 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
31656 can be used:
31657 .code
31658 external_smtp_batv:
31659 driver = smtp
31660 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
31661 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
31662 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
31663 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
31664 {$value}fail}}}
31665 .endd
31666 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
31667
31668
31669
31670 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
31671 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
31672 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
31673 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
31674 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
31675 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
31676 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
31677 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
31678 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
31679 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
31680
31681 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
31682 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
31683 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
31684 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
31685 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
31686 same host is fulfilling both functions,
31687 . ///
31688 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
31689 . ///
31690 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
31691 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
31692 system to arbitrary domains.
31693
31694
31695 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
31696 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
31697 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
31698 example, suppose you want to do the following:
31699
31700 .ilist
31701 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
31702 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
31703 &'my.dom2.example'&.
31704 .next
31705 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
31706 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
31707 .next
31708 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
31709 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
31710 .endlist
31711
31712
31713 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
31714 .code
31715 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
31716 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
31717 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
31718 .endd
31719 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
31720 command:
31721 .code
31722 acl_check_rcpt:
31723 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
31724 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
31725 .endd
31726 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
31727 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
31728 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
31729 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
31730 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
31731 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
31732 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
31733
31734
31735
31736 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
31737 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
31738 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
31739 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
31740 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
31741 .ecindex IIDacl
31742
31743
31744
31745 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31746 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31747
31748 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
31749 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
31750 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
31751 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
31752 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
31753 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
31754 specification.
31755
31756 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
31757 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
31758 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
31759 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
31760 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
31761
31762 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
31763 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
31764 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
31765
31766 .ilist
31767 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
31768 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
31769 .next
31770 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
31771 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
31772 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
31773 .next
31774 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
31775 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
31776 .next
31777 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
31778 conditions.
31779 .next
31780 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
31781 .endlist
31782
31783 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
31784 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
31785 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
31786 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
31787 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
31788 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
31789
31790 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
31791 temporarily created in a file called:
31792 .display
31793 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
31794 .endd
31795 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
31796 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
31797 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
31798 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
31799 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
31800 .code
31801 control = no_mbox_unspool
31802 .endd
31803 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
31804 same directory by default.
31805
31806
31807
31808 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
31809 .cindex "virus scanning"
31810 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
31811 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
31812 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
31813 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
31814 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
31815 in memory and thus are much faster.
31816
31817 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
31818 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
31819
31820 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
31821 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
31822 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
31823 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
31824 .display
31825 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
31826 .endd
31827 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
31828 .code
31829 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
31830 .endd
31831 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
31832 before use.
31833 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
31834 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
31835 .new
31836 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
31837 .wen
31838
31839 .vlist
31840 .vitem &%avast%&
31841 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
31842 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
31843 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
31844 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
31845 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
31846 This scanner type takes one option,
31847 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31848 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31849 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31850 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31851 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
31852 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
31853 For example:
31854 .code
31855 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
31856 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
31857 .endd
31858 If you omit the argument, the default path
31859 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
31860 is used.
31861 If you use a remote host,
31862 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
31863 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
31864 For information about available commands and their options you may use
31865 .code
31866 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
31867 FLAGS
31868 SENSITIVITY
31869 PACK
31870 .endd
31871
31872 Only the first virus detected will be reported.
31873
31874
31875 .vitem &%aveserver%&
31876 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31877 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
31878 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
31879 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
31880 example:
31881 .code
31882 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
31883 .endd
31884
31885
31886 .vitem &%clamd%&
31887 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
31888 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
31889 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
31890 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
31891 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
31892
31893 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
31894 a UNIX socket specification,
31895 a TCP socket specification,
31896 or a (global) option.
31897
31898 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
31899 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
31900 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
31901 and the second a port number,
31902 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
31903 These per-server options are supported:
31904 .code
31905 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31906 .endd
31907
31908 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31909 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
31910
31911 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
31912
31913 Examples:
31914 .code
31915 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
31916 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
31917 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
31918 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
31919 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
31920 .endd
31921 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
31922 &`local`&
31923 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
31924 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
31925 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
31926 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
31927
31928 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
31929 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
31930 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
31931 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
31932 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
31933 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
31934 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
31935 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
31936 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
31937 .code
31938 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
31939 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
31940 (Connection refused)
31941 .endd
31942
31943 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
31944 contributing the code for this scanner.
31945
31946 .vitem &%cmdline%&
31947 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
31948 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
31949 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
31950 type takes 3 mandatory options:
31951
31952 .olist
31953 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
31954 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
31955
31956 .next
31957 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
31958 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
31959 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
31960 the &"trigger"& expression.
31961
31962 .next
31963 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
31964 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
31965 &"name"& expression.
31966 .endlist olist
31967
31968 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
31969 .code
31970 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
31971 .endd
31972 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
31973 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
31974 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
31975 configuration setting:
31976 .code
31977 av_scanner = cmdline:\
31978 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
31979 found in file:'(.+)'
31980 .endd
31981 .vitem &%drweb%&
31982 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
31983 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
31984 takes one option,
31985 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31986 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31987 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31988 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31989 For example:
31990 .code
31991 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
31992 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
31993 .endd
31994 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
31995 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
31996
31997 .vitem &%f-protd%&
31998 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
31999 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
32000 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
32001 (or port-range).
32002 For example:
32003 .code
32004 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
32005 .endd
32006 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32007
32008 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
32009 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
32010 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
32011 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
32012 For example:
32013 .code
32014 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
32015 .endd
32016 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32017
32018 .vitem &%fsecure%&
32019 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
32020 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
32021 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
32022 .code
32023 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
32024 .endd
32025 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
32026 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
32027
32028 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
32029 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32030 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
32031 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
32032 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
32033 For example:
32034 .code
32035 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
32036 .endd
32037 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
32038
32039 .vitem &%mksd%&
32040 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
32041 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
32042 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
32043 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
32044 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
32045 provided that mksd has
32046 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
32047 .code
32048 av_scanner = mksd:2
32049 .endd
32050 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
32051
32052 .vitem &%sock%&
32053 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
32054 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
32055 running on the local machine.
32056 There are four options:
32057 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
32058 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
32059 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
32060 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
32061 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
32062 For example:
32063 .code
32064 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
32065 .endd
32066 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
32067 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
32068 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
32069 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
32070 specify an empty element to get this.
32071
32072 .vitem &%sophie%&
32073 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
32074 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
32075 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
32076 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
32077 client communication. For example:
32078 .code
32079 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
32080 .endd
32081 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
32082 the option.
32083 .endlist
32084
32085 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
32086 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
32087 ACL.
32088
32089 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
32090 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
32091 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
32092 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
32093 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
32094 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
32095 message.
32096
32097 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
32098 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
32099 The first element can then be one of
32100
32101 .ilist
32102 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
32103 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
32104 recommended usage.
32105 .next
32106 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
32107 the condition fails immediately.
32108 .next
32109 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
32110 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
32111 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
32112 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
32113 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
32114 .endlist
32115
32116 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
32117 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
32118 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
32119
32120 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
32121 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
32122 For example:
32123 .code
32124 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
32125 .endd
32126 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
32127
32128 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32129 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32130 is set to record the actual address used.
32131
32132 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
32133 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
32134 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
32135 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
32136 logging data.
32137
32138 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
32139 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
32140
32141 Here is a very simple scanning example:
32142 .code
32143 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32144 malware = *
32145 .endd
32146 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
32147 .code
32148 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32149 malware = */defer_ok
32150 .endd
32151 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
32152 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
32153 .code
32154 av_scanner = $acl_m0
32155 .endd
32156 in the main Exim configuration.
32157 .code
32158 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32159 set acl_m0 = sophie
32160 malware = *
32161
32162 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32163 set acl_m0 = aveserver
32164 malware = *
32165 .endd
32166
32167
32168 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
32169 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
32170 .cindex "spam scanning"
32171 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
32172 .cindex "Rspamd"
32173 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
32174 score and a report for the message.
32175 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
32176
32177 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
32178 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
32179 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
32180
32181 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
32182 .code
32183 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
32184 .endd
32185 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
32186 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
32187 nicely, however.
32188
32189 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
32190 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
32191 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
32192 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
32193 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
32194 configuration as follows (example):
32195 .code
32196 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
32197 .endd
32198 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
32199 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
32200 iptables firewall, consider setting
32201 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
32202 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
32203 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
32204 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
32205 soon.
32206
32207
32208 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
32209 on TCP port 11333)
32210 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
32211 .code
32212 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
32213 .endd
32214
32215 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
32216 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
32217 file name instead of an address/port pair:
32218 .code
32219 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
32220 .endd
32221 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
32222 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
32223 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
32224 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
32225 .code
32226 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
32227 192.168.2.11 783 : \
32228 192.168.2.12 783
32229 .endd
32230 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
32231 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
32232 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
32233 condition defers.
32234
32235 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
32236 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
32237 and changeable in the usual way; take care to not double the separator.
32238
32239 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
32240 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
32241 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
32242 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
32243
32244 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
32245 are options.
32246 The supported options are:
32247 .code
32248 pri=<priority> Selection priority
32249 weight=<value> Selection bias
32250 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
32251 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32252 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
32253 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
32254 .endd
32255
32256 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
32257 higher values being tried first.
32258 The default priority is 1.
32259
32260 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
32261 Within a priority set
32262 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
32263 The default value for selection bias is 1.
32264
32265 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
32266 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
32267 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
32268 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
32269
32270 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
32271 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
32272
32273 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
32274 The default value is two minutes.
32275
32276 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32277 a failed connect is made.
32278 The default is to not retry.
32279
32280 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
32281 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
32282 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
32283 expansion.
32284
32285 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32286 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32287 is set to record the actual address used.
32288
32289 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
32290 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
32291 .code
32292 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32293 spam = joe
32294 .endd
32295 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
32296 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
32297 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
32298 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
32299 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
32300 right-hand side.
32301
32302 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
32303 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
32304 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
32305 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
32306 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
32307 are not set.
32308 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
32309 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
32310 after the first),
32311 or the use of PRDR,
32312 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
32313 are needed to use this feature.
32314
32315 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
32316 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
32317 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
32318
32319
32320 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
32321 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
32322 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
32323 example:
32324 .code
32325 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32326 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
32327 spam = nobody
32328 .endd
32329
32330 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
32331 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
32332 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
32333 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
32334
32335 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
32336 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
32337 variables.
32338 Except for &$spam_report$&,
32339 these variables are saved with the received message so are
32340 available for use at delivery time.
32341
32342 .vlist
32343 .vitem &$spam_score$&
32344 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
32345 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
32346
32347 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
32348 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
32349 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
32350 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
32351 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
32352
32353 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
32354 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
32355 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
32356 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
32357 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
32358 spam bar is 50 characters.
32359
32360 .vitem &$spam_report$&
32361 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
32362 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
32363 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
32364 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
32365 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
32366 unencoded in headers.
32367
32368 .vitem &$spam_action$&
32369 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
32370 spam score versus threshold.
32371 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
32372
32373 .endlist
32374
32375 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
32376 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
32377 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
32378
32379 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
32380 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
32381 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
32382 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
32383 spam condition, like this:
32384 .code
32385 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32386 spam = joe/defer_ok
32387 .endd
32388 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
32389
32390 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
32391 condition:
32392 .code
32393 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
32394 warn spam = nobody:true
32395 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
32396 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
32397
32398 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
32399 # is over threshold
32400 warn spam = nobody
32401 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
32402
32403 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
32404 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
32405 spam = nobody:true
32406 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
32407 .endd
32408
32409
32410
32411 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
32412 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
32413 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
32414 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
32415 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
32416 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
32417 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
32418 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
32419 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
32420 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
32421 cases.
32422
32423 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
32424 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
32425 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
32426 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
32427 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
32428 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
32429 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
32430
32431 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
32432 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
32433 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
32434 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
32435 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
32436
32437 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
32438 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
32439 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
32440 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
32441 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
32442 syntax is:
32443 .display
32444 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
32445 .endd
32446 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
32447 the value can be:
32448
32449 .olist
32450 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
32451 .next
32452 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
32453 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
32454 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
32455 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
32456 .next
32457 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
32458 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
32459 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
32460 the full path and file name.
32461 .next
32462 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
32463 filename, and the default path is then used.
32464 .endlist
32465 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
32466 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
32467 a file with its original, proposed filename using
32468 .code
32469 decode = $mime_filename
32470 .endd
32471 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
32472 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
32473 automatically unlinked.
32474
32475 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
32476 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
32477 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
32478 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
32479 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
32480
32481 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
32482 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
32483 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
32484
32485 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
32486 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
32487 available in the MIME ACL:
32488
32489 .vlist
32490 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
32491 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
32492 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
32493 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
32494 contains the empty string.
32495
32496 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
32497 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
32498 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
32499 .code
32500 us-ascii
32501 gb2312 (Chinese)
32502 iso-8859-1
32503 .endd
32504 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
32505 case-insensitively.
32506
32507 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
32508 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
32509 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
32510 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
32511 only used for display purposes.
32512
32513 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
32514 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
32515 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
32516
32517 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
32518 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
32519 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
32520
32521 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
32522 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32523 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
32524 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
32525 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
32526
32527 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
32528 This variable contains the normalized content of the
32529 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
32530 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
32531
32532 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
32533 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
32534 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
32535 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
32536 .code
32537 text/plain
32538 text/html
32539 application/octet-stream
32540 image/jpeg
32541 audio/midi
32542 .endd
32543 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
32544 empty string.
32545
32546 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
32547 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32548 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
32549 containing the decoded data.
32550 .endlist
32551
32552 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32553 .vlist
32554 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
32555 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
32556 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
32557 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
32558 RFC2047
32559 or RFC2231
32560 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
32561 If no filename was
32562 found, this variable contains the empty string.
32563
32564 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
32565 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
32566 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
32567 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
32568
32569 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
32570 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
32571 follows:
32572
32573 .olist
32574 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
32575
32576 .next
32577 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
32578 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
32579
32580 .next
32581 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
32582 and the rest are attachments.
32583
32584 .next
32585 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
32586 .endlist olist
32587
32588 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
32589 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
32590 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
32591 .code
32592 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
32593 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
32594 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
32595 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
32596 .endd
32597 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
32598 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
32599 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
32600 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
32601 want to carry out specific actions on them.
32602
32603 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
32604 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
32605 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
32606 decoding is fully recursive.
32607
32608 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
32609 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
32610 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
32611 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
32612 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
32613 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
32614 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
32615 .endlist
32616
32617
32618
32619 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
32620 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
32621 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
32622 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
32623 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
32624
32625 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
32626 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
32627 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
32628 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
32629 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
32630
32631 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
32632 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
32633 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
32634 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
32635 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
32636 32K characters are checked.
32637
32638 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
32639 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
32640 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
32641 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
32642 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
32643 .code
32644 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
32645 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
32646 .endd
32647 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
32648 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
32649 matching regular expression.
32650 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
32651 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
32652
32653 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
32654 CPU-intensive.
32655
32656 .ecindex IIDcosca
32657
32658
32659
32660
32661 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32662 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32663
32664 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
32665 "Local scan function"
32666 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
32667 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
32668 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
32669 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
32670 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
32671
32672 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
32673 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
32674 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
32675 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
32676 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
32677
32678 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
32679 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
32680 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
32681 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
32682
32683 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
32684 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
32685 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
32686 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
32687
32688 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
32689 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
32690 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
32691 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
32692 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
32693 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
32694 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
32695 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
32696 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
32697
32698
32699
32700 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
32701 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
32702 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
32703 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
32704 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
32705 directory, so you might set
32706 .code
32707 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
32708 .endd
32709 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
32710 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
32711 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
32712 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
32713 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
32714 _src/local_scan.c_.
32715
32716 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
32717 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
32718 .code
32719 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32720 .endd
32721 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
32722
32723
32724
32725
32726 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
32727 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
32728 You must include this line near the start of your code:
32729 .code
32730 #include "local_scan.h"
32731 .endd
32732 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
32733 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
32734 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
32735 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
32736 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
32737 strings and pointers to character strings:
32738 .code
32739 #define CS (char *)
32740 #define CCS (const char *)
32741 #define CSS (char **)
32742 #define US (unsigned char *)
32743 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
32744 #define USS (unsigned char **)
32745 .endd
32746 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
32747 .code
32748 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
32749 .endd
32750 The arguments are as follows:
32751
32752 .ilist
32753 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
32754 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
32755 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
32756
32757 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
32758 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
32759 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
32760 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
32761 case this changes in some future version.
32762 .next
32763 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
32764 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
32765 .endlist
32766
32767 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
32768
32769 .vlist
32770 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
32771 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
32772 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
32773 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
32774 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
32775 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
32776
32777 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
32778 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32779 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
32780
32781 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
32782 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32783 queued without immediate delivery.
32784
32785 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
32786 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
32787 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
32788 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
32789 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
32790 used.
32791
32792 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
32793 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
32794 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
32795 problem"& is used.
32796
32797 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32798 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
32799 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
32800 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
32801 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
32802 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
32803 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32804
32805 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32806 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
32807 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32808 .endlist
32809
32810 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
32811 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
32812 &%-oe%& command line options.
32813
32814
32815
32816 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
32817 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
32818 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
32819 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
32820 want to do this, you must have the line
32821 .code
32822 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32823 .endd
32824 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
32825 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
32826 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
32827 to define them.
32828
32829 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
32830 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
32831 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
32832 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
32833 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
32834 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
32835 .code
32836 static int my_integer_option = 42;
32837 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
32838
32839 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
32840 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
32841 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
32842 };
32843
32844 int local_scan_options_count =
32845 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
32846 .endd
32847 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
32848 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
32849 .code
32850 begin local_scan
32851 my_integer = 99
32852 my_string = some string of text...
32853 .endd
32854 The available types of option data are as follows:
32855
32856 .vlist
32857 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
32858 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
32859 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
32860 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
32861 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
32862 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
32863 values.)
32864
32865 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
32866 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
32867 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
32868 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
32869
32870 .vitem &*opt_int*&
32871 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
32872 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
32873 Exim.
32874
32875 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
32876 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
32877 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
32878 printed with the suffix K or M.
32879
32880 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
32881 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
32882 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
32883 always output in octal.
32884
32885 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
32886 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
32887 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
32888
32889 .vitem &*opt_time*&
32890 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
32891 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
32892 .endlist
32893
32894 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
32895 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
32896
32897
32898
32899 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
32900 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
32901 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
32902 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
32903 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
32904 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
32905 C variables are as follows:
32906
32907 .vlist
32908 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
32909 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
32910 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32911
32912 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
32913 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
32914 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32915
32916 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
32917 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
32918 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
32919 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
32920
32921 .ilist
32922 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
32923 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
32924 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
32925
32926 .next
32927 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
32928 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
32929 of debugging bits.
32930 .endlist ilist
32931
32932 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
32933 selected, you should use code like this:
32934 .code
32935 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32936 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32937 .endd
32938 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
32939 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
32940 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
32941
32942 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
32943 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
32944 discussed below.
32945
32946 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
32947 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
32948
32949 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
32950 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
32951
32952 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
32953 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
32954 &%-bh%& command line option.
32955
32956 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
32957 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
32958 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
32959
32960 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
32961 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
32962 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
32963 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
32964
32965 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
32966 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
32967 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
32968
32969 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
32970 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
32971
32972 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
32973 The number of accepted recipients.
32974
32975 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
32976 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
32977 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
32978 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
32979 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
32980 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
32981 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
32982 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
32983 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
32984 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
32985 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
32986 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
32987
32988 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
32989 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
32990
32991 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
32992 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
32993 locally-submitted messages.
32994
32995 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
32996 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
32997 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
32998
32999 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
33000 The name of the sending host, if known.
33001
33002 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
33003 The port on the sending host.
33004
33005 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
33006 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
33007
33008 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
33009 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
33010
33011 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
33012 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
33013 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
33014 .endlist
33015
33016
33017 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
33018 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
33019 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
33020 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
33021 their type to *.
33022
33023
33024 .vlist
33025 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
33026 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
33027
33028 .vitem &*int&~type*&
33029 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
33030 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
33031 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
33032 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
33033 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
33034 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
33035
33036 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
33037 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
33038 internal newlines.
33039
33040 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
33041 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
33042 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
33043 .endlist
33044
33045
33046
33047 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
33048 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
33049
33050 .vlist
33051 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
33052 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
33053
33054 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
33055 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
33056 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
33057 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
33058
33059 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
33060 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
33061 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
33062 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
33063 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
33064 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
33065 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
33066 is NULL for all recipients.
33067 .endlist
33068
33069
33070
33071 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
33072 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
33073 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
33074 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
33075 release:
33076
33077 .vlist
33078 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
33079 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
33080
33081 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
33082 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
33083 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
33084 for the process in &%newumask%&.
33085
33086 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
33087 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
33088 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
33089 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
33090 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
33091
33092 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
33093
33094 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
33095 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
33096 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
33097 return value is as follows:
33098
33099 .ilist
33100 >= 0
33101
33102 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
33103 ending status.
33104
33105 .next
33106 < 0 and > &--256
33107
33108 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
33109 signal number.
33110
33111 .next
33112 &--256
33113
33114 The process timed out.
33115 .next
33116 &--257
33117
33118 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
33119 .endlist
33120
33121 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
33122 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
33123 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
33124 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
33125 forks a subprocess that is running
33126 .code
33127 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
33128 .endd
33129 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
33130 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
33131 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
33132 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
33133
33134 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
33135 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
33136 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
33137 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
33138
33139
33140 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
33141 *sender_authentication)*&
33142 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
33143 that it runs is:
33144 .display
33145 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
33146 .endd
33147 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
33148
33149
33150 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33151 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
33152 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
33153 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
33154 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
33155 .code
33156 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33157 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33158 .endd
33159
33160 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
33161 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
33162 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
33163 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
33164 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
33165 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
33166 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
33167 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
33168
33169 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
33170 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
33171 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
33172 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
33173 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
33174 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
33175
33176 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33177 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
33178 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
33179 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
33180
33181 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
33182 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
33183 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
33184 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
33185 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
33186 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
33187 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
33188 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
33189 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
33190 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
33191 .code
33192 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
33193 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
33194 .endd
33195 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
33196 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
33197
33198
33199 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
33200 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
33201 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
33202 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
33203 match the specification, the function does nothing.
33204
33205
33206 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33207 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
33208 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
33209 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
33210 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
33211 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
33212 .code
33213 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
33214 .endd
33215 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
33216 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
33217 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
33218 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
33219 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
33220 zero-terminated.
33221
33222 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
33223 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
33224 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
33225 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
33226 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
33227 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
33228 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
33229 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
33230
33231 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
33232 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
33233 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
33234 .display
33235 &`OK `& match succeeded
33236 &`FAIL `& match failed
33237 &`DEFER `& match deferred
33238 .endd
33239 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
33240 inability to contact a database.
33241
33242 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33243 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
33244 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
33245 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
33246 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33247
33248 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33249 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
33250 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
33251 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
33252 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33253
33254 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
33255 uschar&~*list)*&"
33256 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
33257 expected to be
33258 .code
33259 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
33260 .endd
33261 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
33262 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
33263 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
33264 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
33265 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
33266 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
33267 failed.
33268
33269 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
33270 *format,&~...)*&"
33271 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
33272 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
33273 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
33274 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
33275 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
33276 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
33277
33278
33279 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
33280 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
33281 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
33282 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
33283
33284 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
33285 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
33286 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
33287 value afterwards. For example:
33288 .code
33289 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
33290 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
33291 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
33292 .endd
33293
33294 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
33295 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
33296 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
33297 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
33298 address.
33299 .endlist
33300
33301
33302 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33303 .vlist
33304 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
33305 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
33306 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
33307 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
33308 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
33309 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
33310 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
33311 binary string is returned with an error message.
33312
33313 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
33314 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
33315 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
33316
33317 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
33318 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
33319 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
33320 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
33321 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
33322
33323 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
33324 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
33325 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
33326
33327 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
33328 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
33329 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
33330 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
33331 with translation.
33332
33333
33334 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
33335 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
33336 below.
33337
33338 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33339 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
33340 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
33341 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
33342 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
33343 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
33344 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
33345 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
33346 is involved.
33347
33348 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
33349 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
33350
33351 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
33352 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
33353 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
33354 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
33355 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
33356 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
33357 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
33358 .code
33359 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
33360 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
33361 .endd
33362 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
33363 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
33364 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
33365 multiple output lines.
33366
33367 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
33368 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
33369 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
33370 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
33371 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
33372 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
33373 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
33374 is an error.
33375
33376 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
33377 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
33378 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
33379 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33380
33381 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
33382 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
33383 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33384
33385 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
33386 See below.
33387
33388 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
33389 See below.
33390
33391 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
33392 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
33393 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
33394 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
33395 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
33396 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
33397 more discussion.
33398 .endlist
33399
33400
33401
33402 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
33403 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
33404 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
33405 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
33406 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
33407 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
33408 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
33409 terminates.
33410
33411 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
33412 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
33413 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
33414 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
33415
33416 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
33417 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
33418 .code
33419 store_pool = POOL_PERM
33420 .endd
33421 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
33422 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
33423 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
33424 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
33425
33426 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
33427 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
33428 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
33429 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
33430 &%store_pool%&.
33431 .ecindex IIDlosca
33432
33433
33434
33435
33436 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33437 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33438
33439 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
33440 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
33441 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
33442 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
33443 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
33444 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
33445 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
33446 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
33447
33448 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
33449 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
33450 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
33451 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
33452 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
33453
33454 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
33455 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
33456 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
33457 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
33458 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
33459 prevent it happening on retries.
33460
33461 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33462 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33463 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
33464 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
33465 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
33466 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
33467 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
33468 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
33469
33470
33471 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
33472 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
33473 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
33474 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
33475 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
33476 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
33477 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
33478 .code
33479 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
33480 system_filter_user = exim
33481 .endd
33482 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
33483 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
33484 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
33485 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
33486 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
33487 by the &%reply%& command.
33488
33489
33490 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
33491 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
33492 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
33493 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
33494
33495 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
33496 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
33497
33498
33499
33500 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
33501 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
33502 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
33503 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
33504 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
33505 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
33506 they cause errors.
33507
33508 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
33509 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
33510 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
33511 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
33512 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
33513 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
33514 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
33515
33516 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
33517 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
33518 succeed, it will not be tried again.
33519 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
33520 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
33521
33522 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
33523 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
33524 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
33525 to which users' filter files can refer.
33526
33527
33528
33529 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
33530 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
33531 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
33532 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
33533 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
33534
33535
33536
33537 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
33538 .cindex "freezing messages"
33539 .cindex "message" "freezing"
33540 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
33541 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
33542 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
33543 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
33544 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
33545 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
33546 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
33547 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
33548 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
33549 .code
33550 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
33551 .endd
33552 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
33553
33554 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
33555 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
33556 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
33557 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
33558 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
33559 run.
33560
33561 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
33562 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
33563 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
33564 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
33565
33566 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
33567 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
33568 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
33569 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
33570 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
33571 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
33572 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
33573 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
33574 message. For example:
33575 .code
33576 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
33577 because it contains attachments that we are \
33578 not prepared to receive."
33579 .endd
33580
33581 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
33582 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
33583 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
33584 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
33585 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
33586 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
33587 use, for example
33588 .code
33589 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
33590 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
33591 .endd
33592 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
33593 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
33594 generated by the filter.
33595
33596 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
33597 &%defer%&,
33598 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
33599 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
33600 as
33601 .code
33602 mail ...
33603 freeze
33604 .endd
33605 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
33606 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
33607 take place.
33608
33609
33610
33611 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
33612 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
33613 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
33614 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
33615 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
33616 .code
33617 headers add <string>
33618 headers remove <string>
33619 .endd
33620 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
33621 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
33622 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
33623 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
33624 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
33625
33626 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
33627 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
33628 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
33629 example:
33630 .code
33631 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
33632 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
33633 X-header-2: ...."
33634 .endd
33635 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
33636 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
33637 space after input continuations is ignored.
33638
33639 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
33640 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
33641 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
33642 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
33643 header with the same name, they are all removed.
33644
33645 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
33646 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
33647 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
33648 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
33649 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
33650 used for all recipients of the message.
33651
33652 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
33653 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
33654 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
33655 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
33656 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
33657 until the message is actually being written (see section
33658 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
33659
33660 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
33661 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
33662 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
33663 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
33664 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
33665 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
33666 modified more than once.
33667
33668 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
33669 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
33670 For example:
33671 .code
33672 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
33673 headers remove "Subject"
33674 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
33675 headers remove "Old-Subject"
33676 .endd
33677
33678
33679
33680 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
33681 .cindex "envelope sender"
33682 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
33683 .code
33684 errors_to <some address>
33685 .endd
33686 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
33687 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
33688 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
33689 might use
33690 .code
33691 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
33692 .endd
33693 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
33694 address if its delivery failed.
33695
33696
33697
33698 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
33699 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33700 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33701 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
33702 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
33703 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
33704 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
33705 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
33706 which implements such a filter:
33707 .code
33708 central_filter:
33709 check_local_user
33710 driver = redirect
33711 domains = +local_domains
33712 file = /central/filters/$local_part
33713 no_verify
33714 allow_filter
33715 allow_freeze
33716 .endd
33717 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
33718 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
33719 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
33720 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
33721
33722 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
33723 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
33724 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
33725 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
33726 normal way.
33727 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
33728 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
33729 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
33730
33731
33732
33733
33734
33735
33736 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33737 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33738
33739 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
33740 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
33741 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
33742 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
33743 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
33744 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
33745 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
33746 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
33747
33748 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
33749 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
33750 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
33751 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
33752 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
33753
33754 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
33755 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
33756 loopback interface specially in any way.
33757
33758 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
33759 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
33760
33761
33762
33763
33764 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
33765 .cindex "message" "submission"
33766 .cindex "submission mode"
33767 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
33768 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
33769 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
33770 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
33771 .code
33772 control = submission
33773 .endd
33774 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
33775 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
33776 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
33777 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
33778 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
33779 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
33780 .code
33781 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
33782 control = submission
33783 .endd
33784 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
33785 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
33786 is used to separate options. For example:
33787 .code
33788 control = submission/sender_retain
33789 .endd
33790 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
33791 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
33792 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
33793 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
33794 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
33795 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
33796 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
33797
33798 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
33799 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
33800 example:
33801 .code
33802 control = submission/domain=some.domain
33803 .endd
33804 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
33805 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
33806 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
33807 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
33808 .code
33809 accept authenticated = *
33810 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
33811 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
33812 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
33813 .endd
33814 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
33815 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
33816 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
33817 .code
33818 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
33819 .endd
33820 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
33821 line would be:
33822 .code
33823 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
33824 .endd
33825 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
33826 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
33827 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
33828 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
33829
33830 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
33831 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
33832 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
33833 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
33834 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
33835 spoof another's address.
33836
33837 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
33838 .cindex "line endings"
33839 .cindex "carriage return"
33840 .cindex "linefeed"
33841 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
33842 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
33843 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
33844 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
33845 use CRLF or just CR.
33846
33847 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
33848 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
33849 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
33850 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
33851 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
33852 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
33853 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
33854 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
33855 follows:
33856
33857 .ilist
33858 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
33859 .next
33860 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
33861 is ignored.
33862 .next
33863 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
33864 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
33865 terminator.
33866 .next
33867 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
33868 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
33869 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
33870 people trying to play silly games.
33871 .next
33872 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
33873 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
33874 line.
33875 .endlist
33876
33877
33878
33879
33880
33881 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
33882 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
33883 .cindex "address" "qualification"
33884 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
33885 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
33886 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
33887 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
33888 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
33889
33890 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
33891 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
33892 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
33893 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
33894 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
33895
33896 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
33897 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
33898 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
33899 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
33900 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
33901 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
33902 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
33903 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
33904
33905
33906
33907
33908 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
33909 .cindex "&""From""& line"
33910 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
33911 .cindex "sender" "address"
33912 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
33913 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
33914 .cindex "envelope sender"
33915 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33916 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
33917 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
33918 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
33919 .code
33920 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
33921 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
33922 .endd
33923 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
33924 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
33925 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
33926 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
33927 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
33928 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
33929 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
33930 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
33931 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
33932
33933 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
33934 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
33935 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
33936 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
33937 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
33938 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
33939 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
33940
33941 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
33942 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
33943 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
33944
33945 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
33946 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
33947 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
33948 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
33949
33950
33951
33952 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
33953 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
33954 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
33955 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
33956 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
33957 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
33958 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
33959 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
33960
33961 .blockquote
33962 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
33963 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
33964 .endblockquote
33965
33966 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
33967 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
33968 follows:
33969
33970 .ilist
33971 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
33972 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
33973 .next
33974 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
33975 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
33976 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
33977 .next
33978 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
33979 also removed.
33980 .next
33981 For a locally-submitted message,
33982 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
33983 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
33984 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
33985 included in log lines in this case.
33986 .next
33987 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
33988 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
33989 .endlist
33990
33991
33992
33993
33994 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
33995 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
33996 includes the header line:
33997 .code
33998 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
33999 .endd
34000
34001 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
34002 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
34003 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
34004 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
34005 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
34006 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
34007
34008
34009 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
34010 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
34011 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
34012 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
34013 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
34014 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
34015
34016 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
34017 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
34018 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
34019 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
34020 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
34021 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
34022 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
34023 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
34024 messages.
34025
34026
34027 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
34028 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
34029 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
34030 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
34031 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
34032 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
34033 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
34034 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
34035 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
34036 messages.
34037
34038
34039 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
34040 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
34041 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
34042 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34043 .cindex "message" "submission"
34044 .cindex "submission mode"
34045 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
34046 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
34047
34048 .ilist
34049 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
34050 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
34051 .next
34052 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34053 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
34054 .olist
34055 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34056 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34057 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34058 .next
34059 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
34060 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34061 .next
34062 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34063 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34064 .endlist
34065 .endlist
34066
34067 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
34068
34069 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
34070 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
34071 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
34072 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34073 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
34074 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
34075 &%qualify_domain%&.
34076
34077 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
34078 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
34079 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
34080 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34081
34082
34083 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
34084 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
34085 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
34086 .cindex "message" "submission"
34087 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
34088 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
34089 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
34090 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
34091 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
34092 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
34093 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
34094 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
34095 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
34096 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
34097
34098
34099 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
34100 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
34101 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
34102 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
34103 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
34104 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
34105
34106 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
34107 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
34108 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
34109 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
34110
34111 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
34112 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
34113 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
34114
34115
34116 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
34117 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
34118 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
34119 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
34120 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
34121 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
34122 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
34123 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
34124 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
34125 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
34126 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
34127 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
34128
34129
34130
34131 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
34132 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
34133 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
34134 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
34135 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
34136 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
34137 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
34138 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
34139 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
34140
34141
34142
34143 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
34144 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
34145 .cindex "message" "submission"
34146 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
34147 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
34148 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
34149 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
34150 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34151 control setting.
34152
34153 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
34154 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34155 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
34156 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
34157 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
34158 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
34159 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
34160 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
34161 line is added to the message.
34162
34163 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
34164 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
34165 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
34166 options true at the same time.
34167
34168 .cindex "submission mode"
34169 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
34170 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
34171 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
34172 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
34173
34174 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34175 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
34176 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
34177 created as follows:
34178
34179 .ilist
34180 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34181 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34182 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34183 .next
34184 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
34185 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34186 .next
34187 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34188 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34189 .endlist
34190
34191 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
34192 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
34193 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
34194 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
34195
34196 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
34197 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
34198 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
34199 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
34200
34201
34202
34203 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
34204 "SECTheadersaddrem"
34205 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
34206 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
34207 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
34208 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
34209 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
34210 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
34211 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
34212
34213 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
34214 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
34215 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
34216 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
34217 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
34218 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
34219
34220 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
34221 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
34222 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
34223
34224 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
34225 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
34226 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
34227 .code
34228 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
34229 X-added-second: another added header line
34230 .endd
34231 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
34232
34233 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
34234 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
34235 Each header-line is separately expanded.
34236
34237 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
34238 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
34239 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
34240 not part of the names. For example:
34241 .code
34242 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
34243 .endd
34244
34245 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
34246 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
34247 Each item is separately expanded.
34248 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
34249 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
34250 will act as list separators.
34251
34252 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
34253 items are expanded at routing time,
34254 and then associated with all addresses that are
34255 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
34256 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
34257 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
34258
34259 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
34260 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
34261 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
34262 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
34263
34264 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
34265 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
34266 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
34267 requirements.
34268
34269 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
34270 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
34271 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
34272 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
34273 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
34274 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
34275 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
34276
34277 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
34278 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
34279 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
34280 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
34281
34282 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
34283 the following consequences:
34284
34285 .ilist
34286 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
34287 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
34288 to it, at all times.
34289 .next
34290 Header lines that are added by a router's
34291 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
34292 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
34293 .next
34294 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
34295 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
34296 .next
34297 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
34298 a later router or by a transport.
34299 .next
34300 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
34301 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
34302 .code
34303 headers_remove = subject
34304 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
34305 .endd
34306 .endlist
34307
34308 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
34309 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
34310
34311
34312
34313
34314
34315 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
34316 .cindex "address" "constructed"
34317 .cindex "constructed address"
34318 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
34319 the form
34320 .display
34321 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
34322 .endd
34323 For example:
34324 .code
34325 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
34326 .endd
34327 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
34328 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
34329 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
34330 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
34331 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
34332 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
34333 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
34334 there is no password file entry.
34335
34336 .cindex "RFC 2047"
34337 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
34338 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
34339 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
34340 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
34341 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
34342 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
34343 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
34344 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
34345
34346
34347
34348 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
34349 .cindex "case of local parts"
34350 .cindex "local part" "case of"
34351 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
34352 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
34353 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
34354 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
34355 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
34356 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
34357 router option.
34358
34359 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
34360 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
34361 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
34362 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
34363 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
34364 .code
34365 correct_case:
34366 driver = redirect
34367 domains = +local_domains
34368 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
34369 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
34370 @$domain
34371 .endd
34372 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
34373 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
34374 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
34375 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
34376 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
34377
34378
34379
34380 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
34381 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
34382 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
34383 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
34384 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
34385 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
34386 empty components for compatibility.
34387
34388
34389
34390 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
34391 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
34392 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
34393 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
34394 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
34395 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
34396
34397 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
34398 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
34399 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
34400 example, a header such as
34401 .code
34402 To: hare@teaparty
34403 .endd
34404 might get rewritten as
34405 .code
34406 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
34407 .endd
34408 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
34409 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
34410 been routed.
34411
34412 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
34413 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
34414 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
34415 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
34416 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
34417 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
34418 .ecindex IIDmesproc
34419
34420
34421
34422 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34423 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34424
34425 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
34426 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
34427 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
34428 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
34429 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
34430 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
34431 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
34432
34433 .ilist
34434 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
34435 .next
34436 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
34437 .next
34438 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
34439 .endlist
34440
34441 For mail delivery, the following are available:
34442
34443 .ilist
34444 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
34445 .next
34446 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
34447 &"lmtp"&);
34448 .next
34449 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
34450 transport);
34451 .next
34452 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
34453 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
34454 .endlist
34455
34456 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
34457 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
34458 used to contain the envelope information.
34459
34460
34461
34462 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
34463 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
34464 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
34465 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
34466 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
34467 .cindex "EHLO"
34468 .cindex "HELO"
34469 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34470 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
34471 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
34472 processing is the same in both cases.
34473
34474 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
34475 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
34476 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
34477 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
34478 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
34479 .cindex "transport" "filter"
34480 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
34481 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
34482 suppressed.
34483
34484 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
34485 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
34486 required for the transaction.
34487
34488 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
34489 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
34490 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
34491 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
34492 is called for verification.
34493
34494 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
34495 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
34496 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
34497
34498 .cindex "carriage return"
34499 .cindex "linefeed"
34500 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34501 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
34502 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34503 line terminator.
34504
34505 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
34506 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
34507 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
34508 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
34509 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
34510 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
34511 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
34512 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
34513 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
34514
34515 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
34516 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
34517 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
34518 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
34519
34520 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
34521 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
34522 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
34523 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
34524
34525 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34526 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
34527 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
34528 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
34529 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
34530 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
34531 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
34532 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
34533 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
34534 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
34535
34536 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
34537 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
34538
34539 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
34540 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
34541 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
34542 square bracket of the IP address.
34543
34544
34545
34546
34547 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
34548 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
34549 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
34550 .cindex "host" "error"
34551 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
34552 message errors, and recipient errors.
34553
34554 .vlist
34555 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
34556 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
34557 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
34558
34559 .ilist
34560 Connection refused or timed out,
34561 .next
34562 Any error response code on connection,
34563 .next
34564 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
34565 .next
34566 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
34567 .next
34568 I/O errors at any time,
34569 .next
34570 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
34571 the &"."& at the end of the data.
34572 .endlist ilist
34573
34574 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
34575 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
34576 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
34577 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
34578 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
34579 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
34580 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
34581 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
34582
34583 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
34584 .cindex "message" "error"
34585 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
34586 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
34587 message errors are:
34588
34589 .ilist
34590 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
34591 the data,
34592 .next
34593 Timeout after MAIL,
34594 .next
34595 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
34596 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
34597 connection at any other time.
34598 .endlist ilist
34599
34600 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
34601 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
34602 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
34603 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
34604 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
34605 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
34606 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
34607 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
34608 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
34609 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
34610
34611 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
34612 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
34613 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
34614 response to MAIL.
34615
34616 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
34617 .cindex "recipient" "error"
34618 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
34619 recipient errors are:
34620
34621 .ilist
34622 Any error response to RCPT,
34623 .next
34624 Timeout after RCPT.
34625 .endlist
34626
34627 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
34628 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
34629 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
34630 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
34631 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
34632 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
34633 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
34634 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
34635 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
34636 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
34637 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
34638 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
34639 the retry clock is reset.
34640
34641 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
34642 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
34643 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
34644 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
34645 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
34646 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
34647 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
34648 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
34649 recipient's retry time.
34650 .endlist
34651
34652 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
34653 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
34654 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
34655 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
34656 until the next delivery attempt.
34657
34658 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
34659 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
34660 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
34661 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
34662 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
34663 is created.
34664
34665 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
34666 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
34667 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
34668 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
34669 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
34670 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
34671 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
34672
34673 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
34674 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
34675 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
34676 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
34677 then to be treated as a host error.
34678
34679 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
34680 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
34681 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
34682 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
34683 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
34684
34685
34686
34687
34688 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
34689 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
34690 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
34691 .cindex "inetd"
34692 .cindex "daemon"
34693 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
34694 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
34695 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
34696 .code
34697 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
34698 .endd
34699 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
34700 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
34701 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
34702 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
34703 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
34704 stream and exits with an error code.
34705
34706 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
34707 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
34708 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
34709 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
34710
34711 .cindex "carriage return"
34712 .cindex "linefeed"
34713 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34714 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
34715 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34716 line terminator.
34717 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
34718 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
34719 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
34720
34721 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
34722 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
34723 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
34724 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
34725 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
34726 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
34727 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
34728 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
34729
34730 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34731 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
34732 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
34733 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
34734 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
34735 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
34736 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
34737 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
34738 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
34739
34740 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
34741 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
34742 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
34743
34744 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
34745 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
34746 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
34747 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
34748 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
34749
34750 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
34751 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
34752 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
34753 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
34754 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
34755 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
34756 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
34757
34758 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
34759 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
34760 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
34761 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
34762 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
34763
34764 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
34765 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
34766 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
34767 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
34768 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
34769 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
34770 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
34771 a delivery process.
34772
34773 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
34774 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
34775 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
34776 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
34777 however, available with &'inetd'&.
34778
34779 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
34780 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
34781 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
34782 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
34783
34784 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
34785 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
34786 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
34787
34788
34789
34790 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
34791 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
34792 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
34793 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
34794 the error response to the last command. The default value for
34795 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
34796 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
34797 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
34798
34799
34800 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
34801 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
34802 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
34803 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
34804 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
34805 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
34806 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
34807 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
34808 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
34809 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
34810 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
34811
34812
34813
34814 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
34815 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
34816 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
34817 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
34818 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
34819 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
34820 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
34821 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
34822
34823 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
34824 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
34825 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
34826 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
34827 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
34828 counted.
34829
34830 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
34831 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
34832 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
34833
34834 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
34835 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
34836 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
34837 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
34838 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
34839
34840
34841
34842
34843 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
34844 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
34845 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
34846 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
34847
34848 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
34849 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
34850 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
34851 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
34852 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
34853 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
34854 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
34855 SMTP response codes.
34856
34857 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
34858 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
34859 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
34860 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
34861 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
34862 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
34863 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
34864 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
34865 RCPT failures.
34866
34867
34868
34869 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
34870 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
34871 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
34872 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
34873 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
34874 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
34875 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
34876
34877 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
34878 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
34879 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
34880 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
34881 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
34882 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
34883 argument. For example,
34884 .code
34885 ETRN #brigadoon
34886 .endd
34887 runs the command
34888 .code
34889 exim -R brigadoon
34890 .endd
34891 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
34892 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
34893 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
34894 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
34895 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
34896
34897 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
34898 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
34899 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
34900 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
34901 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
34902 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
34903 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
34904 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
34905
34906 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
34907 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
34908 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
34909 whatever the form of its argument. For
34910 example:
34911 .code
34912 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
34913 $sender_host_address
34914 .endd
34915 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34916 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
34917 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
34918 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
34919 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
34920 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
34921 for it to change them before running the command.
34922
34923
34924
34925 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
34926 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
34927 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
34928 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
34929 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
34930 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
34931 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
34932 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
34933 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
34934 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
34935 runs for RCPT commands:
34936 .code
34937 accept hosts = :
34938 .endd
34939 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
34940
34941
34942
34943 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
34944 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
34945 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
34946 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
34947 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
34948 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
34949 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
34950 envelope along with the message.
34951
34952 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
34953 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
34954 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
34955 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
34956 can be used to specify it.
34957
34958 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
34959 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
34960 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
34961 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
34962 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
34963
34964 .vindex "&$host$&"
34965 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
34966 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
34967 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
34968 router:
34969 .code
34970 begin routers
34971 route_append:
34972 driver = manualroute
34973 transport = smtp_appendfile
34974 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
34975
34976 begin transports
34977 smtp_appendfile:
34978 driver = appendfile
34979 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
34980 batch_max = 1000
34981 use_bsmtp
34982 user = exim
34983 .endd
34984 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
34985 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
34986 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
34987
34988
34989
34990 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
34991 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
34992 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
34993 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
34994 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
34995 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
34996 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
34997 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
34998 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
34999 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
35000
35001 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
35002 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
35003
35004 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
35005 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
35006 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
35007 make some use of automatically, for example:
35008 .code
35009 554 Unexpected end of file
35010 Transaction started in line 10
35011 Error detected in line 14
35012 .endd
35013 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
35014 file, for example:
35015 .code
35016 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
35017 The error message was:
35018
35019 501 '>' missing at end of address
35020
35021 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
35022 The error was detected in line 12.
35023 The SMTP command at fault was:
35024
35025 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
35026
35027 1 previous message was successfully processed.
35028 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
35029 .endd
35030 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
35031 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
35032 accepted.
35033 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
35034 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
35035
35036
35037
35038 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35039 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35040
35041 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
35042 "Customizing messages"
35043 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
35044 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
35045 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
35046 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
35047 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
35048
35049 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
35050 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
35051 option. Exim also adds the line
35052 .code
35053 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
35054 .endd
35055 to all warning and bounce messages,
35056
35057
35058 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
35059 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
35060 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
35061 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
35062 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
35063 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
35064 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
35065
35066 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
35067 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
35068 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
35069 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
35070 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
35071 item.
35072
35073 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
35074 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
35075 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
35076 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
35077 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
35078 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
35079 option, rounded to a whole number.
35080
35081 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
35082
35083 .ilist
35084 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35085 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35086 .next
35087 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
35088 failing addresses with their error messages.
35089 .next
35090 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
35091 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
35092 .next
35093 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
35094 The fields exist for back-compatibility
35095 .endlist
35096
35097 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
35098 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
35099 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
35100 .code
35101 Subject: Mail delivery failed
35102 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35103 {: returning message to sender}}
35104 ****
35105 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35106
35107 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35108 {that you sent }{sent by
35109
35110 <$sender_address>
35111
35112 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
35113 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
35114 ****
35115 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
35116 ****
35117 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
35118 ------
35119 ****
35120 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
35121 only the first
35122 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
35123 ****
35124 .endd
35125 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
35126 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
35127 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
35128 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
35129 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
35130 text sections:
35131
35132 .ilist
35133 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35134 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35135 .next
35136 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
35137 the delayed addresses.
35138 .next
35139 The third item then ends the message.
35140 .endlist
35141
35142 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
35143 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
35144 .code
35145 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
35146 $warn_message_delay
35147 ****
35148 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35149
35150 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
35151 {that you sent }{sent by
35152
35153 <$sender_address>
35154
35155 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
35156 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
35157
35158 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
35159 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
35160 The date of the message is: $h_date
35161
35162 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
35163 ****
35164 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
35165 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
35166 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
35167 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
35168 the message will be returned to you.
35169 .endd
35170 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
35171 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
35172 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
35173 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
35174 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
35175 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
35176 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
35177 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
35178 handled them.
35179
35180
35181
35182
35183 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35184 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35185
35186 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
35187 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
35188 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
35189
35190
35191
35192 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
35193 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
35194 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
35195 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
35196 routing explicitly:
35197 .code
35198 send_to_smart_host:
35199 driver = manualroute
35200 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
35201 transport = remote_smtp
35202 .endd
35203 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
35204 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
35205 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
35206 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
35207 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
35208
35209
35210
35211
35212 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
35213 .cindex "mailing lists"
35214 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
35215 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
35216 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
35217
35218 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
35219 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
35220 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
35221 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
35222 .code
35223 lists:
35224 driver = redirect
35225 domains = lists.example
35226 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35227 forbid_pipe
35228 forbid_file
35229 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35230 no_more
35231 .endd
35232 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
35233 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
35234 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
35235 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
35236
35237 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
35238 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
35239 a mailing list.
35240
35241 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
35242 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
35243 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
35244 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
35245 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
35246
35247 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
35248 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
35249 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
35250 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
35251 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
35252 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
35253 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
35254 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
35255 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
35256
35257
35258
35259 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
35260 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
35261 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
35262 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
35263 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
35264 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
35265 addresses are not rigorously checked.
35266
35267 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
35268 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
35269 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
35270 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
35271 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
35272
35273
35274
35275 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
35276 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
35277 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
35278 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
35279 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
35280 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
35281 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
35282 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
35283 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
35284 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
35285
35286 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
35287 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
35288 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
35289 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
35290 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
35291 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
35292 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
35293 pre-existing messages.
35294
35295 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
35296 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
35297 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
35298 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
35299 one level of expansion anyway.
35300
35301
35302
35303 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
35304 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
35305 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
35306 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
35307 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
35308 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
35309
35310 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
35311 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
35312 .code
35313 lists_request:
35314 driver = redirect
35315 domains = lists.example
35316 local_part_suffix = -request
35317 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
35318 no_more
35319
35320 lists_post:
35321 driver = redirect
35322 domains = lists.example
35323 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
35324 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
35325 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35326 forbid_pipe
35327 forbid_file
35328 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35329 no_more
35330
35331 lists_closed:
35332 driver = redirect
35333 domains = lists.example
35334 allow_fail
35335 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
35336 .endd
35337 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
35338 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
35339 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
35340 mailing list.
35341
35342 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
35343 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
35344 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
35345 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
35346 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
35347 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
35348 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
35349 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
35350 &"unrouteable address"& error.
35351
35352 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
35353 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
35354 the address, giving a suitable error message.
35355
35356
35357
35358
35359 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
35360 .cindex "VERP"
35361 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
35362 .cindex "envelope sender"
35363 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
35364 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
35365 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
35366 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
35367 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
35368 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
35369
35370 .oindex &%errors_to%&
35371 .oindex &%return_path%&
35372 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
35373 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
35374 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
35375 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
35376 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
35377 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
35378 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
35379 .code
35380 verp_smtp:
35381 driver = smtp
35382 max_rcpt = 1
35383 return_path = \
35384 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35385 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35386 .endd
35387 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
35388 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
35389 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
35390 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
35391 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
35392 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
35393 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
35394 rewritten as
35395 .code
35396 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
35397 .endd
35398 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
35399 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
35400 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
35401 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
35402 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
35403 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
35404
35405 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
35406 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
35407 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
35408 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
35409 .code
35410 dnslookup:
35411 driver = dnslookup
35412 domains = ! +local_domains
35413 transport = \
35414 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35415 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
35416 no_more
35417 .endd
35418 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
35419 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
35420 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
35421 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
35422 address.
35423
35424 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
35425 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
35426 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
35427 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
35428 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
35429 .code
35430 verp_dnslookup:
35431 driver = dnslookup
35432 domains = ! +local_domains
35433 transport = remote_smtp
35434 errors_to = \
35435 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
35436 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35437 no_more
35438 .endd
35439 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
35440 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
35441 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
35442 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
35443 them.
35444
35445 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
35446 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
35447 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
35448 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
35449 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
35450 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
35451 used).
35452
35453
35454
35455
35456
35457
35458 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
35459 .cindex "virtual domains"
35460 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
35461 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
35462 meanings:
35463
35464 .ilist
35465 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
35466 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
35467 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
35468 .next
35469 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
35470 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
35471 have login accounts on that host.
35472 .endlist
35473
35474 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
35475 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
35476 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
35477 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
35478 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
35479 to a router of this form:
35480 .code
35481 virtual:
35482 driver = redirect
35483 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
35484 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
35485 no_more
35486 .endd
35487 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
35488 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
35489 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
35490 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
35491 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
35492 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
35493
35494 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
35495 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
35496 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
35497 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
35498
35499 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
35500 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
35501 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
35502 .code
35503 my_domains:
35504 driver = accept
35505 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
35506 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
35507 transport = my_mailboxes
35508 .endd
35509 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
35510 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
35511 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
35512 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
35513 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
35514 follows:
35515 .code
35516 my_mailboxes:
35517 driver = appendfile
35518 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
35519 user = mail
35520 .endd
35521 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
35522 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
35523
35524 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
35525 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
35526 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
35527 information about the domains.
35528
35529
35530
35531 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
35532 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
35533 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
35534 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
35535 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
35536 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
35537 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
35538 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
35539 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
35540 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
35541 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
35542 example, consider this router:
35543 .code
35544 userforward:
35545 driver = redirect
35546 check_local_user
35547 file = $home/.forward
35548 local_part_suffix = -*
35549 local_part_suffix_optional
35550 allow_filter
35551 .endd
35552 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
35553 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
35554 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
35555 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
35556 .code
35557 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
35558 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
35559 endif
35560 .endd
35561 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
35562 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
35563 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
35564 control over which suffixes are valid.
35565
35566 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
35567 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
35568 another MTA:
35569 .code
35570 userforward:
35571 driver = redirect
35572 check_local_user
35573 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
35574 local_part_suffix = -*
35575 local_part_suffix_optional
35576 allow_filter
35577 .endd
35578 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
35579 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
35580 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
35581 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
35582 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
35583
35584
35585
35586 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
35587 .cindex "vacation processing"
35588 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
35589 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
35590 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
35591 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
35592 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
35593
35594 .ilist
35595 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
35596 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
35597 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
35598 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
35599 .code
35600 spqr, vacation-spqr
35601 .endd
35602 .next
35603 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
35604 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
35605 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
35606 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
35607 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
35608 message.
35609 .endlist
35610
35611 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
35612 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
35613
35614
35615
35616 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
35617 .cindex "message" "copying every"
35618 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
35619 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
35620 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
35621 each day's messages.
35622
35623 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
35624 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
35625 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
35626 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
35627
35628
35629
35630 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
35631 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
35632 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
35633 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
35634 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
35635 permanently connected.
35636
35637 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
35638 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
35639 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
35640
35641
35642 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
35643 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
35644 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
35645 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
35646 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
35647 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
35648 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
35649 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
35650
35651 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
35652 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
35653 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
35654 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
35655 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
35656 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
35657 if required.
35658
35659 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
35660 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
35661 intermittent host. For example:
35662 .code
35663 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
35664 .endd
35665 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
35666 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
35667 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
35668 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
35669 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
35670 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
35671 immediately.
35672
35673 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
35674 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
35675 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
35676 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
35677 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
35678 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
35679 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
35680
35681
35682
35683 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
35684 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
35685 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
35686 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
35687 delivered immediately.
35688
35689 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35690 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
35691 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
35692 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
35693 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
35694 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
35695 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
35696 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
35697 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
35698 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
35699 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
35700 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
35701 single SMTP connection.
35702
35703
35704
35705 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35706 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35707
35708 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
35709 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
35710 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
35711 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
35712 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
35713 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
35714 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
35715 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
35716 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
35717 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
35718 messages this way.
35719
35720 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
35721 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
35722 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
35723 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
35724 email is not desirable.
35725
35726 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
35727 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
35728 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
35729 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
35730 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
35731 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
35732 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
35733
35734 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
35735 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
35736 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
35737 before sending a message to the smart host.
35738
35739 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
35740 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
35741 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
35742
35743 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
35744 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
35745 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
35746 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
35747 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
35748 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
35749 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
35750
35751 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
35752 following ways:
35753
35754 .ilist
35755 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
35756 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
35757 .next
35758 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
35759 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
35760 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
35761 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
35762 successful, a zero return code is given.
35763 .next
35764 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
35765 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
35766 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
35767 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
35768 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
35769 are.
35770 .next
35771 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
35772 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
35773 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
35774 .next
35775 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
35776 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
35777 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
35778 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
35779 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
35780 .next
35781 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
35782 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
35783 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
35784 .next
35785 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
35786 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
35787 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
35788 are ever generated.
35789 .next
35790 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
35791 .next
35792 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
35793 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
35794 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
35795 .endlist
35796
35797 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
35798 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
35799 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
35800 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
35801 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
35802 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
35803
35804
35805
35806
35807 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35808 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35809
35810 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
35811 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
35812 .cindex "log" "types of"
35813 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
35814 and the panic log:
35815
35816 .ilist
35817 .cindex "main log"
35818 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
35819 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
35820 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
35821 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
35822 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
35823 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
35824 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
35825 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
35826 .next
35827 .cindex "reject log"
35828 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
35829 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
35830 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
35831 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
35832 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
35833 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
35834 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
35835 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
35836 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
35837 false.
35838 .next
35839 .cindex "panic log"
35840 .cindex "system log"
35841 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
35842 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
35843 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
35844 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
35845 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
35846 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
35847 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
35848 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
35849 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
35850 .endlist
35851
35852 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
35853 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
35854 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
35855 .code
35856 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
35857 by QUIT
35858 .endd
35859 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
35860 ways of changing this:
35861
35862 .ilist
35863 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
35864 you set
35865 .code
35866 timezone = UTC
35867 .endd
35868 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
35869 .next
35870 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
35871 example:
35872 .code
35873 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
35874 .endd
35875 .endlist
35876
35877 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35878 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35879 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
35880 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
35881 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
35882 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
35883
35884
35885
35886
35887 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
35888 .cindex "log" "destination"
35889 .cindex "log" "to file"
35890 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
35891 .cindex "syslog"
35892 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
35893 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
35894 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
35895 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
35896 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
35897 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
35898 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
35899
35900 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
35901 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
35902 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
35903 references to the host name:
35904 .code
35905 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
35906 .endd
35907 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
35908 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
35909 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
35910 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
35911 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
35912 log at all.
35913
35914 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
35915 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
35916 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
35917 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
35918 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
35919 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
35920 implying the use of a default path.
35921
35922 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
35923 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
35924 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
35925 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
35926 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
35927 equivalent to the setting:
35928 .code
35929 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
35930 .endd
35931 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
35932 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
35933 that is where the logs are written.
35934
35935 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
35936 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
35937
35938 Here are some examples of possible settings:
35939 .display
35940 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
35941 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
35942 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
35943 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
35944 .endd
35945 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
35946 error is logged.
35947
35948
35949
35950 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
35951 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
35952 .cindex "cycling logs"
35953 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
35954 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
35955 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
35956 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
35957 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
35958 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
35959 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
35960
35961 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
35962 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
35963 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
35964 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
35965 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
35966 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
35967 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
35968 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
35969 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
35970 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
35971 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
35972 renamed.
35973
35974
35975
35976 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
35977 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
35978 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
35979 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
35980 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
35981 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
35982 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
35983 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
35984 .code
35985 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
35986 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
35987 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
35988 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
35989 .endd
35990 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
35991 examples of names generated by the above examples:
35992 .code
35993 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
35994 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
35995 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
35996 /var/log/exim/main.200212
35997 .endd
35998 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
35999 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
36000 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
36001 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
36002
36003 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
36004 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
36005 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
36006 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
36007 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
36008 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
36009 log names:
36010 .code
36011 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36012 /var/log/exim-panic.log
36013 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36014 /var/log/exim/panic
36015 .endd
36016
36017
36018 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
36019 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
36020 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
36021 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
36022 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
36023 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
36024 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
36025 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
36026 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
36027 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
36028 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
36029 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
36030 the time and host name to each line.
36031 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
36032
36033 .ilist
36034 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
36035 .next
36036 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
36037 .next
36038 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
36039 .endlist
36040
36041 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
36042 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
36043 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
36044 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
36045
36046 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
36047 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
36048 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
36049 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
36050 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
36051 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
36052 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
36053 RFC 3164, you should set
36054 .code
36055 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
36056 .endd
36057 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
36058 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
36059
36060 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
36061 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
36062 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
36063 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
36064 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
36065 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
36066 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
36067 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
36068 name, and pid as added by syslog:
36069 .code
36070 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
36071 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
36072 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
36073 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
36074 [5/5] mple>)
36075 .endd
36076 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
36077 (LOG_NOTICE):
36078 .code
36079 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
36080 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
36081 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
36082 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
36083 [5\18] .example>)
36084 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
36085 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
36086 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
36087 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
36088 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
36089 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
36090 [12\18] F From: <>
36091 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
36092 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
36093 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
36094 [16\18] le>
36095 [17\18] B Bcc:
36096 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
36097 .endd
36098 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
36099 without modification.
36100
36101 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
36102 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
36103 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
36104 where it is.
36105
36106
36107
36108 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
36109 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
36110 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
36111 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
36112 timestamp. The flags are:
36113 .display
36114 &`<=`& message arrival
36115 &`(=`& message fakereject
36116 &`=>`& normal message delivery
36117 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
36118 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
36119 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
36120 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
36121 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
36122 .endd
36123
36124
36125 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
36126 .cindex "log" "reception line"
36127 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36128 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
36129 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
36130 .code
36131 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
36132 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
36133 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
36134 .endd
36135 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
36136 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
36137 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
36138 .code
36139 R=<message id>
36140 .endd
36141 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
36142
36143 .cindex "HELO"
36144 .cindex "EHLO"
36145 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
36146 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
36147 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
36148 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
36149 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
36150 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
36151 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
36152 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
36153 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
36154 name in parentheses.
36155
36156 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
36157 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
36158 the log containing text like these examples:
36159 .code
36160 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
36161 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
36162 .endd
36163 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
36164 on.
36165
36166 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
36167 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
36168 of Exim.
36169
36170 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
36171 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
36172 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
36173 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
36174 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
36175 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
36176 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
36177 suite that was used.
36178
36179 .cindex log protocol
36180 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
36181 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
36182 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
36183 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
36184 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
36185 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
36186 authenticator name.
36187
36188 .cindex "size" "of message"
36189 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
36190 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
36191 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
36192 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
36193 other).
36194
36195 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36196 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36197
36198
36199
36200 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
36201 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
36202 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36203 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
36204 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
36205 to fit it on the page:
36206 .code
36207 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
36208 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
36209 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
36210 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
36211 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
36212 .endd
36213 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
36214 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
36215 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
36216 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
36217 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
36218
36219 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
36220 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
36221 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
36222 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
36223
36224 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
36225 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
36226 .display
36227 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
36228 .endd
36229 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
36230 parentheses afterwards.
36231
36232 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
36233 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
36234 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
36235 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
36236 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
36237 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36238 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
36239 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
36240 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36241 TLS cipher information is still available.
36242
36243 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
36244 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
36245 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
36246 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
36247 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
36248
36249 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
36250 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
36251
36252 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36253 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36254
36255
36256 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
36257 .cindex "discarded messages"
36258 .cindex "message" "discarded"
36259 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
36260 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
36261 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
36262 .code
36263 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
36264 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
36265 .endd
36266 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
36267 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
36268 .code
36269 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
36270 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
36271 .endd
36272
36273
36274 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
36275 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
36276 .code
36277 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
36278 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
36279 .endd
36280 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
36281 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
36282 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
36283 .code
36284 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
36285 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
36286 .endd
36287 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
36288 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
36289 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
36290
36291
36292
36293 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
36294 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
36295 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
36296 following form is logged:
36297 .code
36298 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
36299 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
36300 .endd
36301 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
36302 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
36303 .code
36304 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
36305 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
36306 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
36307 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
36308 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
36309 .endd
36310 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
36311 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
36312 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
36313 flagged with &`**`&.
36314
36315
36316
36317 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
36318 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
36319 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
36320 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
36321 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
36322
36323
36324
36325 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
36326 A line of the form
36327 .code
36328 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
36329 .endd
36330 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
36331 at the end of its processing.
36332
36333
36334
36335
36336 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
36337 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
36338 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
36339 the following table:
36340 .display
36341 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
36342 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
36343 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36344 &`CV `& certificate verification status
36345 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36346 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
36347 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
36348 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36349 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
36350 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
36351 &`H `& host name and IP address
36352 &`I `& local interface used
36353 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
36354 &`id `& message id for incoming message
36355 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
36356 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
36357 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
36358 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
36359 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
36360 &`Q `& alternate queue name
36361 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
36362 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
36363 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
36364 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
36365 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
36366 &`S `& size of message in bytes
36367 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
36368 &`ST `& shadow transport name
36369 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
36370 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
36371 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
36372 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
36373 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
36374 .endd
36375
36376
36377 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
36378 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
36379 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
36380
36381 .ilist
36382 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
36383 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
36384 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
36385 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
36386 during the first delivery attempt.
36387 .next
36388 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
36389 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
36390 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
36391 .next
36392 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
36393 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
36394 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
36395 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
36396 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
36397 doing.
36398 .next
36399 .cindex "error" "ignored"
36400 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
36401 message:
36402 .olist
36403 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
36404 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
36405 .next
36406 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
36407 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36408 .next
36409 A delivery set up by a router configured with
36410 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
36411 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
36412 .code
36413 errors_to = <>
36414 .endd
36415 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36416 .endlist olist
36417 .next
36418 .new
36419 .cindex DKIM "log line"
36420 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
36421 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
36422 .wen
36423 .endlist ilist
36424
36425
36426
36427
36428
36429 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
36430 .cindex "log" "selectors"
36431 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
36432 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
36433 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
36434 example:
36435 .code
36436 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
36437 .endd
36438 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
36439 selection marked by asterisks:
36440 .display
36441 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
36442 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
36443 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
36444 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
36445 &` arguments `& command line arguments
36446 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
36447 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
36448 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
36449 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
36450 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
36451 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
36452 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
36453 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36454 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
36455 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
36456 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
36457 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
36458 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
36459 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
36460 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
36461 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
36462 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
36463 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
36464 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
36465 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
36466 &` pid `& Exim process id
36467 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
36468 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
36469 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
36470 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
36471 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
36472 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
36473 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
36474 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
36475 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
36476 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
36477 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
36478 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
36479 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
36480 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
36481 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
36482 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
36483 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
36484 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
36485 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
36486 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
36487 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
36488 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
36489 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
36490
36491 &` all `& all of the above
36492 .endd
36493 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
36494 section &<<SECID99>>&
36495
36496 More details on each of these items follows:
36497
36498 .ilist
36499 .cindex "8BITMIME"
36500 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
36501 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
36502 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
36503 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
36504 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
36505 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
36506 .next
36507 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
36508 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
36509 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
36510 this log selector is set.
36511 .next
36512 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
36513 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
36514 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
36515 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
36516 such users cannot access the log).
36517 .next
36518 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
36519 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
36520 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
36521 parentheses between them.
36522 .next
36523 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
36524 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
36525 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
36526 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
36527 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
36528 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
36529 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
36530 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
36531 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
36532 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
36533 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
36534 between the caller and Exim.
36535 .next
36536 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
36537 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
36538 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
36539 .next
36540 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
36541 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
36542 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
36543 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
36544 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
36545 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
36546 .next
36547 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
36548 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
36549 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
36550 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36551 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
36552 .next
36553 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
36554 .cindex "size" "of message"
36555 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
36556 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
36557 .next
36558 .new
36559 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
36560 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36561 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
36562 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
36563 .next
36564 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
36565 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36566 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
36567 .wen
36568 .next
36569 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
36570 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
36571 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
36572 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
36573 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
36574 .next
36575 .cindex log dnssec
36576 .cindex dnssec logging
36577 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
36578 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
36579 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
36580 It does not cover helo-name verification.
36581 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
36582 .next
36583 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
36584 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
36585 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
36586 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
36587 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
36588 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
36589 .next
36590 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
36591 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
36592 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
36593 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
36594 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
36595 .next
36596 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
36597 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
36598 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
36599 client's ident port times out.
36600 .next
36601 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
36602 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36603 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36604 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36605 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36606 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
36607 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
36608 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
36609 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
36610 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
36611 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36612 .next
36613 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
36614 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
36615 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
36616 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
36617 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
36618 on a proxied connection
36619 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
36620 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
36621 .next
36622 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
36623 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
36624 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
36625 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
36626 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
36627 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
36628 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
36629 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
36630 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
36631 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
36632 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
36633 .next
36634 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
36635 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
36636 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
36637 .next
36638 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
36639 .cindex millisecond logging
36640 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
36641 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
36642 appended to the seconds value.
36643 .next
36644 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
36645 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36646 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36647 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36648 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36649 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
36650 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
36651 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
36652 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36653 .next
36654 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
36655 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
36656 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
36657 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
36658 containing => tags) following the IP address.
36659 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
36660 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
36661 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
36662 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
36663 local port is a random ephemeral port.
36664 .next
36665 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36666 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36667 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
36668 immediately after the time and date.
36669 .next
36670 .cindex "log" "queue run"
36671 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
36672 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
36673 .next
36674 .cindex "log" "queue time"
36675 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
36676 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
36677 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
36678 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
36679 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
36680 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
36681 message has been successfully received.
36682 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36683 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
36684 .next
36685 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
36686 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
36687 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
36688 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
36689 .new
36690 .next
36691 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
36692 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
36693 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
36694 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36695 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
36696 .wen
36697 .next
36698 .cindex "log" "recipients"
36699 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
36700 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
36701 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
36702 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
36703 has taken place.
36704 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
36705 in the list.
36706 .next
36707 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
36708 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
36709 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
36710 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
36711 .next
36712 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
36713 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
36714 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
36715 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
36716 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
36717 .next
36718 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
36719 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
36720 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
36721 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
36722 attempt.
36723 .next
36724 .cindex "log" "return path"
36725 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
36726 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
36727 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
36728 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
36729 .next
36730 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
36731 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
36732 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
36733 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
36734 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
36735 .next
36736 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
36737 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
36738 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
36739 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
36740 detail is lost.
36741 .next
36742 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
36743 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
36744 it is too big.
36745 .next
36746 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
36747 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
36748 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
36749 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
36750 it.
36751 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
36752 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
36753 .next
36754 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
36755 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
36756 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
36757 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
36758 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
36759 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
36760 response.
36761 .next
36762 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
36763 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
36764 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
36765 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
36766 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
36767 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
36768 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
36769 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
36770 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
36771 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
36772
36773 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
36774 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
36775 reset if the daemon is restarted.
36776 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
36777 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
36778 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
36779 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
36780 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
36781 .next
36782 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
36783 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
36784 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
36785 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
36786 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
36787 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
36788 .next
36789 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
36790 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
36791 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
36792 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
36793 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
36794 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
36795 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
36796 already have their own log lines.
36797
36798 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
36799 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
36800 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
36801 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
36802 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
36803 the same logging options.
36804
36805 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
36806 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
36807 .code
36808 C=EHLO,QUIT
36809 .endd
36810 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
36811 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
36812 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
36813 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
36814 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
36815 .next
36816 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
36817 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
36818 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
36819 was accepted or used.
36820 .next
36821 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
36822 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
36823 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
36824 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
36825 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
36826 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
36827 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
36828 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
36829 .next
36830 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
36831 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
36832 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
36833 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
36834 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
36835 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
36836 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
36837 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
36838 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
36839 .next
36840 .cindex "log" "subject"
36841 .cindex "subject, logging"
36842 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
36843 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
36844 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
36845 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
36846 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
36847 .next
36848 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
36849 .cindex log DANE
36850 .cindex DANE logging
36851 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
36852 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
36853 verified
36854 .new
36855 using a CA trust anchor,
36856 &`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
36857 .wen
36858 and &`CV=no`& if not.
36859 .next
36860 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
36861 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
36862 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36863 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
36864 .next
36865 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
36866 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
36867 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36868 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
36869 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
36870 .next
36871 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
36872 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
36873 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
36874 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
36875 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
36876 .next
36877 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
36878 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
36879 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
36880 .endlist
36881
36882
36883 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
36884 .cindex "message" "log file for"
36885 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
36886 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
36887 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
36888 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
36889 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
36890 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
36891 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
36892 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
36893 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
36894 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
36895 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
36896
36897 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
36898 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
36899 &%message_logs%& option false.
36900 .ecindex IIDloggen
36901
36902
36903
36904
36905 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36906 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36907
36908 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
36909 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
36910 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
36911 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
36912 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
36913
36914 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
36915 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
36916 "list what Exim processes are doing"
36917 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
36918 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
36919 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
36920 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
36921 various criteria"
36922 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
36923 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
36924 "extract statistics from the log"
36925 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
36926 "check address acceptance from given IP"
36927 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
36928 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
36929 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
36930 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
36931 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
36932 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
36933 .endtable
36934
36935 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
36936 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
36937 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
36938
36939
36940
36941
36942 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
36943 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
36944 .cindex "process, querying"
36945 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
36946 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
36947 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
36948 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
36949 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
36950 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
36951 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
36952 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
36953 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
36954
36955 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
36956 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
36957 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
36958
36959
36960 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
36961 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
36962 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
36963 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
36964 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
36965 options:
36966 .display
36967 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
36968 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
36969 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
36970 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
36971 .endd
36972 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
36973 .code
36974 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
36975 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
36976 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
36977 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
36978 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
36979 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
36980 .endd
36981 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
36982 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
36983
36984
36985
36986 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
36987 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
36988 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
36989 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
36990 .code
36991 exim -bpu
36992 .endd
36993 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
36994 .code
36995 exim -bp
36996 .endd
36997 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
36998 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
36999
37000 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
37001 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
37002
37003 .vlist
37004 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
37005 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37006 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
37007 .code
37008 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
37009 .endd
37010 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
37011 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37012 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
37013
37014 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
37015 Match against the size field.
37016
37017 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37018 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
37019
37020 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37021 Match messages that are older than the given time.
37022
37023 .vitem &*-z*&
37024 Match only frozen messages.
37025
37026 .vitem &*-x*&
37027 Match only non-frozen messages.
37028 .endlist
37029
37030 The following options control the format of the output:
37031
37032 .vlist
37033 .vitem &*-c*&
37034 Display only the count of matching messages.
37035
37036 .vitem &*-l*&
37037 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
37038 the default.
37039
37040 .vitem &*-i*&
37041 Display message ids only.
37042
37043 .vitem &*-b*&
37044 Brief format &-- one line per message.
37045
37046 .vitem &*-R*&
37047 Display messages in reverse order.
37048
37049 .vitem &*-a*&
37050 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
37051 .endlist
37052
37053 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
37054
37055
37056
37057 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
37058 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
37059 .cindex "queue" "summary"
37060 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
37061 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
37062 running a command such as
37063 .code
37064 exim -bp | exiqsumm
37065 .endd
37066 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
37067 it, as in the following example:
37068 .code
37069 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
37070 .endd
37071 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
37072 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
37073 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
37074 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
37075
37076 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
37077 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
37078 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
37079 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
37080 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
37081 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
37082 sender.
37083
37084 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
37085 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
37086 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
37087 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
37088 level"& addresses).
37089
37090
37091
37092
37093 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
37094 "SECTextspeinf"
37095 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
37096 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
37097 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
37098 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
37099 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
37100 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
37101 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
37102 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
37103 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
37104 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
37105 .display
37106 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
37107 .endd
37108 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
37109
37110 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
37111 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
37112 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
37113
37114 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
37115 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
37116 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
37117 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
37118 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
37119
37120 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
37121 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
37122 regular expression.
37123
37124 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
37125 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
37126
37127 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
37128 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
37129 normally.
37130
37131 Example of &%-M%&:
37132 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
37133 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
37134 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
37135 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
37136 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
37137 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
37138 search term.
37139
37140 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
37141 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
37142 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
37143 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
37144 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
37145
37146
37147 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
37148 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
37149 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
37150 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
37151 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
37152 the &%--help%& option.
37153
37154
37155 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
37156 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37157 .cindex "cycling logs"
37158 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37159 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
37160 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
37161 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
37162 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
37163 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
37164 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
37165 .ilist
37166 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
37167 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
37168 .next
37169 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
37170 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
37171 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
37172 configuration.
37173 .endlist
37174
37175 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
37176 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
37177 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
37178 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
37179 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
37180 logs are handled similarly.
37181
37182 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
37183 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
37184 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
37185 any existing log files.
37186
37187 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
37188 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
37189 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
37190 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
37191 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
37192 .code
37193 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
37194 .endd
37195 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
37196 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
37197
37198
37199
37200 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
37201 .cindex "statistics"
37202 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
37203 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
37204 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
37205 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
37206 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
37207
37208 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
37209 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
37210 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
37211 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
37212 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
37213 .code
37214 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
37215 .endd
37216 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
37217 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
37218 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
37219 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
37220 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
37221 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
37222 also produced per user.
37223
37224 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
37225 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
37226 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
37227 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
37228 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
37229
37230 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
37231 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
37232 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
37233 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
37234 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
37235 an entirely separate message.
37236
37237 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
37238 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
37239 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
37240 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
37241 least one address that failed.
37242
37243 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
37244 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
37245 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
37246 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
37247 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
37248 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
37249 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
37250
37251 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
37252 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
37253 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
37254
37255 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
37256 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
37257 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
37258 .code
37259 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
37260 .endd
37261
37262 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
37263 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
37264 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
37265 .cindex "checking access"
37266 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
37267 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
37268 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
37269 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
37270 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
37271 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
37272
37273 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
37274 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
37275 .code
37276 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
37277 .endd
37278 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
37279 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
37280 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
37281 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
37282 .code
37283 Rejected:
37284 550 Relay not permitted
37285 .endd
37286 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
37287 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
37288 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
37289 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
37290 you can use:
37291 .code
37292 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
37293 -f himself@there.example
37294 .endd
37295 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
37296 mandatory arguments.
37297
37298 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
37299 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
37300 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
37301
37302
37303
37304 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
37305 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
37306 .cindex "building DBM files"
37307 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
37308 .cindex "lower casing"
37309 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
37310 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
37311 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
37312 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
37313 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
37314 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
37315
37316 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
37317 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
37318 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
37319 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
37320 files.
37321
37322 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
37323 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
37324 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
37325 well.
37326
37327 .cindex "USE_DB"
37328 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
37329 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
37330 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
37331 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
37332 .code
37333 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
37334 .endd
37335 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
37336 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
37337
37338 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
37339 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
37340 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
37341 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
37342 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
37343 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
37344
37345 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
37346 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
37347 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
37348 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
37349 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
37350 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
37351 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
37352 return code is 2.
37353
37354
37355
37356
37357 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
37358 .cindex "retry" "times"
37359 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
37360 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
37361 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
37362 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
37363 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
37364 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
37365 output. For example:
37366 .code
37367 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
37368 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
37369 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37370 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37371 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
37372 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
37373 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
37374 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
37375 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
37376 past final cutoff time
37377 .endd
37378 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
37379 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
37380 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
37381 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
37382 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
37383 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
37384 run very often.
37385
37386 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
37387 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
37388 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
37389 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
37390 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
37391 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
37392
37393
37394
37395 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
37396 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
37397 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
37398 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
37399 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
37400 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
37401 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
37402
37403 .ilist
37404 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
37405 .next
37406 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
37407 for remote hosts
37408 .next
37409 &'callout'&: the callout cache
37410 .next
37411 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
37412 .next
37413 &'misc'&: other hints data
37414 .endlist
37415
37416 The &'misc'& database is used for
37417
37418 .ilist
37419 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
37420 .next
37421 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
37422 &(smtp)& transport)
37423 .next
37424 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
37425 in a transport)
37426 .endlist
37427
37428
37429
37430 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
37431 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
37432 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
37433 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
37434 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
37435 .code
37436 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
37437 .endd
37438 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
37439 .code
37440 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
37441 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
37442 .endd
37443 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
37444 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
37445 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
37446 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
37447 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
37448 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
37449 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
37450 and a textual description of the error.
37451
37452 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
37453 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
37454 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
37455 exceeded.
37456
37457 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
37458 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
37459 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
37460 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
37461 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
37462 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
37463 cross-references.
37464
37465
37466
37467 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
37468 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
37469 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
37470 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
37471 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
37472 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
37473 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
37474 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
37475 updated sufficiently often.
37476
37477 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
37478 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
37479 the retry database:
37480 .code
37481 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
37482 .endd
37483 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
37484 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
37485 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
37486 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
37487 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
37488 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
37489 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
37490 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
37491 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
37492 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
37493 whenever it removes information from the database.
37494
37495 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
37496 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
37497 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
37498 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
37499 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
37500
37501 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
37502 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
37503 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
37504 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
37505 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
37506 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
37507 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
37508 tidied.
37509
37510 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
37511 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
37512
37513
37514
37515
37516 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
37517 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
37518 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
37519 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
37520 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
37521 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
37522 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
37523 displayed.
37524
37525 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
37526 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
37527 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
37528 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
37529 by new data, for example:
37530 .code
37531 > 4 951102:1000
37532 .endd
37533 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
37534 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
37535 used as optional separators.
37536
37537
37538
37539
37540 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
37541 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
37542 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
37543 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
37544 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
37545 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
37546 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
37547 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
37548 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
37549 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
37550 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
37551 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
37552 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
37553
37554 .vlist
37555 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
37556 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
37557
37558 .vitem &%-flock%&
37559 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
37560 supports it.
37561
37562 .vitem &%-interval%&
37563 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
37564 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
37565
37566 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
37567 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
37568
37569 .vitem &%-mbx%&
37570 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
37571
37572 .vitem &%-q%&
37573 Suppress verification output.
37574
37575 .vitem &%-retries%&
37576 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
37577 the lock (default 10).
37578
37579 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
37580 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
37581 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
37582 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
37583 subsequently sees.
37584
37585 .vitem &%-timeout%&
37586 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
37587 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
37588 default), a non-blocking call is used.
37589
37590 .vitem &%-v%&
37591 Generate verbose output.
37592 .endlist
37593
37594 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
37595 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
37596 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
37597 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
37598 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
37599 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
37600 more than 30 minutes old.
37601
37602 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
37603 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
37604 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
37605 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
37606 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
37607 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
37608
37609 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
37610 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
37611 suppresses all output except error messages.
37612
37613 A command such as
37614 .code
37615 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
37616 .endd
37617 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
37618 .display
37619 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
37620 <&'some commands'&>
37621 &`End`&
37622 .endd
37623 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
37624 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
37625 such as
37626 .code
37627 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
37628 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
37629 .endd
37630 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
37631 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
37632 .ecindex IIDutils
37633
37634
37635 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37636 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37637
37638 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
37639 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
37640 .cindex "X-windows"
37641 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
37642 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
37643 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
37644 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
37645 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
37646 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
37647 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
37648 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
37649
37650
37651
37652 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
37653 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
37654 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
37655 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
37656 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
37657 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
37658 parameters are for.
37659
37660 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
37661 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
37662 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
37663 .code
37664 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
37665 .endd
37666 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
37667 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
37668 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
37669 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
37670 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
37671
37672 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
37673 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
37674 .code
37675 Eximon*background: gray94
37676 .endd
37677 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
37678 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
37679 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
37680 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
37681 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
37682 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
37683 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
37684 .code
37685 xrdb -merge <<End
37686 Eximon*highlight: gray
37687 End
37688 .endd
37689 .cindex "admin user"
37690 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
37691 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
37692
37693 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
37694 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
37695 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
37696 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
37697 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
37698
37699 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
37700 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
37701 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
37702 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
37703 different parts of the display.
37704
37705
37706
37707
37708 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
37709 .cindex "stripchart"
37710 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
37711 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37712 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
37713 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
37714 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
37715 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
37716 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
37717 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
37718 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37719
37720 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
37721 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
37722 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
37723 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
37724
37725 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
37726 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
37727 to a single partition.
37728
37729 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
37730 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
37731 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
37732 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
37733 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
37734 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37735 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37736
37737
37738
37739
37740 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
37741 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
37742 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
37743 .cindex "window size"
37744 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
37745 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
37746 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
37747 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
37748 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
37749 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
37750
37751 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
37752 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
37753 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
37754 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
37755
37756 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
37757 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
37758 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
37759 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
37760 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
37761 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37762
37763 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
37764 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
37765 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37766
37767
37768
37769 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
37770 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
37771 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
37772 the main log is maintained.
37773 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
37774 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
37775 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
37776 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
37777 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
37778
37779 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
37780 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
37781 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
37782 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
37783 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
37784 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
37785 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
37786 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
37787 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
37788 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
37789 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37790
37791 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
37792 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
37793 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
37794 It cannot go further back up the log.
37795
37796 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
37797 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
37798 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
37799 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
37800 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
37801 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
37802
37803 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
37804 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
37805 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
37806 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
37807 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
37808 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
37809
37810 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
37811 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
37812 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
37813 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
37814 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
37815 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
37816 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
37817 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
37818 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
37819 window.
37820
37821
37822
37823 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
37824 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
37825 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
37826 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
37827 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
37828 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
37829 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
37830 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
37831 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
37832 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
37833
37834 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
37835 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
37836 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
37837 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
37838 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
37839 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
37840 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
37841
37842 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
37843 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
37844 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
37845 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
37846 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
37847 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
37848 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
37849
37850 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
37851 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
37852 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
37853 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
37854
37855 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
37856 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
37857 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
37858 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
37859 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
37860 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
37861 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
37862 not shown.
37863
37864 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
37865 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
37866
37867 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
37868 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
37869 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
37870 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
37871 display is updated.
37872
37873
37874
37875 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
37876 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
37877 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
37878 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
37879 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
37880 any selected text.
37881
37882 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
37883 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
37884 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
37885 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
37886 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
37887 .code
37888 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
37889 .endd
37890 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
37891 follows:
37892
37893 .ilist
37894 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
37895 in a new text window.
37896 .next
37897 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
37898 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
37899 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
37900 .next
37901 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
37902 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
37903 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
37904 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
37905 .next
37906 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
37907 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
37908 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
37909 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
37910 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
37911 .next
37912 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
37913 that the message be frozen.
37914 .next
37915 .cindex "thawing messages"
37916 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
37917 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
37918 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
37919 that the message be thawed.
37920 .next
37921 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
37922 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
37923 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
37924 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
37925 .next
37926 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
37927 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
37928 message.
37929 .next
37930 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
37931 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37932 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37933 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37934 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
37935 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
37936 which case no action is taken.
37937 .next
37938 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
37939 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37940 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37941 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37942 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
37943 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
37944 case no action is taken.
37945 .next
37946 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
37947 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
37948 .next
37949 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
37950 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
37951 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
37952 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
37953 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
37954 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
37955 the address is qualified with that domain.
37956 .endlist
37957
37958 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
37959 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
37960 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
37961 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
37962 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
37963 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
37964 if no output is generated.
37965
37966 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
37967 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
37968 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
37969 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
37970
37971 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
37972 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
37973 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
37974 .ecindex IIDeximon
37975
37976
37977
37978
37979
37980 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37981 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37982
37983 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
37984 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
37985 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
37986 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
37987
37988 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
37989 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
37990 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
37991 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
37992 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
37993 its security as compared with other MTAs.
37994
37995 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
37996 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
37997 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
37998 as soon as possible.
37999
38000
38001 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
38002 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
38003 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
38004 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
38005 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
38006 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
38007
38008 .ilist
38009 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
38010 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
38011 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
38012 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
38013 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
38014 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
38015
38016 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
38017 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
38018 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
38019 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
38020 .next
38021
38022 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
38023 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
38024 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
38025 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
38026 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
38027 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
38028 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
38029 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
38030 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
38031 separate commands.
38032
38033 .next
38034 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
38035 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
38036 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
38037 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
38038 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
38039 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
38040 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
38041 .next
38042 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
38043 is disabled.
38044 .next
38045 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
38046 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
38047 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
38048 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
38049 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
38050 .endlist
38051
38052
38053
38054 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
38055 .cindex "setuid"
38056 .cindex "root privilege"
38057 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
38058 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
38059 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
38060 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
38061 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
38062 is required for two things:
38063
38064 .ilist
38065 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
38066 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
38067 not required.
38068 .next
38069 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
38070 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
38071 configuration.
38072 .endlist
38073
38074 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
38075 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
38076 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
38077 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
38078 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
38079 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
38080 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
38081 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
38082
38083 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
38084 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
38085 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
38086
38087 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
38088 uid and gid in the following cases:
38089
38090 .ilist
38091 .oindex "&%-C%&"
38092 .oindex "&%-D%&"
38093 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
38094 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
38095 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
38096 the calling process.
38097 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
38098 option may not be used at all.
38099 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
38100 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
38101 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
38102 .next
38103 .oindex "&%-be%&"
38104 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
38105 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
38106 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
38107 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
38108 calling process.
38109 .next
38110 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
38111 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
38112 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
38113 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
38114 testing address verification
38115 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
38116 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
38117 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
38118 option).
38119 .next
38120 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
38121 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
38122 .endlist
38123
38124 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
38125
38126 .ilist
38127 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
38128 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
38129 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
38130 will be used during message reception.
38131 .next
38132 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
38133 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
38134 .next
38135 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
38136 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
38137 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
38138 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
38139 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
38140 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
38141 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
38142 generating bounce and warning messages.
38143
38144 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
38145 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
38146 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
38147 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
38148 .next
38149 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
38150 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
38151 .endlist
38152
38153
38154
38155
38156 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
38157 .cindex "privilege, running without"
38158 .cindex "unprivileged running"
38159 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
38160 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
38161 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
38162 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
38163 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
38164 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
38165 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
38166 to any other uid.
38167
38168 .cindex SIGHUP
38169 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
38170 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
38171 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
38172 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
38173
38174 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
38175 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
38176 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
38177 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
38178 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
38179
38180 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
38181 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
38182 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
38183 effect.
38184
38185 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
38186 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
38187 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
38188
38189 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
38190 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
38191 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
38192 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
38193 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
38194 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
38195 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
38196 address this problem at this time.
38197
38198 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
38199 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
38200 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
38201 be used in the most straightforward way.
38202
38203 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
38204 number of restrictions on what you can do:
38205
38206 .ilist
38207 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
38208 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
38209 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
38210 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
38211 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
38212 .next
38213 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
38214 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
38215 .next
38216 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
38217 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
38218 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
38219 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
38220 .next
38221 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
38222 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
38223
38224 .olist
38225 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
38226 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
38227 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
38228 .next
38229 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
38230 owned by the Exim user.
38231 .next
38232 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
38233 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
38234 mailboxes need to be created manually.
38235 .endlist olist
38236 .endlist ilist
38237
38238
38239 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
38240 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
38241 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
38242 gives more security at essentially no cost.
38243
38244 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
38245 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
38246
38247
38248
38249
38250 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
38251 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
38252 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
38253
38254
38255
38256 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
38257 .cindex "security" "local commands"
38258 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
38259 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
38260 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
38261 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
38262 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
38263
38264 .ilist
38265 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
38266 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
38267 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
38268 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
38269 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
38270 .next
38271 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
38272 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
38273 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
38274 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
38275 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
38276 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
38277 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
38278 .next
38279 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
38280 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
38281 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
38282 .next
38283 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
38284 taint checking might apply to their usage.
38285 .next
38286 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
38287 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
38288 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
38289 .next
38290 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
38291 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
38292 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
38293 of opaque strings.
38294 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
38295 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
38296 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
38297 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
38298 .endlist
38299
38300
38301
38302
38303 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
38304 .cindex "security" "data sources"
38305 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
38306 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
38307 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
38308 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
38309 are some issues to be aware of:
38310
38311 .ilist
38312 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
38313 .next
38314 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
38315 .next
38316 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
38317 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
38318 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
38319 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
38320 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
38321 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
38322 data.
38323 .next
38324 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
38325 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
38326 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
38327 .next
38328 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
38329 expected to yield one result.
38330 .endlist
38331
38332
38333
38334
38335 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
38336 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
38337 .cindex "IP source routing"
38338 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
38339 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
38340 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
38341 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
38342
38343
38344
38345 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
38346 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
38347 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
38348
38349
38350
38351
38352 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
38353 .cindex "trusted users"
38354 .cindex "admin user"
38355 .cindex "privileged user"
38356 .cindex "user" "trusted"
38357 .cindex "user" "admin"
38358 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
38359 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
38360 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
38361 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
38362 permit a remote host to be specified.
38363
38364 .oindex "&%-f%&"
38365 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
38366 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
38367 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
38368 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
38369 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
38370 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
38371
38372 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
38373 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
38374 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
38375 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
38376 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
38377
38378 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
38379 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
38380 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
38381 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
38382 includes the contents of files on the spool.
38383
38384 .oindex "&%-M%&"
38385 .oindex "&%-q%&"
38386 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
38387 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
38388 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
38389 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
38390 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
38391 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
38392
38393 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
38394 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
38395 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
38396 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
38397 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
38398 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
38399 files.
38400
38401 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
38402 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
38403 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
38404 This affects most of the checking options,
38405 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
38406
38407
38408 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
38409 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
38410 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
38411 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
38412 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
38413 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
38414
38415
38416
38417 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
38418 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
38419 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
38420 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
38421 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
38422 this.
38423
38424
38425
38426 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
38427 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
38428 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
38429 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
38430 converted output.
38431
38432
38433
38434 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
38435 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
38436 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
38437 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
38438 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
38439
38440
38441
38442 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
38443 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
38444 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
38445 loading it.
38446
38447
38448 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
38449 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
38450 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
38451 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
38452 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
38453 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
38454 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
38455
38456 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
38457 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
38458 string.
38459
38460
38461
38462 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
38463 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
38464 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
38465 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
38466
38467
38468
38469 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
38470 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
38471 enough to hold the result.
38472 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
38473
38474
38475
38476
38477 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38478 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38479
38480 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
38481 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
38482 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
38483 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
38484 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
38485 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
38486 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
38487 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
38488 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
38489 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
38490 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
38491 themselves are recoverable.
38492
38493 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
38494 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
38495 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
38496
38497 .ilist
38498 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
38499 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
38500 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
38501 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
38502 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
38503 .next
38504 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
38505 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
38506 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
38507 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
38508 .next
38509 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
38510 .next
38511 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
38512 signature.
38513 .endlist
38514 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
38515
38516 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
38517 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
38518 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
38519 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
38520 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
38521 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
38522 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
38523 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
38524 attempt.
38525
38526 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
38527 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
38528 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
38529 relics of crashes and can be removed.
38530
38531 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
38532 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
38533 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
38534 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
38535 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
38536 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
38537 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
38538 normally the Exim user.
38539
38540 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
38541 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
38542 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
38543 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
38544 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
38545 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
38546 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
38547 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
38548
38549 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
38550 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
38551 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
38552 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
38553
38554 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
38555 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
38556
38557 .vlist
38558 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38559 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
38560 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
38561 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
38562 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
38563 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
38564 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
38565 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
38566 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
38567 newlines.
38568
38569 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38570 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
38571 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
38572 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38573 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38574 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38575
38576 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38577 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
38578 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
38579 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38580 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38581 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38582
38583 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
38584 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
38585 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
38586
38587 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
38588 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
38589 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
38590 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
38591 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38592
38593 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
38594 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
38595 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
38596 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
38597 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38598
38599 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
38600 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
38601 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
38602
38603 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
38604 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
38605 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
38606
38607 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38608 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
38609 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
38610
38611 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38612 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
38613 present if the number is greater than zero.
38614
38615 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
38616 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
38617 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
38618
38619 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
38620 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
38621 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
38622
38623 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38624 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
38625 command.
38626
38627 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38628 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
38629 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
38630 messages.
38631
38632 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
38633 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
38634 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
38635 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
38636
38637 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
38638 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
38639 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
38640
38641 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38642 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
38643 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
38644 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
38645 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
38646 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
38647
38648 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
38649 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
38650 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
38651 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
38652 supplied by the remote host, if any.
38653
38654 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38655 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
38656 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
38657 generated messages.
38658
38659 .vitem &%-local%&
38660 The message is from a local sender.
38661
38662 .vitem &%-localerror%&
38663 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
38664
38665 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
38666 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
38667 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
38668 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
38669
38670 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
38671 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
38672 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
38673
38674 .vitem &%-N%&
38675 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
38676 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
38677 &%-N%& is assumed.
38678
38679 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
38680 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
38681 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
38682
38683 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
38684 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
38685 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
38686
38687 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
38688 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
38689 of &$spam_score_int$&.
38690
38691 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
38692 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
38693 rather than Unix-format.
38694 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
38695 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
38696
38697 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
38698 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
38699 certificate was verified by the server.
38700
38701 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
38702 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
38703 name of the cipher suite that was used.
38704
38705 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
38706 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
38707 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
38708 certificate.
38709 .endlist
38710
38711 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
38712 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
38713 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
38714 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
38715 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
38716 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
38717 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
38718 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
38719 addresses are complete.
38720
38721 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
38722 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
38723 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
38724 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
38725 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
38726 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
38727 .code
38728 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
38729 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
38730 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38731 .endd
38732 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
38733 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
38734 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
38735 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
38736 example:
38737 .code
38738 4
38739 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38740 darcy@austen.fict.example
38741 rdo@foundation
38742 alice@wonderland.fict.example
38743 .endd
38744 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
38745 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
38746 line is of the following form:
38747 .display
38748 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
38749 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
38750 .endd
38751 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
38752 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
38753 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
38754 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
38755 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
38756 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
38757 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
38758 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
38759
38760
38761 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
38762 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
38763 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
38764 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
38765 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
38766 following:
38767
38768 .table2 50pt
38769 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
38770 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
38771 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
38772 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
38773 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
38774 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
38775 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
38776 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
38777 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
38778 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
38779 .endtable
38780
38781 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
38782 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
38783 typical set of headers:
38784 .code
38785 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
38786 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38787 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
38788 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
38789 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
38790 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
38791 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
38792 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38793 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
38794 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38795 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38796 .endd
38797 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
38798 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
38799 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
38800 .ecindex IIDforspo1
38801 .ecindex IIDforspo2
38802 .ecindex IIDforspo3
38803
38804 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
38805 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
38806 an ASCII newline character.
38807 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
38808 can have an alternate format.
38809 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
38810 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
38811 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
38812 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
38813 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
38814 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
38815
38816 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38817 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38818
38819 .chapter "DKIM and SPF" "CHAPdkim" &&&
38820 "DKIM and SPF Support"
38821 .cindex "DKIM"
38822
38823 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
38824
38825 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
38826 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
38827 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
38828 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
38829
38830 .new
38831 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
38832 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
38833 any original DKIM signature.
38834 .wen
38835
38836 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
38837 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
38838
38839 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
38840 .olist
38841 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
38842 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
38843 (including transport filters)
38844 except cutthrough delivery.
38845 .next
38846 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
38847 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
38848 different signature contexts.
38849 .endlist
38850
38851 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
38852 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
38853 Exim's standard controls.
38854
38855 .new
38856 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
38857 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
38858
38859 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
38860 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
38861 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
38862 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
38863 .code
38864 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
38865 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
38866 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
38867 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
38868 .endd
38869 .wen
38870
38871 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
38872 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
38873 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
38874 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
38875 senders).
38876
38877
38878 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
38879 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
38880
38881 .new
38882 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
38883 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38884 .code
38885 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
38886
38887 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
38888 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
38889 .endd
38890
38891 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
38892 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
38893 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
38894 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
38895 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
38896 .wen
38897
38898 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
38899 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
38900
38901 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
38902 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
38903 After expansion, this can be a list.
38904 Each element in turn is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
38905 while expanding the remaining signing options.
38906 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
38907 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
38908
38909 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
38910 This sets the key selector string.
38911 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
38912 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
38913 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
38914 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
38915 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
38916 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
38917
38918 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
38919 This sets the private key to use.
38920 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
38921 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
38922 The result can either
38923 .ilist
38924 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
38925 .new
38926 .next
38927 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
38928 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
38929 .wen
38930 .next
38931 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
38932 the private key
38933 .next
38934 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
38935 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
38936 is set.
38937 .endlist
38938
38939 .new
38940 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
38941 .code
38942 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
38943 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
38944 .endd
38945 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
38946 for the DNS TXT record.
38947 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
38948
38949 Under GnuTLS:
38950 .code
38951 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
38952 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
38953 .endd
38954
38955 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38956 .code
38957 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
38958 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
38959 .endd
38960
38961 Support for EC keys is being developed under
38962 &url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-dcrup-dkim-crypto/).
38963 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
38964 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
38965 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
38966 for some transition period.
38967 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
38968 for EC keys.
38969
38970 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
38971 .code
38972 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
38973 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
38974 .endd
38975
38976 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
38977 .code
38978 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
38979 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
38980 .endd
38981 .wen
38982
38983 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
38984 Can be set alternatively to &"sha1"& to use an alternate hash
38985 method.
38986
38987 .new
38988 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38989 .code
38990 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
38991 .endd
38992 .wen
38993
38994 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
38995 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
38996 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
38997 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
38998 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
38999 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
39000
39001 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
39002 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
39003 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
39004 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
39005 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
39006
39007 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
39008 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
39009 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
39010 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
39011 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
39012 variables here.
39013
39014 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
39015 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
39016 list of header names.
39017 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
39018 in the message signature.
39019 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
39020 whether or not each header is present in the message.
39021 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
39022 "_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
39023
39024 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
39025 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
39026 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
39027
39028 A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
39029 If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
39030 will be signed.
39031 If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
39032 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
39033 name will be appended.
39034
39035
39036 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
39037 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
39038
39039 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is implemented via the
39040 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
39041 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
39042 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
39043 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
39044 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
39045 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
39046
39047 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
39048 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
39049 runtime of the ACL.
39050
39051 .new
39052 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
39053 Performing verification sets up information used by the
39054 &$authresults$& expansion item.
39055 .wen
39056
39057 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
39058 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
39059 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
39060 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
39061
39062 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
39063 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
39064 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
39065 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
39066 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
39067 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
39068 it defaults as:
39069 .code
39070 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
39071 .endd
39072 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
39073 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
39074 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
39075 .code
39076 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
39077 .endd
39078 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
39079 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
39080 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
39081 .code
39082 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
39083 .endd
39084
39085 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
39086 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
39087
39088 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
39089 for each matching signature.
39090
39091
39092 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
39093 available (from most to least important):
39094
39095
39096 .vlist
39097 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
39098 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
39099 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
39100 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
39101
39102 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
39103 Within the DKIM ACL,
39104 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
39105 .ilist
39106 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
39107 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39108 .next
39109 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
39110 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39111 .next
39112 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
39113 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39114 .next
39115 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
39116 .endlist
39117
39118 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39119 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
39120 hash-method or key-size:
39121 .code
39122 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
39123 condition = ${if eq {$len_3:$dkim_algo}{rsa}}
39124 condition = ${if or {eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
39125 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}} }
39126 logwrite = NOTE: forcing dkim verify fail (was pass)
39127 set dkim_verify_status = fail
39128 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
39129 .endd
39130
39131 After all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
39132 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
39133
39134 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
39135 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
39136 "fail" or "invalid". One of
39137 .ilist
39138 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
39139 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
39140 .next
39141 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
39142 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
39143 .next
39144 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
39145 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
39146 means that the message body was modified in transit.
39147 .next
39148 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
39149 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
39150 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
39151 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
39152 .endlist
39153
39154 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39155
39156 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
39157 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
39158 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
39159 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39160
39161 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
39162 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
39163 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
39164 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39165
39166 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
39167 The key record selector string.
39168
39169 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
39170 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
39171 .new
39172 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39173 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
39174 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39175 for EC keys.
39176 .wen
39177
39178 .new
39179 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39180 .code
39181 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39182
39183 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
39184 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
39185 .endd
39186
39187 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39188 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39189 .wen
39190
39191 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
39192 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39193
39194 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
39195 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39196
39197 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
39198 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
39199 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
39200 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
39201 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
39202 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
39203
39204 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
39205 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
39206 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
39207 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
39208
39209 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
39210 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
39211 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
39212
39213 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
39214 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
39215 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
39216 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
39217 integer size comparisons against this value.
39218 .new
39219 Note that Exim does not check this value.
39220 .wen
39221
39222 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
39223 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
39224
39225 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
39226 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
39227
39228 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
39229 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
39230
39231 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
39232 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39233 in the key record.
39234
39235 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
39236 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39237 in the key record.
39238
39239 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
39240 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
39241
39242 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
39243 Number of bits in the key.
39244
39245 .new
39246 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39247 .code
39248 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
39249 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
39250 .endd
39251
39252 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39253 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39254 As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
39255 .wen
39256
39257 .endlist
39258
39259 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
39260
39261 .vlist
39262 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
39263 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
39264 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
39265 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
39266 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
39267
39268 .code
39269 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
39270 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
39271 sender_domains = gmail.com
39272 dkim_signers = gmail.com
39273 dkim_status = none
39274 .endd
39275
39276 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
39277 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
39278
39279 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
39280 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
39281 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
39282 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
39283
39284 .code
39285 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
39286 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
39287 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
39288 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
39289 .endd
39290
39291 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
39292 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
39293 for more information of what they mean.
39294 .endlist
39295
39296
39297
39298
39299 .new
39300 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
39301 .cindex SPF verification
39302
39303 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
39304 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
39305 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.openspf.org).
39306
39307 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
39308 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
39309
39310 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
39311 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
39312 &url(http://www.libspf2.org/).
39313 There is no Exim involvement on the trasmission of messages; publishing certain
39314 DNS records is all that is required.
39315
39316 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
39317 .new
39318 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
39319 Performing verification sets up information used by the
39320 &$authresults$& expansion item.
39321 .wen
39322
39323
39324 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39325 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
39326 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
39327 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
39328 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
39329 Valid strings are:
39330 .vlist
39331 .vitem &%pass%&
39332 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
39333
39334 .vitem &%fail%&
39335 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
39336 domain in the envelope-from address.
39337
39338 .vitem &%softfail%&
39339 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
39340 is a forgery.
39341
39342 .vitem &%none%&
39343 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
39344
39345 .vitem &%neutral%&
39346 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
39347 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
39348 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
39349
39350 .vitem &%permerror%&
39351 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
39352 You may deny messages when this occurs. (Changed in 4.83)
39353
39354 .vitem &%temperror%&
39355 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
39356 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
39357 (Changed in 4.83)
39358
39359 .vitem &%err_temp%&
39360 Same as permerror, deprecated in 4.83, will be removed in a future release.
39361
39362 .vitem &%err_perm%&
39363 Same as temperror, deprecated in 4.83, will be removed in a future release.
39364 .endlist
39365
39366 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
39367 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
39368 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
39369 short-circuit fashion.
39370
39371 Example:
39372 .code
39373 deny spf = fail
39374 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
39375 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
39376 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
39377 Please see http://www.openspf.org/Why?scope=\
39378 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
39379 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
39380 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
39381 ip=$sender_host_address
39382 .endd
39383
39384 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
39385 variables:
39386
39387 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
39388 .vlist
39389 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
39390 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
39391 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
39392 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
39393 it for logging purposes.
39394
39395 .vitem &$spf_received$&
39396 .vindex &$spf_received$&
39397 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
39398 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
39399 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
39400 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
39401
39402 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
39403 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
39404
39405 .vitem &$spf_result$&
39406 .vindex &$spf_result$&
39407 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
39408 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
39409 temperror.
39410
39411 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
39412 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
39413 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
39414 and required in order to obtain a result.
39415
39416 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39417 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39418 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
39419 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
39420 .endlist
39421
39422
39423 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39424 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
39425 .cindex SPF "best guess"
39426 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
39427 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
39428 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
39429 capability.
39430 Refer to &url(http://www.openspf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
39431 for a description of what it means.
39432
39433 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
39434 of the spf one. For example:
39435
39436 .code
39437 deny spf_guess = fail
39438 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
39439 .endd
39440
39441 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
39442 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
39443 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
39444 reject message.
39445
39446 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
39447 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
39448
39449 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
39450 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
39451 &%spf_guess%& option.
39452 For example, the following:
39453
39454 .code
39455 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
39456 .endd
39457
39458 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
39459
39460
39461 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
39462 .cindex lookup spf
39463 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
39464 address as the key and an IP address as the database:
39465
39466 .code
39467 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
39468 .endd
39469
39470 The lookup will return the same result strings as they can appear in
39471 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
39472 Currently, only IPv4 addresses are supported.
39473
39474
39475 . wen-for SPF section
39476 .wen
39477
39478
39479 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39480 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39481
39482 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
39483 "Proxy support"
39484 .cindex "proxy support"
39485 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
39486
39487 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
39488 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
39489
39490
39491 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
39492 .cindex proxy inbound
39493 .cindex proxy "server side"
39494 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
39495 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
39496
39497 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
39498 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
39499 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
39500 in Local/Makefile.
39501
39502 It was built on specifications from:
39503 (&url(http://haproxy.1wt.eu/download/1.5/doc/proxy-protocol.txt)).
39504 That URL was revised in May 2014 to version 2 spec:
39505 (&url(http://git.1wt.eu/web?p=haproxy.git;a=commitdiff;h=afb768340c9d7e50d8e)).
39506
39507 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
39508 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
39509 to distribute load.
39510 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
39511 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
39512 There is no logging if a host passes or
39513 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
39514 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
39515
39516 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
39517 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
39518 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
39519 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
39520 automatically determines which version is in use.
39521
39522 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
39523 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
39524 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
39525 Exim and the proxy server.
39526
39527 The following expansion variables are usable
39528 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
39529 of the proxy):
39530 .display
39531 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
39532 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
39533 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
39534 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
39535 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
39536 .endd
39537 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
39538 there was a protocol error.
39539
39540 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
39541 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
39542 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
39543 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
39544 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
39545 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
39546 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
39547 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
39548 A possible solution is:
39549 .display
39550 # Set max number of connections per host
39551 LIMIT = 5
39552 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
39553 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
39554
39555 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
39556 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
39557 .endd
39558
39559
39560
39561 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
39562 .cindex proxy outbound
39563 .cindex proxy "client side"
39564 .cindex proxy SOCKS
39565 .cindex SOCKS proxy
39566 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
39567 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
39568 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
39569 Local/Makefile.
39570
39571 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
39572 on an smtp transport.
39573 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
39574 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
39575 Each proxy specifier is a list
39576 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
39577 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
39578
39579 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
39580 The list of options is in the following table:
39581 .display
39582 &'auth '& authentication method
39583 &'name '& authentication username
39584 &'pass '& authentication password
39585 &'port '& tcp port
39586 &'tmo '& connection timeout
39587 &'pri '& priority
39588 &'weight '& selection bias
39589 .endd
39590
39591 More details on each of these options follows:
39592
39593 .ilist
39594 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
39595 .cindex proxy authentication
39596 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
39597 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
39598 for access to the proxy.
39599 Default is &"none"&.
39600 .next
39601 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
39602 Default is empty.
39603 .next
39604 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
39605 Default is empty.
39606 .next
39607 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
39608 Default is 1080.
39609 .next
39610 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
39611 Default is 5.
39612 .next
39613 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
39614 higher values being tried first.
39615 The default priority is 1.
39616 .next
39617 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
39618 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
39619 weighted by this value.
39620 The default value for selection bias is 1.
39621 .endlist
39622
39623 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
39624 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
39625 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
39626
39627 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
39628 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
39629 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
39630 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
39631
39632 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39633 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39634
39635 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
39636 "Internationalisation""
39637 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
39638 .cindex EAI
39639 .cindex i18n
39640 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
39641
39642 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
39643 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
39644 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
39645
39646 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
39647 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
39648 requirement, upon libidn2.
39649
39650 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
39651 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
39652 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
39653 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
39654 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
39655 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
39656
39657 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
39658 international handling for the message is enabled and
39659 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
39660
39661 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
39662 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
39663 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
39664 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
39665
39666 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
39667 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
39668 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
39669 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
39670
39671 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
39672 components expanded to a-label form,
39673 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
39674 form of the name.
39675
39676 .cindex log protocol
39677 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
39678 .cindex i18n logging
39679 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
39680 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
39681
39682 The following expansion operators can be used:
39683 .code
39684 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
39685 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
39686 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
39687 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
39688 .endd
39689
39690 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
39691 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
39692 .new
39693 The RCPT ACL
39694 .wen
39695 may use the following modifier:
39696 .display
39697 control = utf8_downconvert
39698 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
39699 .endd
39700 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
39701 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
39702 Message Submission Agent context.
39703 If a value is appended it may be:
39704 .display
39705 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
39706 &`0 `& no downconversion
39707 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
39708 .endd
39709
39710 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
39711 is initially set to -1.
39712
39713
39714 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
39715 Configurations supporting these should inspect
39716 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
39717
39718 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
39719 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
39720 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
39721
39722 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
39723 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
39724
39725
39726
39727 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
39728 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
39729 the following expansion operator can be used:
39730 .code
39731 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
39732 .endd
39733
39734 The string is converted from the charset specified by
39735 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
39736 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
39737 to the
39738 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
39739 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
39740 (which has to be a single character)
39741 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
39742 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
39743
39744 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
39745 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
39746
39747 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
39748 by many other IMAP servers.
39749
39750 Examples:
39751 .display
39752 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
39753 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
39754 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
39755 .endd
39756
39757 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
39758 must be representable in UTF-16.
39759
39760
39761 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39762 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39763
39764 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
39765 "Events"
39766 .cindex events
39767
39768 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
39769 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
39770 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
39771 processing actions.
39772
39773 Most installations will never need to use Events.
39774 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
39775 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39776
39777 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
39778 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
39779 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
39780
39781 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
39782 An example might look like:
39783 .cindex logging custom
39784 .code
39785 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
39786 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
39787 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
39788 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
39789 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
39790 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
39791 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
39792 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
39793 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
39794 } {}}
39795 .endd
39796
39797 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
39798 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
39799 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
39800
39801 The current list of events is:
39802 .display
39803 &`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
39804 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
39805 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39806 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
39807 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
39808 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
39809 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39810 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
39811 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
39812 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
39813 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
39814 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
39815 .endd
39816 New event types may be added in future.
39817
39818 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
39819 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
39820 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
39821
39822 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
39823 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
39824 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
39825
39826 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
39827 should define the event action.
39828
39829 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
39830 with the event type:
39831 .display
39832 &`dane:fail `& failure reason
39833 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
39834 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
39835 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
39836 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
39837 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
39838 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
39839 .endd
39840
39841 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
39842
39843 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
39844 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
39845 the course of its processing:
39846 .ilist
39847 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
39848 transport call
39849 .next
39850 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
39851 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
39852 .endlist
39853 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
39854 a useful way of writing to the main log.
39855
39856 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
39857 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
39858 following will be forced:
39859 .display
39860 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
39861 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
39862 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
39863 .endd
39864 All other message types ignore the result string, and
39865 no other use is made of it.
39866
39867 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
39868 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
39869 the target system.
39870
39871 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
39872 chain element received on the connection.
39873 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
39874 loaded locally.
39875
39876 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39877 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39878
39879 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
39880 "Adding drivers or lookups"
39881 .cindex "adding drivers"
39882 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
39883 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
39884 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
39885 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
39886
39887 .olist
39888 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
39889 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
39890 .next
39891 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
39892 .display
39893 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
39894 .endd
39895 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
39896 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
39897 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
39898 .next
39899 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
39900 .code
39901 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
39902 .endd
39903 .next
39904 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
39905 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
39906 .next
39907 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
39908 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
39909 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
39910 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
39911 simple form that most lookups have.
39912 .next
39913 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
39914 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
39915 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
39916 .next
39917 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
39918 &_src_&.
39919 .next
39920 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
39921 as for other drivers and lookups.
39922 .endlist
39923
39924 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
39925 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
39926 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
39927 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
39928 searched using a binary chop procedure.
39929
39930 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
39931 the interface that is expected.
39932
39933
39934
39935
39936 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39937 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39938
39939 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39940 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
39941 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
39942 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
39943 . processors.
39944 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39945
39946 .literal xml
39947 <?sdop
39948 format="newpage"
39949 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
39950 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
39951 ?>
39952 .literal off
39953
39954 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
39955 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
39956 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
39957
39958
39959 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39960 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////